Design document
Transcription
Design document
Document of The International Fund for Agricultural Development REPUBLIC OF ZAMBIA SMALLHOLDER PRODUCTIVITY PROMOTION PROGRAMME (S3P) PROGRAMME DESIGN REPORT VOLUME 1 – MAIN REPORT CONFIDENTIAL REPORT No. XX June 2011 East and Southern Africa Division Programme Management Department This document has a restricted distribution and may be used by recipients only in the performance of their official duties. Its contents may not otherwise be disclosed without the authorisation of the International Fund for Agricultural Development (IFAD). Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report REPUBLIC OF ZAMBIA SMALLHOLDER PRODUCTIVITY PROMOTION PROGRAMME (S3P) PROGRAMME DESIGN REPORT VOLUME 1 – MAIN REPORT TABLE OF CONTENTS ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS ...........................................................................II EXECUTIVE SUMMARY .......................................................................................... IV SAPP AND S3P PROGRAMME OVERVIEW .................................................................. 1 S3P LOGICAL FRAMEWORK .................................................................................... 2 I. STRATEGIC CONTEXT AND RATIONALE .......................................................... 7 A. Country and Rural Development and Poverty Context ............................... 7 B. Rationale............................................................................................. 9 II. PROGRAMME DESCRIPTION ........................................................................ A. Programme Area and Target Group ...................................................... B. Programme Development Objective ...................................................... C. Components and Outcomes ................................................................. 12 12 15 16 III. PROGRAMME IMPLEMENTATION .................................................................. A. Approach .......................................................................................... B. Organizational Framework ................................................................... C. Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation and Knowledge Management ............ D. Financial Management, Procurement and Governance ............................. E. Supervision ....................................................................................... F. Risk Identification and Mitigation.......................................................... 21 21 22 23 26 30 30 IV. PROGRAMME COSTS, FINANCING AND BENEFITS .......................................... A. Programme Costs ............................................................................... B. Programme Financing ......................................................................... C. Summary Benefit Analysis ................................................................... D. Sustainability..................................................................................... 31 31 32 32 35 ANNEXES ........................................................................................................... 37 Annex 1. Country and Rural Context Background ...................................... 39 Annex 2. Poverty, Targeting and Gender.................................................. 46 Annex 3. Country Performance and Lessons Learned ................................. 57 Annex 4. Detailed Programme Description ............................................... 65 Annex 5. Implementation Arrangements.................................................. 78 Annex 6. Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation and Knowledge .................... 97 Annex 7. Financial Management and Disbursement Arrangements .............104 Annex 8. Procurement ..........................................................................113 Annex 9. Programme Cost and Financing ................................................119 Annex 10. Economic and Financial Analysis ...............................................133 Annex 11. Draft Programme Implementation Manual .................................140 Annex 12. Adherence to IFAD Policies ......................................................158 Annex 13. Contents of the Programme Life File .........................................167 i Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report CURRENCY EQUIVALENTS Currency Unit = Zambian Kwacha USD 1.00 = ZK 4800 (April 2011) WEIGHTS AND MEASURES International Metric System, unless specified in text FISCAL YEAR 1st January to 31st December ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS ACPG ADC AER AR4D AWPB CA (CF) CAADP CAC CEO CF (CA) CFU CMT COSOP CSC CSO DAC DACO DCU DDCC DFA DoA DP EC FAO FFS FISP FMU FNDP FO FRA FTC GART GDP GRZ HH ICT IFAD IPPM IPSAS KM KMC Agricultural Cooperating Partners Group Area Development Committee Agro-Ecological Region Agricultural Research for Development Annual Work Plan and Budget Conservation Agriculture (Conservation Farming) Comprehensive African Agriculture Development Programme Camp Agricultural Committee Camp Extension Officer Conservation Farming (Conservation Agriculture) Conservation Farming Unit of ZNFU Change Management Team Country Strategic Opportunities Paper/ Programme Cassava Sub-sector Committee Central Statistics Office District Agricultural Committee District Agricultural Coordinator District Cooperative Union District Development Coordination Committee District Farmers Association Department of Agriculture Development Partner European Commission Food and Agriculture Organization of the United Nations Farmer Field School Farm Input Supply Programme Financial Management Unit in Ministry of Agriculture and Cooperatives Fifth National Development Plan (2005-2010) Farmer Organization Food Reserve Agency Farmer Training Centre Golden Valley Agricultural Research Trust Gross Domestic Product Government of the Republic of Zambia Household Information Communication Technology International Fund for Agricultural Development Integrated Pest and Production Management International Public Sector Accounting Standards Knowledge Management Knowledge Management and Communication ii Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report KM&L LCMS MACO MCDSS MDG M&E MIS MFNP MLGH MOU MT MTEF MTR NAP NARS Natsave NGO PACO PAO PCR PDG PEA PEP PIM PLARD PME PMU PPD PRSP PSC PSU RIMS RFP S3P SAPP SCCI SHEMP SNDP SLIP SLM TA ToT UNZA ZARI ZNFU ZPPA Knowledge Management and Learning Living Conditions Monitoring Survey Ministry of Agriculture and Cooperatives Ministry of Community Development and Social Services Millennium Development Goal Monitoring and Evaluation Management Information System Ministry of Finance and National Planning Ministry of Local Government and Housing Memorandum of Understanding Metric ton Medium Term Expenditure Framework Mid Term Review National Agricultural Policy National Agricultural Research System National Savings and Credit Bank Non-Governmental Organization Provincial Agricultural Coordinator Principle Agricultural Officer Programme Completion Report Project Design Group Participatory Extension Approaches Performance Enhancement Programme Programme Implementation Manual Programme for Luapula Agricultural and Rural Development Programme Monitoring and Evaluation Programme Management Unit Policy and Planning Department Poverty Reduction Strategy Paper Programme Steering Committee Procurement and Supplies Unit Results and Impact Management System Rural Finance Programme Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme Smallholder Agribusiness Promotion Programme Seed Control and Certification Institute Smallholder Enterprise and Marketing Programme Sixth National Development Plan(2011-2015) Smallholder Livestock Investment Project Sustainable Land Management Technical Assistance Training of Trainers University of Zambia Zambia Agricultural Research Institute Zambia National Farmers Union Zambia Public Procurement Authority iii Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report EXECUTIVE SUMMARY 1. Background: The Programme design is rooted in: (i) a participatory consultative process that started in September 2009, and involved several missions, extended field visits, numerous workshops and meetings at central, provincial, district and field level, and involving many different voices, from policy and decision makers to researchers, extension workers and male and female farmers; and (ii) lessons learned from previous and ongoing IFAD experience in Zambia, as well as from other initiatives, projects and programmes within the country and the Region. There was a general consensus to propose a programme that would complement and support the recently started Smallholder Agribusiness Promotion Programme (SAPP) in the form of a Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P). 2. Rationale: The justification for the investment is based on: (i) the need to accelerate growth in smallholder agriculture to reduce poverty in Zambia, which hinges on both improved marketing and increased productivity; (ii) the need to contribute to the GRZ policy framework, in particular the Sixth National Development Plan (20112015), which supports the development of a sustainable and competitive agricultural sector in order to ensure food security and income generation at household and national levels and to maximize the sector’s contribution to GDP; and (iii) the opportunity to complement ongoing IFAD programmes and contribute to overall cohesiveness of the IFAD Country Strategic Opportunities Programme 2011-2015 (COSOP); (iv) the opportunity to focus on three essential elements that deserve more systematic attention: smallholder productivity, diversification (away from maize), and reduction of vulnerability to climatic variations; and (v) the opportunity to engage in and support highly relevant policy development related to these issues. 3. Target group: The programme’s target group consists of around 60,000 smallholder farming households (with cropped area up to 5 ha), organized in groups and/or cooperatives, or willing to join such groups. A large majority of smallholders are below the poverty line, but many already devote part of their farming system to marketoriented production. Others remain semi-subsistence farmers who primarily grow food crops but occasionally sell surpluses. About 50 percent are women farmers. 4. Approach: S3P will follow a farming systems approach (up to farm gate), thereby complementing SAPP’s value chain approach (from farm gate to end user). S3P investment in the “supply-push” side of production development is expected to complement the “market-pull” investment under SAPP, and also complements other initiatives supported by GRZ and development partners. S3P will focus on cassava-based farming systems and the associated commodities of cassava, mixed beans, groundnuts and rice, which (with the exception of groundnuts) have already been included in the list of commodities SAPP works with. These commodities are central to smallholder farming systems in high rainfall areas, significant for household food and nutrition security and income, and they offer important marketing opportunities in more efficient value chains in which smallholder farmers can participate. The target beneficiaries are expected to improve their organizational structures (farmers organizations and federations will be supported to better understand and respond to market opportunities), gain access to and adopt improved technologies (seeds, cropping practices, labour saving technologies and tools), benefit from improved agricultural and rural infrastructure and market linkages, have improved access to markets (linked to SAPP) and financial institutions (linked to IFAD’s Rural Finance Programme, RFP). 5. Objectives: the S3P goal is that income levels, food and nutrition security are sustainably improved for poor agricultural households in the target areas. At the goal level, the Programme is expected to assist up to 48,000 smallholder households (80 per cent of the core target group) to achieve at least one of the following: (i) increase in household asset ownership; (ii) increase in household savings; reduction in prevalence of child malnutrition; and (iv) reduction in food insecurity. iv Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 6. The purpose of S3P is: that the production, productivity and sales of smallholder farmers in target areas are sustainably increased. The associated indicators include: (i) average crop yields of cassava, rice, mixed beans and/or groundnuts of 30,000 smallholder households increased by at least 30 percent; (ii) quantities of cassava, rice, mixed beans and/or groundnuts marketed by 40,000 smallholder households increased by at least 20 percent; (iii) vulnerability of 10,000 smallholder households to climatic variation affecting crop production and/or market access reduced. 7. Programme description: S3P will adopt a phased programmatic approach and will be implemented over a seven years period. It will start in eight districts in two provinces (Luapula and Northern) and will gradually expand to cover up to 24 districts in three provinces. S3P will have two components and six sub-components. 8. Component 1: Sustainable smallholder productivity growth, to improve smallholder access to knowledge, extension, adapted technologies and improved planting material, with three sub-components: 1.1 Strengthening farmer organizations and their federations; 1.2 Pluralistic participatory extension systems; and 1.3 Agricultural research for development. 9. Component 2: Enabling environment for productivity growth, will address critical constraints in the enabling environment for smallholder productivity growth, reflected in three sub-components: 2.1 Local agricultural investments, which improve access to markets, increase labour productivity, reduce post-harvest losses, improve land and water management; 2.2 Support to the policy and planning framework; and 2.3 Programme management, monitoring and evaluation. 10. Outcomes generated by S3P include: (1.1) targeted smallholder groups and organizations functioning more effectively and empowered to respond to market and rural development opportunities; (1.2) smallholders in target areas have improved access to more pertinent and effective advisory services delivered by government and/or private sector; (1.3) agricultural research and seed multiplication more responsive to priority needs of smallholders; (2.1) improved rural infrastructure and improved access to productivity enhancing works and equipment; (2.2) improved public policy and planning framework to support sustainable productivity growth and expand smallholder integration in agricultural markets; and (2.3) effective implementation capacity, knowledge management, programme coordination, results measurement and reporting. 11. Implementation: detailed implementation procedures including start-up activities will be documented in a Programme Implementation manual (PIM). The S3P will be executed within the Ministry of Agriculture and Cooperatives (MACO), and will be managed by a Programme Management Unit, located within MACO, with a programme manager and a management team based in Lusaka, and a technical team based in the target provinces. It will be guided by a Programme Steering Committee, which is shared with SAPP. MACO field staff at provincial and district level and in the Zambia Agricultural Research Institute will play key roles. Farmer organizations and private sector entities will provide services, where possible through public-private partnerships (PPPs), or through contractual arrangements. 12. Partnerships: The S3P will be co-financed by the government of Finland. This will provide opportunity for close collaboration and synergies in particular with the Finnish-supported Luapula Agricultural and Rural Development programme (PLARD), which is piloting and implementing some of the activities that S3P can scale-up. The S3P partnerships are envisaged at different levels: (i) with government and/or donor supported programmes and initiatives; (ii) PPPs with private/non-government initiatives that target smallholders through similar types and methods of activities promoted by S3P; and (iii) partnerships with national and international research organizations to work together on the development of appropriate technologies. In addition, S3P will seek to learn from best practice, avoid overlap and ensure complementarities, create linkages, leverage investments already made, and help establish a joint platform involving MACO v Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report and its cooperating partners for lessons learned and knowledge about smallholder productivity growth and related issues. 13. Economic impact. The economic rationale for S3P hinges on the increased net margins of smallholders in the “cassava belt” that produce cassava, mixed beans, groundnuts and rice. This increased net margin will primarily result from increased productivity (yields per ha and per labour unit). These result in a 300 per cent increase in net household incomes the core target group farmers and an internal economic rate of return for the programme as a whole of 14 per cent. 14. Programme costs and financing. Total investment and recurrent costs, including contingencies, are estimated at US$ 39.9 million (ZMK 271 billion). Component 1 accounts for 57 per cent of total costs, and Component 2 the remaining 43 per cent. The programme will be funded by: (i) an IFAD Loan of US$ 24.8 million provided on highly concessional terms; (ii) a Grant from the Government of Finland (US$ 7.1 million) (EUR 5 million), on pari passu basis with the IFAD Loan; (iii) the Government of Zambia (US$ 6.1 million), in the form of taxes foregone; (iv) Programme beneficiaries (US$ 1.5 million) and (v) participating districts (US$ 0.4 million). 15. Sustainability. As a result of S3P, smallholders will be more productive and better organized, capable and empowered to consolidate their demand for quality support services and link-up with different service providers. Decentralized agricultural offices and institutions will have strengthened their governance capacities by routinely engaging in bottom-up participatory planning and implementation of sustainable local agricultural and economic activities, operating with fairness and transparency. Government and non-government agricultural research and extension service providers will be working together through PPP-type arrangements. Increasing productivity of cassava, mixed beans, groundnuts and rice is expected to continue well beyond programme duration, once the demand-driven technology development systems are operating as intended. 16. Risks: The Programme is regarded as only moderately risky. The design draws lessons from previous and ongoing IFAD projects and programmes initiatives in the country, as well as of other initiatives within Zambia and the region. The programme will be embedded in MACO at central, provincial and district level, and measures are included to support capacity building at these different levels. Robust implementation arrangements and inclusion of a management team as well as a technical team should help ensure programme execution. Risks and appropriate mitigation measures have been identified and incorporated in the Programme design. vi REPUBLIC OF ZAMBIA SMALLHOLDER PRODUCTIVITY PROMOTION PROGRAMME (S3P) PROGRAMME DESIGN DOCUMENT VOLUME 1 – MAIN REPORT SAPP AND S3P PROGRAMME OVERVIEW Smallholder Agribusiness Promotion Programme (SAPP) Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Goal: Income levels, food and nutrition security sustainably improved for poor agricultural households in target area Development objective: Volume and value of agribusiness output of small-scale producers increased Development objective: Production, productivity and sales of smallholder farmers in target areas sustainably increased. Approach: Value chain approach, from farm gate to end user. Approach: farming systems approach, up to farm gate. 1 Component 1: More efficient value chains. Component 2: Enabling environment for agribusiness development. Component 1: Sustainable smallholder productivity growth. Component 2: Enabling environment for productivity growth. Outcome 1.1: Small-scale producers better connected to and better able to respond to market demand and value addition opportunities Outcome 2.1: Enhanced policies and increased capacities to deliver public good services to small-scale farmers and promote viable agribusiness as poverty reduction strategy. Outcome 1.1: Targeted smallholder groups and organizations functioning more effectively and empowered to respond to market and rural development opportunities Outcome 2.1: Improved rural infrastructure and improved access to productivity enhancing works and equipment. Outcome 1.2: Enhanced capacity of value chain operators and improved relations and coordination among value chain stakeholders and support services Outcome 2.2: Effective implementation capacity, knowledge management, programme coordination, results management and reporting. Outcome 1.2: Smallholders in target areas have improved access to more pertinent and effective advisory services delivered by MACO and/or private sector Outcome 2.2: Improved public policy and planning environment to support sustainable productivity growth and expand smallholder integration in agricultural markets. Outcome 1.3: Agricultural research and seed multiplication services more responsive to priority needs of smallholders. Outcome 2.3: Effective implementation capacity, knowledge management, programme coordination, results measurement and reporting. Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Goal: Increase the income levels of poor rural households involved in production, value adding and trade and trade of agricultural commodities S3P LOGICAL FRAMEWORK Indicators Means of Verification GOAL: Income levels and food and nutrition security sustainably improved for poor agricultural households in the project area By programme completion up to 48,000 smallholder households (80% of direct beneficiaries) achieve min. one of the following: Increase in asset ownership. Increase in savings. Reduction in prevalence of child malnutrition. Reduction in food insecurity. RIMS baseline, and completion surveys Zambia Central Statistical Office DEVELOPMENT OBJECTIVE: Production, productivity and sales of smallholder farmers in target areas sustainably increased Increased crop yields (min. 30%) of cassava, rice, mixed beans and/or groundnuts of 30,000 smallholder. Increased quantities (min. 20%) of cassava, rice, mixed beans / groundnuts marketed by 40,000 smallholder HHs . Reduced vulnerability of 10,000 smallholder HHs to climatic variation affecting crop production. MACO/CSO surveys Baseline and end- of programme surveys. 20,000 smallholder farmers (by gender and poverty quintile) actively involved in farmer groups, associations and cooperatives 100 farmer groups linked to financial service providers 30% of leadership positions in farmer groups and CACs held by women MACO M&E data S3P reports, surveys and qualitative impact assessments ZARI reports 80% of farmers participating in PEA/FFS-type groups satisfied with advisory services. 80% of participants in PEA/FFS-type groups adopting improved seed, planting material and/or cultural practices. 5 public-private partnerships for agricultural extension and marketing established in programme area. 45,000 farmers adopting improved crop varieties adapted to target areas 30,000 farmers adopting conservation agriculture, agro-forestry and/or improved cropping practices adapted to target areas 5,000 farmers and their families adopting labour saving equipment MACO M&E data S3P reports, surveys and qualitative impact assessments ZARI reports Baseline and end- of programme surveys. MACO/CSO studies ZARI/SCCI reports Assumptions Stable prices; effective targeting includes poorer households OUTCOMES 2 Component 1: Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth Targeted smallholder farmer groups and organizations informed, organized and empowered to respond to market and agricultural development opportunities. Smallholders in target areas have improved access to more pertinent and effective advisory services delivered by MACO and/or private sector. Agricultural research and seed multiplication services responds to priority needs of smallholders, with availability of: Improved crop varieties. Improved land and crop management practices. Labour saving tools/equipment. Agricultural technologies offer smallholders opportunities to increase production and productivity in a sustainable manner. SAPP operating effectively and successfully on key selected agricultural value chains Research - extension link operational Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Results Hierarchy Results Hierarchy Indicators Means of Verification Assumptions S3P annual reports Districts, communities and groups interested willing and able to contribute to and cofinance agricultural and rural investments. Component 2: Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth. 40 operational district-level agricultural investments. 350 operational community-level agricultural investments. 500 group-level agricultural investments. Improved public policy and planning environment to support sustainable productivity growth and expand smallholders’ integration in agricultural markets 3 changes in policies resulting from policy reviews and studies, related workshops and lessons learning visits. Unqualified financial and technical audits. Timeliness and adequacy of annual work plans, budgets and reports (including M&E reports, expenditure and accounting reports). Disbursement rate <10% variance from profile Effective implementation capacity, knowledge management, programme coordination, results measurement and reporting. SNDP reports Policy processes driven by technical as well as political considerations Audit reports S3P periodic reports PMU adequately staffed and supported S3P periodic reports Service Provider reports PSC minutes Existing and solid farmers organisations genuinely interested in having their capacities strengthened Individuals trained willing to set-up farmer group and see the value of collective action S3P periodic reports MACO district and provincial reports SNDP reports Internal / external audit reports PSC minutes Establishment of extension staff posts well covered, reduced vacancy ratio in districts targeted by the project OUTPUTS 3 Sub-component 1.1: Strengthening Farmer Organizations and their Federations. Capacities of existing farmer organizations, quality of their services and capacity support they require assessed Training provided to FO and individual farmers 12 District Farmer Associations and/or District Cooperative Unions, and 750 Farmer groups/camp level associations, strengthened 20,000 members trained on identified priority issues. Sub-component 1.2: Pluralistic Participatory Extension Services PACO and DACO capacities to coordinate and deliver quality services strengthened Procurement and financial management capacities in target provinces / districts improved Improved information and knowledge sharing Improved mobility and housing of Camp extension Officers. Quarterly provincial level planning and review meetings involving DACOs, ZARI and partners. Quarterly district level planning, information sharing and review meetings. Staff of 3 provinces and 24 districts trained in fiduciary issues Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Improved agricultural and rural infrastructure and improved access to productivity enhancing works and equipment. Partnerships established with private sector agricultural extension and marketing services providers in target areas.. Preparation of harmonized PEA/FFS curriculum for Master Training of Trainers. Training of master trainers in 3 provinces. Training of trainers in 24 districts. 1500 PEA/FFS trainings for 30,000 participating farmers. S3P periodic reports MACO district and provincial reports PSC minutes 15,000 smallholders receive extension support through public-private partnerships with private/nongovernment organizations providing such services. PPP agreements Service provider contracts PPP / Service providers reports Farmer surveys PSC minutes Establishment of extension staff posts well covered, reduced vacancy ratio in districts targeted by the project Sub-component 1.3: Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) Improved crop varieties adapted to target areas delivered. On-station breeding and selection programmes for cassava and mixed beans and possibly rice and groundnuts undertaken. Number of improved cassava, mixed beans and possibly rice and groundnuts varieties developed ZARI reports S3P reports Partner institutions reports PSC minutes Adaptive cropping practices research to support shift to more intensive production systems undertaken ZARI reports S3P reports Partner institutions reports PSC minutes Adaptive labour productivity research for on-farm technologies and equipment, including transport and post-harvest undertaken. Improved access to certified seed and planting material in target areas. Adapted certification supported by SCCI. Adapted CA, agro-forestry practices and/or other improved cropping practices made available Number of improved resilience to climatic variability, integrated pest management Soil fertility, organic matter and nutrients management technologies produced. Number of Labour saving tools/equipment adapted to target areas produced. Improved access to transport and training infrastructure at district level 4 Maintenance of breeder seed stock for cassava (4 varieties min.) and mixed beans (5 varieties min.) Production of foundation seed for cassava and mixed beans on 3 ha, 2 ha respectively. First multiplication of seed at district/block level on 2 ha, 1 ha., and second multiplication at camp level (by FFS groups of sub-component 1.2) on 5 ha, 2 ha. Sub-component 2.1: Local Agricultural Investments 40 district level agricultural investments planned by communities and implemented Cassava Sector strategy remains a government priority leading to increased funding for research for Agroecological zone III, in particular research on cassava farming systems, ZARI reports S3P reports Partner institutions reports PSC minutes Province and District reports S3P reports PSC minutes S3P reports District Development Plans and Annual DDCC reports District willing and able to finance 10% of total costs Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Participatory extension approaches (PEA)/Farmer field school (FFS) methodologies in target areas harmonized and upscaled. Participatory assessment of current PEA/FFS methodologies conducted. Improved access to local transport and community level infrastructure (storage, SWC) 350 small-scale community-level agricultural investments of a public nature planned by communities and implemented improved access to productivity enhancing equipment. 500 very small-scale group-level agricultural investments identified and financed. MACO M&E system strengthened Improved management of information and communication within MACO/PPD. Improved information for and opportunities for discussion with decision makers. Unqualified financial and technical audits. Timeliness and adequacy of annual work plans, budgets and reports (including M&E reports, expenditure and accounting reports). MACO M&E system revised and operational Programme planning and monitoring specialist based in MACO/PPD 5 Number and type of policy reviews and studies relevant to sustainable productivity growth and smallholder integration in markets, and related workshops and discussion forums and dialogue events Increased exposure to other Number and type of exposure visits of policy and experiences by policy and decision makers, within Zambia to programme or other decision makers. relevant sites and/or events or international relevant sites or events. Sub-component 2.3: Programme Management, Monitoring and Evaluation. PSC established and meeting regularly for S3P/SAPP AWPBs, Progress and annual reports prepared. MTR and Completion review conducted Communities willing and able to contribute at least 25% of total costs Groups willing and able to contribute at least 50% of total costs. MACO Annual report and provincial reports MIS database Advisor reports PSC minutes Policy reports Workshop reports New policies and legislation PSC minutes Study tour reports New policies and legislation PSC minutes Performance Enhancement Programme remains a priority for MACO CAADP process on-track Minutes of PSC meetings AWPB and Annual report Minutes of Joint Decision Meeings with PSC and IFAD Mid-Term Review Aide memoire and report Completion report Baseline survey and completion survey reports PSC minutes PMU established and staffed Policy and decision makers willing to participate and make evidence-based policy decisions Policy and decision makers willing to participate and make evidence-based policy decisions Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Sub-component 2.2: Support to the Policy and Planning Framework SNDP reports PSC minutes S3P reports Service provider reports SNDP reports PSC minutes S3P reports Service provider reports PSC minutes Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report I. A. STRATEGIC CONTEXT AND RATIONALE Country and Rural Development and Poverty Context 1. Zambia is a large landlocked country (753,000 km2 - the 39th largest country in the world). Its population, which grew at 2.8 per cent during the 2000s, totalled only 13 million in 2010, giving it a population density of only 17 persons/km2. Its GDP per capita currently stands at US$ 1760 (PPP); its Gini index, at over 0.50 in 2006, indicates that income distribution remains extremely unequal; and its Human Development Index of 0.395 gives it a ranking of 150th out of 169 countries, low but about average for subSaharan Africa. 2. At independence in 1964, Zambia inherited an economy which was heavily dependent on the copper mining sector (accounting more than 90% of export earnings), and a population that was close to 50 per cent urban, one of the highest rates in subSaharan Africa. After 30 years of relatively poor economic performance, Zambia’s macroeconomic situation has improved in the last 10 years: driven by the macroeconomic and public sector reforms initiated in the 1990s and propelled by rising copper prices, annual economic growth averaged 4.8 percent over the period 2002-2005 and increased to 6.1 percent over 2006-2009. Average annual inflation over 2006-2009 fell to 11 percent as compared to 20 percent during 2002-20051. Good progress has been made in seven out of the eleven MDG indicators, in particular for child malnutrition, primary education, infant mortality and the incidence of malaria. Targets on hunger, education, gender equality and HIV&AIDS are likely to be achieved by 2015. 3. National poverty levels have come down somewhat since 1998, but remain high with 64 percent of the population ranked as poor and 51 percent as extremely poor in 20062. Poverty in rural areas is significantly higher than in urban areas, and has declined less during the period since 1998 (Table 1). Female headed households are more likely to be poor than those headed by men. Table 1: Poverty levels in Zambia 1998-2006 (compiled from CSO data Annex 1). Zambia Rural Urban 1998 Poverty Extreme Incidence Poverty 73 58 83 71 56 36 2006 Poverty Extreme Incidence Poverty 64 51 80 67 34 20 4. Agriculture is the main source of income and employment for more than 60 per cent of the population, and especially for women, who constitute 65 percent of the rural population. Accelerated growth in the agriculture sector is thus key to reducing both poverty and the dependency on the mining sector. However, the sector has grown only weakly since 2000 – on average 2 per cent per year, though there were strong performances in 2003/2004, 2009/2010 and 2010/11, mainly linked to record-breaking maize harvests the last two seasons. Moreover, while between 1987 and 2010 food production increased at an average 4.3-4.4 percent per year, it was increases in the area cropped that accounted for fully 4 percent of that, while the annual productivity (yields per ha) increased at only 0.3-0.4 percent per annum (see Annex 1). 5. The smallholder farming sector numbers approximately 1.1 million households, over 20 per cent of which are headed by women. These households cultivate on average 1.5 ha of land, generally using low-input, hand hoe technology and relying primarily upon family labour. They produce principally for household consumption, although about one-third sell some of their production, while at the other extreme, about one quarter suffer chronic food insecurity and require long-term social protection. These are often 1 2 Sixth National Development Plan 2011-2015. Central Statistical Office: Poverty Trends Report, 1996 – 2006. 7 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report female-, elderly- or child-headed households, the chronically sick and/or disabled 1. In addition, there are some 50,000 emergent farmers, who cultivate between 5 and 20 ha, typically with draught power, greater use of purchased inputs, and hired labour; and their production is predominantly for sale. The vast majority of such farmers operate along the line-of-rail that traverses the country from south-west to north-east. There are some 1500 large-scale commercial farmers, included a sizeable number of Zimbabweans who have relocated to Zambia, who generally cultivate upwards of 50 ha, have extensive mechanization and use both permanent and casual staff. There is also a limited number of large corporate operations, farming thousand of hectares of crops and/or with a thousand or more head of livestock, that are managed by hired professionals and vertical integrated to agro-processing. 6. Smallholder farming systems vary according to the agro-ecological conditions across the country. In the northern half of the country, cassava is the main staple and the basis for the production system. In the southern half of the country, maize is the main food crop; while in the centre, there are mixed maize/cassava systems. Overall, agricultural production is dominated by maize, which is grown by 80 per cent of farming households and in 2010 covered over half the area planted. Maize production is strongly promoted by the Government of Zambia (GRZ) through: (a) a targeted subsidized Farm Input Supply Programme (FISP); and (b) a guaranteed maize purchase programme by the Food Reserve Agency (FRA), which in recent years has offered above market farmgate prices. Other important smallholder crops include beans, groundnuts, rice, cotton, tobacco, sugar cane and vegetables. Some 20 per cent of smallholders own cattle, mainly in the drier southern part of the country, where draft power is a key element of the cropping systems and permit larger areas to be cultivated than in the north, where lack of labour is the principal constraint to increased production. Poultry are much more widespread, owned by over 90 per cent of households. 7. Conservation farming practices have been widely promoted in Zambia, and around 180,000 small-scale farmers have adopted some elements of conservation farming. However, the techniques used are those that have been developed specifically for the maize-based farming systems in the dryer parts of the country, while the main cassava based farming systems are mostly located in more humid regions with acidic soils, for which appropriate CF techniques still need to be developed. 8. An estimated 300,000, or one quarter of all, smallholders are currently linked to agribusiness through more or less vertically integrated value chains, for crops such as cotton, tobacco, sugarcane and horticultural crops. Outside these value chains, low population densities mean that for many farmers agricultural markets are distant, uncompetitive and unremunerative, all of which creates little incentive for increased production. This is one of the factors behind the low productivity of the smallholder sector. Another is the plentiful availability of arable land, which means that expanding the area under cultivation, rather than intensifying the production system, remains a possibility for a majority of smallholder farmers. Lack of education – over 70 per cent of smallholder farmers have only primary education – and entrepreneurial skills; high dependency rates and seasonal labour constraints, combined with high levels of disease and hunger during the growing season; plus the devastating effects of HIV/AIDS, also all undermine farmers’ productive capacity. So too do farmers’ lack of financial assets. Growing climatic variability and extremes, and declining soil fertility and soil acidity also adversely affect agricultural production. In addition, animal diseases and deaths in the 1990s, especially in southern Zambia, have undermined productive capacity. 9. Land-rights of smallholders are in general considered relatively secure. However, land is starting to become a constraint in some more densely populated areas; in some parts of the country the land rights of women – particularly widows – are not secure; 1 World Bank Report No. 36573-ZM, January 9, 2007: Zambia Smallholder Agriculture Commercialization Strategy. 8 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report and there are some concerns regarding the conversion of customary land to leasehold land, in particular for larger (sometimes foreign) investors. A draft Land Policy aims (among other things) to strengthen decentralised land administration systems and the registration of customary lands, but the finalisation of this policy has been protracted. 10. Agricultural extension services are provided through MACO, donor-funded projects/ programmes, NGOs, churches, the Zambia National Farmers Union (ZNFU) and the private sector, all to a large extent using MACO staff. MACO’s institutional structure comprises the Departments of Policy and Planning; Agriculture; Cooperatives, Agribusiness and Marketing; Administration and Finance; and Human Resources, as well as Institutes for Research and for Seed Certification. The structure is replicated at provincial and district levels; and each district is split up into blocks, and further into camps, each one (in theory) with a front-line Camp Extension Officer (CEO). MACO promotes participatory extension approaches, but is challenged by its limited institutional capacity at different levels. Field staff play key roles, but positions are sometimes vacant and staff are often poorly trained and/or ill equipped. 11. In 2009, MACO identified its major capacity development needs as being in five key areas: (a) informing and strengthening its policy analysis and decision-making processes; (b) reviewing its functions, role and capacities for services provision and for co-ordination; (c) building modern budget, planning and financial systems from national to district levels; (d) modernising its human resources management and development; and (e) modernising its knowledge management and technology (ICT). Particular concerns have been MACO’s monitoring and evaluation systems and the lack of priority given to financial management and control. All of these issues are to be tackled under a forthcoming EU-financed Performance Enhancement Programme (PEP). Two other areas in which MACO has lagged are in relation to public-private partnerships and to decentralisation. In both these areas however, some progress is now being made. 12. Other key institutions in the agricultural sector are the research organizations: the Zambia Agricultural Research Institute (ZARI), the non-profit agency Golden Valley Agricultural Research Trust (GART), and a variety of other public and private agencies conducting research on crops, livestock and fisheries. The Zambia National Farmers Union (ZNFU) and its affiliate Conservation Farming Unit (CFU) is a national membership-based organization for all types of farmers in Zambia; and at local level farmer organizations include primary and district cooperatives, promoted by MACO over many years, and the District Farmers Associations (DFA) that are affiliated to the ZNFU. 13. An apparent high priority given by GRZ to the agriculture sector has not generally been reflected in its budget allocation: as a share of total expenditure, agriculture effectively received an average of 3 per cent between 1994 and 2002. It rose gradually to over 12 per cent in 2007, before falling to 8 per cent in 2008 and 2009 and less than 7 per cent in 2010. However, of this up to 45 per cent is used on FISP and the FRA’s purchases of maize; and this has squeezed the budgets for other MACO activities. Public investments in key activities such as livestock extension, support to crops other than maize, and agricultural research remain at a low level; and activities at field level are particularly affected. In addition, donor support to the sector has declined considerably in recent years, from over K400 billion in 2007 to less than K190 billion in 2011. B. Rationale 14. The sector policy framework for S3P is set by variety of agricultural development policies and strategies: the National Agricultural Policy 2004-2015 (NAP); the National Development Plans; and the Comprehensive African Agriculture Development Plan (CAADP) principles embraced by Government. All of these support the national Vision 2030, which aims for Zambia to become “a prosperous middle-income country by 2030”. 15. The NAP presents a vision for the agricultural sector as being “to promote development of an efficient, competitive and sustainable agricultural sector, which 9 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report assures food security and increased income”; and its main thrusts are increased production, sector liberalization, commercialization, promotion of public and private sector partnerships, and provision of effective services to ensure sustainable agricultural growth. The Sixth National Development Plan 2011-2015 (SNDP), launched in February 2011, highlights the urgency of economic diversification. Its vision for the agricultural sector – one of five key growth sectors identified – reconfirms that of the NAP, while its goal is “to increase and diversify agriculture production and productivity so as to raise the share of its contribution to 20 percent of GDP by end-2015”. The Plan identifies a number of strategic priorities for the crop production, livestock and fisheries sub-sectors; and it also gives emphasis to promoting post-harvest technologies, agro-processing and access to domestic, regional and international markets for agro-products. In support of SNDP, Zambia signed its CAADP Compact in January 2011. The Compact comprises five programmes, for sustainable land management; agricultural productivity improvement; agricultural marketing development and investment promotion; food and nutrition security; and research, seeds and extension enhancement. It also commits GRZ to agriculture marketing and credit acts; fertilizer distribution reforms – and particularly the use of e-vouchers; and reconfirms an expanded role for the private sector. 16. Accelerated growth in smallholder agriculture hinges on both marketing and productivity, and key elements of GRZ policy have been the embracing of the commercialization of small-scale agriculture as the main driver of poverty reduction by generating sustainable incomes from “farming as a business”. Agribusiness is encouraged to strengthen market linkages between smallholder farmers and consumers through increased private sector participation in service delivery, such as in input supply, output marketing and agro-processing. 17. The IFAD Country Strategic Opportunities Programme for Zambia (COSOP) for 2011-2015 is aligned with the National Agricultural Policy and SNDP’s goal for the agricultural sector. Its goal is to increase the incomes, improve the food security and reduce the vulnerability of rural people living in poverty. It includes three Strategic Objectives (SOs). 18. Strategic Objective 1: Access to, and participation in, expanded and more competitive markets by poor rural men and women are increased, within more efficient value chains. The objective will be achieved through an array of interventions along value chains for specific commodities (crop, livestock, fisheries and forest-derived) of particular importance to smallholder producers. Improved market access would provide incentives for smallholder farmers to increase the productivity and sustainability of their farm systems, which will be facilitated through complementary support provided under the programme. The recently started Smallholder Agribusiness Promotion Programme (SAPP) will be the main delivery vehicle for this objective; opportunities for a NTFP commercialisation project could also be explored during the period 2013-2015. 19. Strategic Objective 2: Access to and use of technologies and services for enhanced productivity, sustainability and resilience of smallholder production systems are increased. Achieving this objective will involve the strengthening and diversification of service provision (the supply), as well as the strengthening of farmer capacity to productively draw on and use these services (the demand). It will require a focus on improving the access to, and use, of improved technologies for crop and livestock production, as well as more sustainable land management by smallholder households. The proposed Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) will contribute to the achievement of this objective. 20. Strategic Objective 3: Access to and use of sustainable financial services by poor rural men and women are increased. The objective will be achieved through a systematic approach to rural financial services development, encompassing community-based financial institutions, MFIs and commercial banks, as well as the policy framework for rural financial services. It will support the other strategic objectives of the country programme related to agricultural production and marketing, as well as 10 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report supporting non-farm rural enterprises. The delivery vehicles will be the ongoing Rural Finance Programme (RFP), which will continue until 2013, and a possible follow-up intervention. 21. IFAD’s experience with agricultural and rural development projects in Zambia has been varied, though it has gradually improved over time, in large part as a result of the growing impact of having an IFAD country office and stronger, IFAD-conducted implementation support. A first set of lessons learnt (see Annex 3) points to the importance of simple project designs, strong yet accountable project management units, and enhanced country ownership. Second, the project completion report for the Smallholder Enterprise and Marketing Programme (SHEMP) highlighted two key issues: the importance of rural roads as a precondition for agricultural and rural development; and the importance of production support to enable farmers to increase their productivity and respond to the demands of the market in response to the new opportunities created through the value chain projects, SHEMP and the follow-up SAPP. Third, one of the key lessons relating to the country programme is the fact that there has been insufficient collaboration and learning between projects; this is something that needs to change. 22. The design for S3P seeks to build on these lessons, as well as those of other donor-supported projects in Zambia. It also takes up the theme, highlighted in the COSOP, of working with GRZ to promote ‘smart’ government, involving new ways of working with the private sector. Government is still at an early stage of implementing these principles, and IFAD can provide it support in developing appropriate models and piloting partnerships, and in promoting “farming as a business”. In addition, S3P is explicitly designed to complement and reinforce SAPP, with SAPP focussing on marketing and value chains of selected commodities, while S3P promotes productivity increases in the farming systems that have these commodities as basis. Effectively, SAPP focuses on the demand-pull side of the value chains of these commodities, while S3P will work on the supply-push side. Both are considered innovative programmes within Zambia and will serve as vehicles for further learning and policy dialogue, and will contribute to MACO’s transformation in support of “farming as a business”. 23. Finally, S3P will actively seek opportunities for collaboration with others of GRZ’s development partners. The programme will be co-financed by the government of Finland, which will provide opportunity for close collaboration and synergies in particular with the Finnish-supported Luapula Agricultural and Rural Development programme (PLARD), which is piloting and implementing some of the activities that S3P can learn from, and where appropriate scale-up. The programme will also be closely coordinated with the capacity development efforts of the EU-financed PEP. Concrete opportunities for collaboration exist also with other development partners, including JICA, USAID and the other Rome-based agencies; and these will be exploited by the programme. 24. The starting point for S3P is the value chains associated with a limited number of selected commodities on which SAPP focuses its efforts. The commodities promoted under SAPP have been selected according to: the extent to which they are grown by, and offer market opportunities to, large numbers of smallholder farmers – and particularly for women and young farmers; their importance or significance for both household food security and sales income; the extent to which the value chain can be up-scaled; and the opportunities offered for value addition at farm level. Using these screening criteria, cassava and mixed beans (Phaseolus sp.), rice, goats/village chickens and fish1 have all been selected by stakeholders (government and non-government) for programme engagement. Detailed analysis of these value chains started in the second quarter 2011. 1 Village chickens, goats and fish will not be retained by S3P, mainly because of the recent creation of a separate Ministry of Livestock and Fisheries Development (MLFD), which would make implementation arrangements more complex. 11 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 25. Cassava holds a primary role in Zambia’s food security, as a buffer against grain shortages. It represents 17 per cent of the area cropped with staples, accounts for 26 per cent of the total production of staple crops and for an estimated 20 per cent of national calories consumed. Though the potential for cassava production and value chains is significant, with potential demand estimated at 4 million Mt1, at present low productivity and lack of market linkages mean that the cassava sector is not as viable from a business point of view as some other crops. It is grown by about 400,000 smallholders, about two-thirds of whom are found in Luapula and Northern Provinces. In these provinces more than 80 percent of the rural population depend on cassava for food security, with both men and women involved in farming, primary processing and trading. Productivity is generally low, with yields averaging 7 tons per hectare, and there is substantial scope for increasing both yields and sales of cassava in the two provinces (see Annex 1, Table 3). Apart from cassava, the cash crops grown in these farming systems include maize, mixed beans, rice, groundnuts and millets. II. A. PROGRAMME DESCRIPTION Programme Area and Target Group 26. S3P will adopt a phased approach to implementation. It will start in Project Year (PY) 1 in eight districts in Luapula and Northern Provinces, expanding to 16 districts in PY2, and further expanding to a third province and a total of 24 districts in PY3. The initial programme area (PY1 and PY2) is determined by the main area of cassava-based farming systems: within the two targeted provinces high potential districts will be prioritized, with as main criterion that they should be important cassava and/or mixed beans production areas, with the highest potential to increase marketable surpluses (see Map and Table 3 in Annex 1). Expansion of the area in PY3 will allow the Programme to respond to the new market opportunities identified under SAPP, including for other commodities: areas with high smallholder market potential for, for example, rice and groundnuts (though possibly a number of other crops) could be brought into the programme. Within the total 24 districts, clusters of agricultural camps will be prioritized for intensive support, using the same criteria, up to a maximum of 150 camps in total. 27. Unlike in many countries, there are not major regional differences in poverty rates across the country. Excluding Lusaka and Copper Belt Provinces, which have a high proportion of their populations living in the urban areas, all the other 7 provinces in the country have rates of poverty between 72 and 79 per cent, with the rates in the rural areas generally over 80 per cent. Northern Province ranks the second highest in poverty incidence and extreme poverty in 2006 (78 and 64 per cent respectively), and Luapula the third highest (73 per cent and 61 per cent respectively). Food insecurity and malnutrition are prevalent in these provinces, as stunting among preschool- and schoolage children is highest in Luapula (about 50 per cent and 51 per cent), followed by Northern Province (also around 50 per cent, compared to a national average of 42 per cent and 31 per cent respectively)2. Further, Luapula and Northern Provinces reportedly have some of the highest prevalence of chronic energy deficiency among women (13-14 per cent compared to national average of 10 per cent). Similarly, Luapula and Northern Provinces’ average share of household expenditure on food, typically expressing the extent of poverty and food security, were reported among the highest range in the country (between 60-67 per cent)(see also Annex 2). 28. Agro-ecological characteristics. Luapula and Northern Provinces are located in the so-called Agro-Ecological Region (AER) III, at altitudes that range from 1,100-1,700 metres above sea level, except for the Luapula Valley (along the border with the Democratic Republic of Congo), with land below 1,000 metres asl. The mean annual rainfall in this region exceeds 1,000 mm and the length of the growing season varies 1 2 Zambia Cassava Sector Development Strategy 2010-2015. MACO, ACP, ITC, FAO, IITA, ACF. Central Statistic Office (CSO) 2009. 12 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report from 120 to 150 days. The soils are highly weathered, leached and acidic, with pH of less than 4.5, very low soil organic matter content and very low reserves of primary minerals. They are usually deficient in phosphorous, nitrogen and many other major plant nutrients and some micro-nutrients. Though these soils have serious chemical limitations to plant growth, their physical properties are mostly favourable. 29. Traditional slash and burn agriculture (Chitemene) is still widely practiced, although in some areas close to the main road axes, farmers are already moving towards more settled systems. However, doing so, and gradually shifting towards more intensive farming systems, requires drastic changes in soil management, so as to increase soil organic matter content and pH, enhance the sustainability of the farming systems and promote greater resilience to climatic variability (flooding and drought). Within this perspective, conservation farming and agro-forestry technologies appear to be the most promising options. However, the CF and agro-forestry technologies promoted in Zambia have mainly been developed for the dryer, maize-based production systems of AERs I and II, and they still need to be fully adapted to AER III. 30. The target group would consist of productive small-scale/ smallholder rural farmers (with cropped area up to 5 ha) organized in groups and/or cooperatives, or willing to join such groups. As much as 80 per cent of smallholders are below the poverty line. Many already devote part of their farming system to market-oriented production and have joined an enterprise group or common interest group, but their commercial activities are constrained by poor market access and weak bargaining power. Others remain semi-subsistence farmers who primarily grow food crops but occasionally sell surpluses. 31. Woman farmers and female headed households are common in both groups, as are households affected by HIV/AIDS, but women are reported as more disadvantaged, with less assets and opportunities to engage in commercial agriculture. Division of labour is differentiated, with fields and farming activities partially separate along gender lines. Women are overburdened with subsistence farming and other household chores. When subsistence-oriented, household-based enterprises dominated by women become more commercial, husbands are likely to become more involved. Men control most income from the sale of (cash) crops. 32. The target group is characterized by low asset-based, precarious livelihoods with comparatively low resilience to shocks. Under stress low-asset households are likely to fall back into conditions of vulnerability and extreme poverty. In these situations, they are forced to rely on traditional coping strategies such as skipping meals, reducing dietary diversity, engaging in causal labour on farms or other occupations at low rates, depending on familial social networks, bartering, selling assets, pulling children out of school etc.1 Vulnerability is due to a complexity of factors: weakened social capital, the high prevalence of HIV/AIDS, climatic shocks such as droughts and flooding, lack of capital to expand agricultural activities, low levels of education and, notably, isolation and distance from economic and social services, including markets, schools and health facilities. An important factor keeping households strapped in this cycle is low production and productivity, resulting in low incomes. The project aims to support these households by improving their access to improved, services and infrastructure that respond to farmers’ particular conditions and asset base. 33. For many smallholders lack of labour is a more critical constraint to increased production than lack of land. This situation is particularly acute for households with conditions that worsen labour availability, notably female-headed and those affected by HIV/AIDS. Reportedly, about 60 percent of rural families have lost family members due to HIV/AIDs. This is putting stress on the extended family system as already vulnerable families take in more dependent members, raising the burden of acquiring enough food. The phenomenon of child-headed households has also been rising, particularly limiting 1 IFAD (2006) Study on Poverty and Targeting in Eastern and Southern Africa: Zambia Country Report, and (2008) Zambia: Vulnerability Assessment Committee (ZVAC) 13 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report opportunities for the girl child, often withdrawn from school to help with home care of sick members1. On this specific issue, S3P foresees activities related to adaptive research on tools and equipment (including for transport), in view of increasing labour productivity; as well as promoting investments in agro-processing technologies which will result in freeing significant time for women in particular. 34. Direct beneficiaries. Agricultural camps in the target areas consist of 1,0001,500 rural smallholder households (Luapula and Northern Provinces respectively). The S3P aims at working in a total of about 150 camps distributed over these, plus a third province, reaching an average of 200 smallholder households per camp. These will participate directly in the main S3P activities, notably Farmer Field School-type groups (about 10 groups per camp), to improve access to technologies and markets. The core target group will therefore consist of 30,000 participating smallholder households, equivalent to around 150,000 people2, or about 20 per cent of the rural population in targeted camps (Table 2 below). At least half these participants are expected to be women farmers - an expectation based on the experience under SHEMP, where 62 per cent of the members of the groups supported were women. The programme will work with groups of farmers, where group members are involved in small-scale cassava and/or mixed bean production systems (which includes groundnuts in rotation with other crops) and/or rice, or are interested in growing rice. Groups will range in extent of formality (from cooperatives to “clubs”) and diversity of membership will be encouraged, e.g. women, youth, members from disadvantaged households. 35. The core target group also includes those farmers who: (i) gain access to improved planting material (sub-component 1.3), as well as other technological improvements through farmer organizations (sub-component 1.1) and/or partners (subcomponent 1.2); and (ii) households who benefit from improved community investments and infrastructure (sub-component 2.1), but which are not counted above. This second direct group is estimated to consist of a further 30,000 smallholder households, equivalent to some 150,000 people or 20 per cent of the population in targeted camps. 36. The total number of participants and direct beneficiaries of the programme will therefore amount to 60,000 households, equivalent to 300,000 people, or 40 per cent of the population of targeted camps (Table 2 below). Table 2. Summary of Participants and Beneficiaries Description Provinces targeted Districts targeted Coverage Luapula, Northern and third Province 24 districts in 3 Provinces Agricultural Camps targeted for intensive support 150 Farmer groups and households targeted 1,500 groups with 30,000 smallholder HHs (150,000 people) Other farmers/HHs in target area benefitting from improved planting material, seeds, advisory services and/or community infrastructure Total direct beneficiaries 1 2 Assumptions About 30% of total camps in 3 provinces. Average 1,000 HHs per camp 10 groups per camp 20 HHs pr group 5 persons/HH 30,000 smallholder HHs (150,000 people) 20% of camp HHs 60,000 smallholder HHs (300,000 persons) About 40% of total population of targeted camps Chiwele D. et all (2004) for FAO. Agricultural Development and Food Security in Sub-Saharan Africa: A Case Study of Zambia; and NAP draft (2011). Average size of 5 persons/household; Zambia Census 2000. 14 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 37. Indirect beneficiaries would include smallholder producers of cassava, mixed beans/groundnuts who do not live in the targeted camps, but who would nevertheless (in due course) be able to gain access to improved technologies (in particular improved crop varieties and CF technologies) generated by S3P. 38. Self-targeting. Once the programme areas are defined through a process of geographic targeting, a self-targeting approach will be activated in complement with SAPP. Self-targeting in S3P, in complement to SAPP, will be guided by the core criteria of smallholder farmers who are already organised in farmer groups (producer groups, cooperatives, informal associations etc.) or are willing and have potential to join such groups, and potential to be linked to markets (see SAPP WP1). The targeting strategy will be inclusive, determined by farmer interest and willingness to comply with programme procedures. Farmers in all ranges of small-scale cassava and/or mixed bean production systems as well as rice growers in areas of concentration, will be eligible as direct beneficiaries of programme support. 39. To ensure adequate gender mainstreaming in S3P, a pro-active gender targeting would be incorporated through a gender mainstreaming strategy that will be crosscutting throughout all programme interventions and aligns with both IFAD and GRZ policies. In addition to ensuring equal opportunities, special attention is required to promote participation of women in the range of programme activities and access to benefits. This will require monitoring not only of quantitative achievements but also of qualitative changes (e.g. leading roles played by women, gradual changes of women’s roles and voice in the household and in groups); the results will guide programme implementation. A minimum target of 30 percent female beneficiaries will be used regarding participation in capacity building activities and for the disbursement of matching grants to groups. Should women not be gaining access to programme benefits as intended, direct targeting measures would be considered. B. Programme Development Objective 40. The Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) has as its overall goal that Income levels, food and nutrition security are sustainably improved for poor agricultural households in target areas. The indicators at the goal level include: up to 48,000 smallholder households (80 per cent of direct beneficiaries) achieve at least one of the following by programme completion: (i) an increase in household asset ownership; (ii) an increase in household savings; (iii) reduction in prevalence of child malnutrition; and (iv) a reduction in food insecurity (see Logical Framework). 41. The S3P purpose or development objective is that production, productivity and sales of smallholder farmers in target areas are sustainably increased. The associated indicators include: (i) average crop yields of cassava, rice, mixed beans and/or groundnuts of 30,000 smallholder households are increased by at least 30 percent; (ii) the quantities of cassava, rice, mixed beans and/or groundnuts marketed by 40,000 smallholder households are increased by at least 20 percent; (iii) the vulnerability of 10,000 smallholder households to climatic variation affecting crop production and/or market access is reduced. 42. S3P is closely linked to SAPP and the commodities selected under SAPP, in particular cassava, rice and mixed beans. Initially, S3P will operate exclusively in the cassava-based farming systems common to the Northern and Luapula Provinces. The productivity of these farming systems will be enhanced, as will that of the main crops cultivated under these systems: cassava, rice, mixed beans and groundnuts1. 1 SAPP does not yet focus on opportunities in the groundnut value chain, however it will be requested to analyse the market opportunities offered by groundnuts, with a view to possibly including it. 15 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report C. Components and Outcomes 43. S3P will adopt a phased programmatic approach and will have a duration of seven years. The programme will have two components, each of which are divided into three subcomponents: (i) Sustainable smallholder productivity growth; and (ii) Enabling environment for productivity growth. See Annex 4 for a detailed description of components and outcomes. 44. Component 1: Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth (US$ 24.2 million) with as its objective to: improve smallholders access to, and ability to use, knowledge, extension1, adapted technologies and improved planting material. Component key outcomes include: (a) targeted farmer groups and organizations function more effectively and are empowered to respond to market and rural development opportunities; (b) smallholder farmers in target areas have improved access to more relevant and effective advisory services delivered by MACO as well as farmer organizations and/or private sector; and (c) agricultural research and seed multiplication services respond better to priority needs of smallholders. This component includes three sub-components: 1.1 strengthening farmer organizations and their federations; 1.2 pluralistic participatory extension services; and 1.3 agricultural research for development. 45. Sub-component 1.1: Strengthening farmer organizations and their federations, with as its objective to strengthen membership-based farmers associations and cooperatives and their federations at camp and district level to improve and diversify the offer of services to farmers. Farmer groups, associations and/or cooperatives and their federations provide services which go beyond, but include, both technical advisory services as well as marketing services (for instance bulking). These organizations already exist at camp, block and district level, but their effectiveness is variable depending on why and how they were formed, their cohesiveness and management capacity and the support they have received. The nature of the support provided by the programme would be determined by the development stage groups have reached. 46. S3P will strengthen existing farmer organizations, assist interested farmers who are not yet organized to become organized, and support federations of farmer associations and cooperatives to increase their membership base. It targets 10 district level farmers associations and/or cooperative unions (i.e 50 per cent of overall targeted districts) and 750 farmer groups with 20,000 members. Implementation will be outsourced and activities will include: (i) a detailed assessment of the existing farmers organizations and their federations in the target areas, their level of development and capacity, the quality of the services they offer to their members, and their main capacity development requirements; (ii) provision of the training and capacity building as per identified needs, for instance on group formation and group dynamics, leadership skills, governance, entrepreneurship skills and business planning (farming as a business), financial management, accounting and legal aspects; and (iii) follow-up and on-the-job mentoring of federative structures at district level in terms of developing capacities of coordination and service provision. Once a group has sufficiently matured (see Annex 4 for a description of development stages), S3P would assist it to link up to financial institutions that promote saving and credit activities, such as for instance those supported through the IFAD-financed Rural Finance Programme (RFP). It would also seek to explore the issue of identifying a sustainable institutional development path for them. 47. Sub-component 1.2: Pluralistic participatory extension services, with as objective to improve the access, quality and sustainability of advisory services available to smallholders in the target areas. Extension services are “pluralistic” when there is a diversity of providers, for instance by government, by farmer organizations, and by the private/non-government sector. S3P will support different sources of advisory services to farmers: MACO, membership-based farmer organizations, private or commercial 1 In this document, extension and advisory services are used synonymous. 16 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report enterprises and non-governmental organizations (NGOs). These provide complementary services, while each contributes to long-term sustainability of advisory service delivery to farmers. “Participatory” extension approaches provide the opportunity for on-farm testing and development of technical options which effectively respond to farmers’ needs. This is done through farmer-led trials and demonstrations, promotion of farmerto-farmer learning, farmer organization knowledge exchange networks, and access to information platforms using modern information and communications technologies (ICT). 48. S3P will promote an extension process in which: (a) farmers are organized and empowered to demand quality support services; (b) service providers work with organized market-oriented farmer groups; (c) collaboration between MACO and nongovernment service providers is promoted; (d) ICT for information access and feedback are increasingly used; and (e) cross-cutting issues, such as gender and HIV/AIDS are mainstreamed. Since the strengthening of farmer organizations is already covered under sub-component 1.1, the activities under sub-component 1.2 are limited to: (i) strengthening of MACO field capacities; (ii) harmonization of participatory extension services; and (iii) partnerships with other providers of extension. 49. Strengthening MACO field capacities, at Provincial and District levels, including support for: (i) a facilitator, based in the office of the Provincial Agricultural Coordinator (PACO), to assist in planning, coordination, information and knowledge management and M&E; (ii) quarterly provincial level agricultural planning and review meetings with the participation of the District Agricultural Coordinators (DACOs), provincial agricultural research stations, donor-supported project representatives, and other relevant partners; (iii) quarterly district level agricultural planning and review meetings for district staff, district planning officers and representatives of the provincial agricultural research stations, donor-supported MACO projects and other partners; (iv) provincial and district procurement and financial management training and technical support; (v) information and knowledge sharing: exchange visits, participation in knowledge events, production and distribution of communication/information material; and (vi) providing mobility, housing and solar panels for CEOs where needed and appropriate. 50. Harmonization and upscaling of participatory extension approaches (PEA) within MACO and the different donor supported MACO projects, including support to: (i) assess the various diverse extension methodologies that have been, or are currently being, used in Zambia and elsewhere (including those that use ICT); (ii) prepare a harmonized curriculum for training of trainers (ToT) in PEA/FFS approach including a module on basic business planning; (iii) conduct ToT at provincial level and form master trainers to (iv) conduct ToT at district level, targeting CEOs and lead farmers as facilitators, who (v) are expected to facilitate between one and three FFS each cropping season; and (vi) regular refresher training sessions for MACO field staff. The ToTs will also be open to representatives of farmer organizations and the private/non-government sector. 51. Partnerships with organizations providing advisory services. At present, some private/non-government initiatives target smallholders through similar types and methods of activities promoted by S3P (and SAPP) 1. They are successfully engaging smallholders in organized bulking, marketing, and processing of mainly mixed beans, groundnuts and rice; they provide relevant advisory services to smallholders to ensure regular supply and desired quality of farm products. The services provided are at present partially financed by the profit margin of the processing and marketing business, and could in future be totally financed by the latter. Some of these private/non-government service providers have gained considerable outreach and experience in the S3P target areas and constitute an important asset that could be further strengthened to serve a larger number of farmers within a framework for pluralistic extension services. 1 Two relevant initiatives are: (i) the COMACO enterprise supported by the Wildlife Conservation Society serving 45,000 farmers, providing business training, investing in local bulking, transport and processing units for rice, beans, groundnuts and soya beans and creating market outlets both at national and international level; and (ii) SNV specialising on rice value chain and providing assistance throughout the chain including support to the newly founded Zambia Rice federation. 17 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 52. At the same time, MACO has established a committee specifically to identify opportunities for promoting non-government provision of extension services (complementary to those already provided by MACO). Working closely with SAPP, S3P can support this initiative, working in two main areas. First, it would finance studies and reviews to help the committee both to identify opportunities where pluralistic service provision in the agricultural sector can add value, and to define the key roles for MACO in promoting, managing and monitoring service providers. These could also identify how ICT can be used to contribute to improved extension services; and address and mainstream cross-cutting issues, such as gender and HIV/AIDS. Second, it would finance pilot projects for the non-government provision of extension-related services. These would be realised through: (i) public-private partnerships (PPPs) where the private or non-government partner shares similar objectives, but needs additional support or resources to up-scale activities in the target areas; and (ii) more straightforward contracting in cases where PPPs might not be possible or would be less desirable. 53. Sub-component 1.3: Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D), with as its objective to complement on-going GRZ and other partners’ initiatives to strengthen strategic on-station and on-farm research capacities to broaden the technology options for increased smallholder productivity. Potential technology options to increase smallholder productivity range from: (a) improved certified seed and planting material; (b) integrated soil fertility and crop management techniques that allow for and facilitate the shift from traditional extensive slash-and-burn (chitemene) to more intensive and more permanent farming systems, for which conservation agriculture and agro-forestry appear to be promising options; and (c) improved tools, equipment and techniques that reduce labour requirements or peaks of intensive labour requirements. 54. S3P support of adaptive research will involve: (i) strategic agricultural research for development (AR4D) in support to on-going ZARI research programmes, integrating technical support from regional/ international research institutions and programmes; (ii) competitive AR4D, driven by partnerships involving different agricultural research institutions such as ZARI, GART, the University of Zambia (UNZA), and the private/nongovernment sector; (iii) promoting farmer participation in identifying research priorities and in implementing and evaluating AR4D; (iv) instituting provincial- and district-level AR4D platforms as part of the quarterly agricultural review and planning meetings included under sub-component 1.2; and (v) building an integrated research-extension information management platform. Specific activities include: (a) adaptive research for improved varieties and cropping practices; (b) participatory research on integrated soil fertility management practices, conservation Agriculture (CA) and agro-forestry practices; (c) research on adapted tools/equipment; and (d) access to improved Seeds and Planting Material. 55. Adaptive research for improved varieties and cropping practices, to support: (i) on-going on-station breeding and selection programmes for cassava (ZARI’s Mansa station in Luapula Province), beans (ZARI’s Misamfu Research Station in Northern Province) and possibly rice and groundnuts; (ii) participatory researcher and farmer-led on-farm trials for most advanced lines, as well as improved cropping practices, especially Integrated Pest and Production Management (IPPM) practices; (iii) specialised technical assistance and support from international institutions (IITA for cassava, CIRAD for conservation agriculture, CIAT for beans, for example). The programme will finance some up-grading of research infrastructure of research stations and some equipment. 56. Adaptation of conservation agriculture, agro-forestry and other improved cropping practices. One of the main factors limiting agricultural productivity in the programme areas is the low soil fertility (low organic matter content and soil acidity). It is therefore imperative to continue working on identifying integrated soil fertility management practices, including those that go under the label of conservation and agro-forestry technologies adapted to the local agro-ecological and socio-economic conditions. This research would be undertaken by ZARI in a partnership with GART and 18 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report farmers’ organizations and would complement existing efforts being undertaken with the support of the CFU, GART and FAO. 57. Research on adapted tools/equipment, including for transport, and on-farm postharvest technologies. S3P will support research related to improving labour productivity and, therefore, competitiveness of commodities produced in the project area. Labour availability is an important factor limiting agricultural growth and solutions to this issue are fundamental to significantly improve production. Labour saving equipment and agro-processing technologies adapted to local climate for cassava and other crops need to be developed. The research will be conducted by the post-harvest unit in ZARI, in collaboration with IITA in the case of cassava technology, private industries and other partners as required. 58. Access to improved seeds and planting material. Cassava, mixed beans and other neglected crops are not of commercial interest to the private seed sector. Therefore, farmer-based multiplication of high quality seed/planting material will be promoted and strengthened for sustainability, with support to: (i) the maintenance of breeder and foundation seed stock by specialised commodity research programmes in ZARI; (ii) first multiplication at district level); (iii) second multiplication at camp level whereby by farmer groups and/or specialized seed producer groups/individuals; (iv) adapted certification (Quality Declared Seeds) support to be provided by the Seed Control & Certification Institute (SCCI); and (v) strengthened local agro-dealer networks. In addition to the support for cassava and mixed beans, the project would support the work undertaken by ZARI in Kasama with the support from JICA and SNV related to the purification of local varieties of rice used in the project area. 59. Component 2: Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth (US$ 17.7 million) will address critical constraints in the enabling environment for smallholder productivity growth, including: (i) improved rural infrastructure and improved access to productivity enhancing equipment and assets; (ii) the policy and institutional framework to provide the necessary support services; and (iii) programme coordination, management and monitoring and evaluation. 60. Sub-component 2.1: Local Agricultural Investments will help finance investments that improve access to markets, increase labour productivity, reduce postharvest losses, improve land and water management, or facilitate access to knowledge. This sub-component, which will start in PY2, will provide conditional partial grants for eligible agricultural investments, as well as technical and facilitation assistance to prepare the investment requests and help ensure correct implementation, operation and maintenance. Access to resources will be according to defined criteria that outline beneficiary eligibility and eligible type of investments. Three categories of investment will be established, each with specific procedures and internal control mechanisms. Financial allocations between the three categories will be flexible, according to demand. 61. District-level agricultural investments of a strategic nature, such as: (i) improvement of feeder roads connecting productive smallholder areas to main roads; and (ii) rehabilitation of district Farmer Training Centres or Farm Institutes. All such investments would be conditional on there being a sound and credible business plan for the sustainable operation and management of the infrastructure financed. S3P contribution to such investments will be up to 90 percent of total costs, with a ceiling equivalent to US$ 250,000 per sub-project. Investments that would normally be undertaken by the private sector are not eligible for support. Sub-projects will be identified by the communities and, after approval at district level, included in the District Development Plan. The proposals will then be reviewed by the PACO, and (depending on the amount) submitted through the Programme Management Unit (PMU) for final review and approval by the Programme Steering Committee (PSC). If the cost per sub-project averages US$ 100,000, a total of 40 sub-projects could be financed from the allocation. 62. Community-level agricultural investments of a public nature, including for instance: (i) spot improvement of agricultural roads, such as culverts, fords or small 19 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report bridges; (ii) small-scale storage sheds and drying floors; and (iii) small-scale water management or soil erosion control structures. Proposals will originate at the farmer group, cooperative or community level, and will be submitted though the local structures for the review of the DACO, and final approval by the PACO where the total investment is within his/her approval ceiling (currently ZK20 million / US$ 4,400), and – through the PMU - by the PSC where it is beyond this. S3P will provide facilitation services for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening and construction. Requesting groups or communities will need to meet eligibility criteria, while the proposals will need to include realistic operation and management plans. S3P contribution will be up to 75 percent of construction costs, with a ceiling of US$ 25,000 per sub-project. The total S3P co-financing amount is set at US$3.5 million (though this could be increased or decreased depending on actual achievements and availability of funds). With an average cost per sub-project amounts of US$ 10,000, a total of around 350 sub-projects (15 per district) could be financed from the provisional allocation. 63. Group-based agricultural investments with a high social value includes limited and conditional support to enable groups of poor and disadvantaged rural people, in particular women and girls, to purchase labour-saving equipment. The processing of the crops being targeted by S3P is usually done by women, using methods which are extremely labour-intensive and time consuming, and labour-saving technologies can have a very significant positive impact on their livelihoods. Investment support will be restricted to interest groups that: (i) have reached a sufficiently mature developmental stage; (ii) whose members are already members of savings groups; but (iii) are not able to raise sufficient funds to obtain the required equipment on credit; while (iv) the laboursaving equipment would, at a modest fee, also be available to other (non-group) community members. Requests for these investments will originate at the group level and S3P will provide facilitation services for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening and preparation of business plans. S3P contribution will be up to 50 percent of equipment costs, with a ceiling of US$ 2,500 per sub-project and a maximum of one sub-project per group. Sub-projects will be approved by the DACO, up to his/her approval ceiling (currently ZK10 million or US$2,200); beyond this sub-projects will be referred for the PACO’s approval. The total available S3P co-financing amount is set at US$0.5 million. Since sub-project co-financing costs are expected to be very modest, on average US$1,000 per sub-project, a total of close to 500 sub-projects (or only 20 per district) could be financed from the provisional allocation. 64. Technical and facilitation assistance will be provided for: (i) training of DACO and DDCC staff, CACs and other community committees and eligible farmer groups, as required; (ii) facilitation of the participatory planning and implementation processes for community-level and group-based sub-projects and verification of eligibility of communities, groups and their proposed investments; (iii) technical assistance for the screening, assessment and design of proposed investments, such as technical, financial, economical, social and environmental feasibility, as well as (iv) preparation of business, operation and maintenance plans. A Local Agricultural Investments Manager, working closely with the programme manager as a part of the PMU, will provide overall leadership to the sub-component: he/she will establish the procedural and operational modalities for the funding facilities; ensure that these function, with active community involvement; and monitor the sub-projects once financed and implemented. 65. Sub-component 2.2 Support to the Policy and Planning Framework would support MACO’s Policy and Planning Department (PPD) to manage flows of information and communication, undertake policy reviews, and provide opportunities to learn from relevant experience. 66. Management of information and communication within MACO and PPD has become increasingly challenging in recent years. This reflects staff shortages, compounded by the recent creation of the Ministry of Livestock and Fisheries Development (MLFD), as well as the proliferation of different development partnersupported projects and programmes, which MACO is increasingly concerned to 20 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report coordinate effectively. To assist MACO strengthen its knowledge management systems, S3P will finance the recruitment of a Programme planning and monitoring specialist. He/she will be based in PPD and will report to the Director PPD, and will: (i) assist with the review of the current M&E system and facilitate internal discussion on this issue; (ii) advise on information technology requirements for a Management Information System; (iii) assist in the coordination and harmonization of the different initiatives, projects and programmes in relation to the SNDP, the National Agricultural Policy and the Zambia CAADP; (iv) assist in the management of information and communication flows related to these; and (v) support MACO in mainstreaming gender through implementation of the recent strategy and implementation plan for engendering the public service. The programme would finance this post for a period of 3 years, with any future need reviewed in the context of the institutional strengthening activities under PEP. 67. Policy reviews and studies will be undertaken that aim to improve the enabling environment relevant to sustainable productivity growth and expanded smallholders’ integration into agricultural markets. Support would be provided to undertake specific studies, draft policies and regulations; as well as for multi-stakeholder review, discussion (workshop, forums) and dialogue related to their preparation. Some of the topics already identified include, for example, those policies specific to cassava-based farming systems, such as the importance of cassava in national food security, issues related to FISP and the FRA, the lack of appropriate CA techniques for agro-ecological region III, and issues of extension methodology. Other policy issues will be identified through the course of programme implementation. Visits by senior policy and decision makers, within Zambia and elsewhere within the region, has proven a valuable contribution to the policy agenda under other projects in Zambia, and it would be supported under S3P. 68. Sub-component 2.3. Programme Management, Monitoring and Evaluation. The S3P will be managed on behalf of Government by a Programme Management Unit (PMU) located within the Policy and Planning Department (PPD) of MACO. The PMU will consist of management and technical teams, overseen by a Programme Manager responsible for overall programme delivery, based in Lusaka, who will report to the Director PPD. The management team will also be based in Lusaka and it will include a Financial Management Specialist; a Procurement and Contracts Specialist; a Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation/Knowledge Management/ Communication Specialist; and a Local Agricultural Investments Manager (budgeted for under Component 2.1). 69. The technical team will be based at provincial level (in a ZARI Research Station either in Northern or Luapula Province) and will include a Research for Development Specialist, and an Extension Methodology Specialist. It will also include one Facilitator per target province, who will be based in the office of the PACO (and budgeted under Component One). All these posts will report to the Programme Manager. The PMU will also manage a budget for hiring short term technical expertise required by the programme. III. PROGRAMME IMPLEMENTATION A. Approach 70. The S3P will be implemented over a period of seven years. Implementation will start in two provinces (Luapula and Northern Province): in PY1 eight districts will receive intensive support, and PY2 another eight district within these same provinces will be added. As of PY3, a third province and a further eight district will be added. 71. The S3P is expected to complement the already-ongoing SAPP, and by formally linking the two programmes to each other, the one is expected to strengthen the other’s effectiveness and enhance its ability to achieve its overall objective, and vice versa. The two programmes will be managed separately, but a number of mechanisms, including a single Programme Steering Committee for both, linked annual work planning and 21 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report budgeting processes and outcomes, and regular meetings of project managers, will ensure that they remain coordinated and mutually supportive. B. Organizational Framework 72. S3P will be overseen by a Programme Steering Committee (PSC), managed by a Programme Management Unit (PMU) located within the Policy and Planning Department (PPD) of MACO, and implemented by MACO and a variety of non-government partners and service providers. The same Programme Steering Committee (PSC) that has already been established for SAPP will provide overall policy and technical direction and guidance to the programme. Chaired by the Permanent Secretary MACO, it includes representatives of the relevant MACO departments; Ministry of Finance and National Planning (MFNP); Ministry of Commerce, Trade and Industry (MCTI); Ministry of Local Government and Housing (MLGH); Farmers Organizations (such as the Zambia National Farmers Union, ZNFU) and Industry Organizations (such as the Cassava Sub-sector Committee), relevant to the selected commodities or sectors. The PSC should meet at least quarterly, to review and approve the annual work plan and budget, progress reports, the annual financial statements and the external auditor’s report; to provide strategic guidance to the PMU and implementing agencies (within and outside government); to monitor implementation progress and impact; and to make specific recommendations for follow-up, which the PMU should be accountable for delivering. 73. MACO, and specifically PPD, is the lead programme implementing agency. This is a role that involves: (a) taking overall implementation responsibility; (b) convening the PSC; (c) managing changes in Programme direction; (d) chairing the Country Programme Management Team (established as the Programme Development Group during the design phase), to offering a platform for technical advice, guidance and knowledge management, and provide an opportunity for the PMU to engage with key ministries, representatives of farmers’ organizations and the private sector.; (e) recruiting the staff of the PMU; and (f) ensuring coordination with other on-going GRZ/Development Partner support in the sector. 74. A dedicated Programme Management Unit will be created to support MACO to manage S3P implementation. The PMU, located – like SAPP – within PPD, will be led by a Programme Manager who will report to the Director PPD. He/she will be responsible for overall programme delivery, and will lead the PMU (an organogram of the PMU as well as terms of reference for each position are provided in Annex 5). The management team will include the following posts: a Financial Management Specialist, a Procurement and Contracts Specialist, and a Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation/Knowledge Management/ Communication Specialist. The team will be based in Lusaka, so as to facilitate close working relations with MACO, SAPP and other national stakeholders, though it will be expected to travel frequently to the programme provinces and it will have a budget to allow them to do so. 75. The Technical team will include a Research for Development Specialist and an Extension Methodology Specialist, both of whom will be based in a Research Station either in Northern or Luapula Province; as well as one Facilitator in each of the three provinces targeted by the Programme, based in the office of the PACO; and a Local Agricultural Investments Manager, who will be based in one of the provinces. All these positions will report to the Programme Manager. The PMU will also manage a budget for hiring short term technical expertise as required. Additional support to provincial and district financial management may be an area where such expertise will be required. 76. The PMU will draw on management procedures that will be documented in a Programme Implementation Manual (PIM). The PIM outline is presented in Annex 11: a complete draft of the PIM will be prepared by a consultant prior to programme start-up, and it will be finalised by the PMU during the first quarter of programme year one. Among other things, the PIM will define the criteria for selecting the districts and camps to be covered under the programme (which are then reflected in the AWPBs); it will 22 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report include detailed operational guidelines and procedures for the Local Agricultural Investments; and it will also include a gender strategy, which defines the operational measures to be taken to promote gender mainstreaming and women’s empowerment under the programme. 77. The S3P PMU will also draw on and learn from the managers of other IFADfinanced projects in Zambia. Under the COSOP 2011-2015 it is intended that the managers and teams all of the IFAD-financed projects in Zambia meet regularly to share experience and lessons learnt, and build linkages and synergies between their projects. Project Managers’ Team (PMT) meetings will be convened monthly, with the participation of the IFAD Country Officer. The PIM will define the range of specific mechanisms that will be used to develop operational synergies between S3P and SAPP. 78. MACO provincial and district staff will play key roles in the implementation, monitoring and supervision of S3P activities. The service-providers engaged to undertake tasks will work in partnership with provincial and district staff, particularly the Principal (at Province level) and Senior (at district level) Agricultural Officer and relevant Subject Matter Specialists, but also relevant ZARI staff from the Research Stations in Mansa and Kasama (Luapula and Northern). District staff, in particular the 24 District Agricultural Coordinators and their technical teams, the Block Extension Supervisors (BESs) and the Camp Extension officers (CEO) in the 150 target camps, will all benefit from the programme’s capacity development activities, and play valuable roles in knowledge sharing and supporting research and extension linkages. Members of the Camp Agricultural Committees (CACs) in the targeted camps, and of the 24 District Agricultural Committees (DACs) will also benefit from capacity building. 79. Local-level Farmer Organizations and Cooperatives play a key role in representing the interests of smallholder farmers. Under sub-component 1.1, S3P will provide support to strengthen the capacity of local-level farmer groups, already-existing and new. District level farmer associations and cooperative unions will also be supported, depending on the role they can play in improving farmer-productivity within specific value chains. Participatory planning will be used to identify the specific needs of these organizations and these will be incorporated into the work plans. S3P will also seek to support in identifying a sustainable institutional development path for the farmer organizations and cooperatives. 80. Local (district and sub-district) coordination committees such as the DACs and CACs, as well as the multisectoral District Development Coordination Committees (DDCCs) and Area Development Committees (ADCs) will all play key roles in overseeing and prioritizing agricultural development activities at camp level. CACs will be encouraged to coordinate agricultural development activities with the endorsement of ADCs that are responsible for coordinating all development efforts at ward level. DACs oversee and prioritize agricultural development activities at district level (see Annex 5, Appendix 2). C. Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation and Knowledge Management 81. Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation (PM&E) systems will be established to meet the needs of Programme management, GRZ, IFAD and other stakeholders (see Annex 6). The S3P PME system will be guided by the following principles: (i) the establishment of a sound planning and monitoring framework (logical framework) with a limited number of indicators; (ii) the use of the annual work plan and budget (AWPB) as the key instrument for defining and guiding programme activities and expenditures; (iii) the use of simple M&E processes, structures and instruments, including M&E software which can be adjusted to make M&E information accessible to key stakeholders in a timely manner; (iv) alignment with existing M&E frameworks at national and district level, to strengthen the M&E system of MACO and reduce the workload of the district and camp staff, and in particular use of MACO participatory planning process at camp, district, provincial and national level; (v) timely collection of baseline data for key indicators in the logframe as 23 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report specified in the M&E Plan; (vi) integration of communication and Knowledge Management (KM) in all aspects of programme planning and M&E to encourage feedback and reflection on results for effective adaptive management; and (vii) provision of adequate resources for capacity building of stakeholders involved in PME activities at all levels, with a focus on participatory PME approaches. 82. A point of departure for the PM&E system will be the programme start-up workshop, which the PMU will organize. The workshop will involve all relevant stakeholders, government and non-government, at national, provincial and district levels, and its purpose will be to reach a clear and common understanding of S3P objectives; the main results that need to be achieved and indicators for measuring their achievement; the roles and responsibilities of each stakeholder; and the implementation arrangements for the various sub-components. This workshop will also be the opportunity for team building and establishing working relationship between the PMU, the PPD, other national stakeholders and IFAD. 83. Annual work plan and budget (AWPB). The AWPB will be the key instrument for implementation and operational control, in that its approval by the PSC and IFAD will be the authority for the PMU to conduct activities and incur expenditure. It also facilitates operational flexibility, as it allows for regular adjustments to be made to the programme approach, activities and expenditures to reflect the implementation experience gained and changing circumstances. Particular attention will therefore be given to the process for its preparation, which should be inclusive, participatory and demand driven; involve all relevant stakeholders from within and beyond government; and after the first year, build on the annual implementation review (see para.89). Timely preparation and submission of AWPB will require adherence to a schedule of preparation, which also needs to be linked to the GRZ budgetary approval process. 84. In a programme such as S3P, in which the geographical area of intervention is defined in only broad terms, the AWPB for PY1, PY2 and PY3 will assume particular importance, in that they will define the specific districts (and within them camps) in which the programme will be implemented. These AWBPs will therefore indicate the districts and camps to be covered during the year to come, selected on the basis of clear and transparent criteria (already defined in the PIM – para.76). 85. The Programme Manager will oversee the whole AWPB process and ensure that the Director of PPD and his team are fully involved. The M&E specialist within the PMU will be responsible for coordinating the preparation of AWPB, its consolidation, presentation to PSC, finalization and submission to IFAD. He/she will be supported by: (i) the Financial Management Specialist to ensure proper costing, incorporation of the financing plan and disbursement arrangement; (ii) the Procurement and Contracts Specialist who will prepare the procurement plan; and (iii) the Technical Team will provide technical support in preparing the work plans. Given the importance of the process, the PMU will receive training in the preparation of AWPBs. 86. Monitoring and evaluation. S3P results are expected at three different levels (objectives, outcomes, outputs), reflected in the Logical Framework. At each level a set of indicators has been developed, taking into account on one hand IFAD’s Results and Impact Management System (RIMS) framework, and on the other GRZ strategy and programming documents such as the Sixth National Development Plan (SNDP). These indicators, which will be gender disaggregated wherever possible, will be reviewed and finalised during programme start-up in consultation with the main stakeholders. The logframe (and particularly the outcomes and outputs, and their indicators) may then be revised at a later stage if required. 87. Planning, M&E under the programme will be coordinated by the M&E specialist whose role will be to develop appropriate tools and procedures; strengthen the capacity of implementing partners to carry out their monitoring tasks; recruit specialists as necessary for PME system design, impact assessment and other specialized studies; and consolidate and analyze the data. Supported by short-term technical assistance as 24 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report necessary, the M&E Specialist will be responsible for setting up an effective PME plan and system during the first six months of S3P implementation. In doing so, he/she will work closely with PPD and other technical departments of MACO. The M&E system will comprise the following elements. 88. The programme will establish a management information system (MIS), using a dedicated software that will be used to collect data from various levels. The MIS database will be aligned with the MACO M&E system being developed under the “Support to the Agricultural Sector Performance Enhancement Programme (PEP)”. Reporting will be aligned or will be based on the Camp, Block, District and Provincial format of MACO. Service providers will also be required to use this software when reporting on their achievements. Results will be presented in summary form in quarterly and annual progress reports. The MIS will also provide the basis for the half-yearly and annual progress reports that will be submitted to IFAD. 89. A baseline survey will be undertaken during the first semester, to establish benchmarks against which the outcomes and impact on the beneficiaries would be assessed. Annual implementation reviews will be conducted, involving implementers at all levels and key stakeholders, to analyse and review lessons and challenges. The reviews will be linked with the AWPB planning processes to ensure that lessons lead to improved implementation. Qualitative analysis will be conducted from the end of the second year to assess whether activities are likely to lead to the desired higher-level results. Process monitoring will also be carried out during these reviews, by assessing the degree of beneficiaries’ participation in project activities, quantifying the numbers of households reached through the different components, and confirming the level of participation by women and youth. Specialised studies to evaluate the extent to which the S3P purpose and overall goal are being achieved will be contracted out. An assessment of quantitative targets included at all levels in the logical framework will be carried out before the Mid-Term Review. 90. A Mid Term Review (MTR) will be undertaken, during the first semester of the fourth year to assess programme’s achievements and interim impact, the efficiency and effectiveness of S3P management, and the validity of S3P design. On the basis of its findings, the MTR mission may make recommendations for revisions to the programme activities and approach for the remainder of the implementation period, as well as modifications to the PIM, if required. 91. At the end of the implementation period, an End of Programme survey will be carried out to measure changes at beneficiary level, comparing with the baseline situation. Baseline and terminal surveys will be contracted out to service providers under the supervision of the PMU. The PMU will also prepare an internal Programme Completion Report (PCR), which will include an assessment of the achieved versus the planned impact, to be submitted to GRZ and IFAD within three months of programme completion. 92. Knowledge management and learning. In S3P, knowledge management and learning (KM&L) will be a means to make the programme more effective and efficient, enable it to simplify processes, adapt much faster to the emerging realities and lessons, and achieve greater impact. The main purpose of KM processes within S3P is to ensure that knowledge generated is systematically identified, analysed, documented, used to improve S3P performance and shared. KM&L will be fully linked to the S3P PME system, to enable a continuous improvement process, based on feedback loops from data collection to analysis and interpretation. This will enable S3P to be flexible and responsive to changing circumstances. Emerging lessons and experience will also be used to support capacity building and institution strengthening activities of a range of stakeholders, especially MACO at provincial, district and camp level, as well as other GRZ departments, service providers, farmer organizations and others. Systematic KM&L will also support evidence-based decision-making and policy development. Developing the KM system, which will be the responsibility of the M&E specialist, will involve the 25 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report following steps: (a) design of an appropriate monitoring and documentation system; (b) development of appropriate institutional arrangements; (c) monitoring, evaluation and documentation; (d) information management; (e) communication; and (f) knowledge based project support, decision making and policy dialogue. D. Financial Management, Procurement and Governance 93. The programme will be co-financed by IFAD (loan of US$ 24.8 million), the Government of Finland (grant of US$ 7.1 million1), GRZ (estimated US$ 6.1 million), the districts (US$ 0.4 million) and by the beneficiaries (US$ 1.5 million). 94. In 2010, the Governments of Finland and Sweden conducted an external assessment of MACO’s financial management capacity2. They conclude that while MACO staff are well trained and able to apply sound financial management, internal audit and procurement systems, the areas of bank reconciliation, accounting and reporting, and audit committee function are considered as weak. At provincial level in particular, a number of constraints are highlighted. The level of fiduciary risk in MACO as a whole is therefore considered to be substantial, though it is expected that the roll-out of the Integrated Financial Management Information System (IFMIS), foreseen in 2012, will help address many of the constraints identified. The proposed financial management and procurement arrangements proposed for S3P recognise these strengths and weaknesses, they also build on IFAD experiences in Zambia, and they are intended to ensure the secure and effective financial management of the programme Financial Management 95. Finland’s contribution will be channelled via IFAD and blended with the IFAD loan in a fixed ratio (pari passu) of 22 per cent (Finland): 78 per cent (IFAD). This arrangement will be formalised in the financing agreement between GRZ and IFAD, in which Finland’s contribution will appear, as well as agreements between IFAD and Finland, and between the Governments of Finland and Zambia. GRZ contribution will come from foregone taxes and duties, while beneficiaries’ contribution will be limited to sub-component 2.1 (Local Agricultural Investments), and will be made both in-cash and in-kind (labour and local materials). 96. Disbursement Procedures and Withdrawal of Funds. The arrangements for Loan Administration will be contained in a Letter to the Borrower sent from IFAD to the Ministry of Finance and National Planning. Programme expenditures will be broken down by expenditure category, as well as by financier. The Letter to the Borrower will provide for four possible disbursement procedures: (i) via Designated Account; (ii) Direct Payment; (iii) Special Commitment; and (iv) Reimbursement of expenditures incurred. It is foreseen that the bulk of programme funds will be disbursed through the first procedure, via the designated account. Direct Payment procedure will be used only for payments on goods and services procured internationally. 97. Funds flow arrangements have been kept simple (see Annex 7, Appendix 1). IFAD/Finland funds will pass into a Designated Account (DA) denominated in US Dollars and held at the Zambia Reserve Bank (ZRB). This account will be managed by MACO/PPD and will require one signature each from both Category 1 (Director PPD, Chief Accountant or Principal Accountant) and Category 2 (PMU Programme Manager or Financial Management Specialist). The designated account will be used to feed the Kwacha-denominated Operations Account (OA), which will be held in a commercial bank in Lusaka and will be managed exclusively by the PMU. It will be replenished from the DA, based on progress reports and in compliance with IFAD disbursement procedures. Any involvement of public/ private institutions in the delivery of programme activities will 1 2 The grant from the Government of Finland is denominated in Euros, and thus the US Dollar value may vary according to future exchange rate movements. Assessment of the Financial Management Capacity of the Ministry of Agriculture and Cooperative and the Ministry of Livestock and Fisheries, (2010) Finnish Consulting Group; Pre-Award Assessment Ministry of Agriculture and Cooperatives (2009), Moore Stephens LLP (Upon request of the Embassy of Sweden) 26 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report be treated as service provision, and will be translated into output-based contracts/MOUs with payments treated as reimbursable to the service provider. 98. The operation of the Designated Account and Operational Programme Account will be in accordance with IFAD procedures. The DA will be replenished on the basis of regular withdrawal applications with the appropriate supporting documentation, known as Statement of Expenditures (SoE). Disbursement of funds from the DA will be made for all eligible expenditures – excluding taxes and duties – against submission of full standard supporting documentation. The Designated Account will have a ceiling equivalent to approximately six months of programme expenditure. 99. For activities implemented by MACO at decentralised level, funds will be passed to a provincial programme account, held in ZK in a commercial bank branch in each of the Provincial capitals where the programme is working. These will operate on an imprest basis: the PCU will provide an advance that will need to be justified before subsequent releases. This account will finance activities implemented by MACO, and will consist of paying DSA, fuel, training facility, equipment, etc. The Provincial MACO accountant will be responsible for managing the account and providing financial reports for the PMU financial management specialist to review. Provincial and district accountants where the programme will be operating will benefit from training on IFAD and GRZ financial management and procurement procedures. 100. Financial management at the provincial level can be problematic; there are frequently pressures on the provincial accountant to use project resources for nonproject purposes. To strengthen the S3P financial management arrangements at this level and prevent any possibility of leakage of funds, a series of measures are proposed: The amount of the advance will initially be kept low (one month operations) and gradually increased as capacities are improved and the provincial accountant is able to provide complete and accurate financial reports. The Financial Management Specialist in the PMU will be expected to travel to the provinces monthly to review and verify the provincial programme accounts. He/she will be provided with an adequate travel budget to make this possible. All transfers of funds from the operations account in Lusaka to the provincial programme account will be accompanied by a note to the Provincial PS, indicating the expected use of the funds. Using an internet banking facility, the FMS will be able to review the provincial operations accounts in real time. He/she will also be authorised to block the account in the event of unjustified expenditures. All proposed expenditures from the account will be: (a) subject to ex-ante audit; (b) cleared (by email) by the FMS; and (c) approved by the PS of the Province In addition, orientation and related training on financial management and procurement procedures (both GRZ and IFAD) will be provided for all relevant staff at provincial level: the provincial accountant, PACO, internal auditor, PS. These should also be involved in the preparation of the AWPB, to increase their awareness of the proposed project activities. Support for the Provincial Accountants’ mobility, to enable them to visit the districts, will also be provided. 101. Programme Financial Statements and Financial Reporting. According to GRZ procedures, S3P Financial Statements will be prepared in compliance with International Public Sector Accounting Standards (IPSAS) Cash basis. Guidance on compliance will be offered by the MACO Chief Accountant (who is an officer of the Accountant General’s Office in MFNP); and he/she will be closely involved in the preparation of Final Accounts. IFAD-financed transactions will initially be accounted for and reported on using the SAPPO accounting package. Provincial accountants will prepare financial statements based on models developed by the PMU’s Financial Management Specialist, a qualified accountant. Performance-based invoices, linked to achievement of defined milestones, 27 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report will be the basis for payments to contractors, and it will be the responsibility of the service providers to collate documentation to justify their claims for reimbursable costs. 102. Monthly management accounts will be prepared, based on the accounting system, to aid management decision and control. Half yearly progress reports, which include analysis of the programme’s finances, should be submitted to IFAD no later than three months after the end of each six month period. Annual reports, including financial reports, will also need to be prepared and submitted not later than three months following the end of the year. The annual reports will be more detailed than the half-year reports. In addition to a simple review of implementation progress, they will require analysis by the PMU, and a presentation of a full picture of programme resources, achievements of the past year and since the beginning of the programme, as well as annual and cumulative expenditure. Analysis is required of successful approaches and outputs, failures and constraints, performance of implementing partners, and whether progress is being made towards achieving objectives. Such analysis should lead to conclusions about the effectiveness of programme strategies, the need for modification of the logical framework, and planning for the following year. 103. Audit. MACO internal auditors will include S3P in their annual internal audit plans – and will thus cover it during the audits in accordance with GRZ procedures. MACO internal auditors will have a right to report directly to the PSC should there be a need. There should be at least one internal audit report covering SAPP in each quarter. Each year the GRZ Auditor General, or a firm acceptable to him/her, will conduct an external audit of the Programme’s Financial Statements. Normal GRZ procedures will be followed in selecting and appointing the auditors: after consulting with the Auditor General, the PMU will prepare a list of firms to be invited to tender. IFAD will need to provide its no objection to this list, to the terms of reference and later to the tender evaluation report, prior to it being sent to the Auditor General for issuing the contract to the external audit firm. The audit will be carried out in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (ISA), and a certified copy of the Audit Report must be submitted to IFAD no later than 6 months after the end of the Fiscal Year. Failure to do so will result in disbursement being suspended. Procurement 104. IFAD’s revised Project Procurement Guidelines (September 2010), and associated Procurement Handbook, provide for all procurement to be carried out in accordance with national procurement regulations, to the extent that they are consistent with IFAD Procurement Guidelines. In cases where IFAD deems that the borrower’s system for procurement is either in whole or in part not in line with the revised guidelines, then an alternative provision will apply (IFAD rules), in whole or in part. 105. The latest international assessment of GRZ procurement procedures was conducted by OECD/DAC in 2007, and was based on the 1994 Zambia National Tenders Board Act. Its main conclusions were that while the system is well documented with clear responsibilities and procedures, some major weaknesses remained. The GRZ then passed a Public Procurement Act in 2008, which transformed the Zambia National Tender Board into the Zambia Public Procurement Agency (ZPPA), and gave it a specific oversight and regulatory role; while ministries and public spending agencies are being empowered to be fully responsible for the complete procurement cycle1. A transition period during which ZPPA retained its review and approval role was supposed to have ended in December 2010, following the finalization of the procurement regulations, including revised standard bidding documents. However, it appears that the ZPPA has yet to be transformed into a full oversight and regulatory body. The procurement regulation and standard bidding documents based on the 2008 Act have not yet been released, and meantime, MFNP has recently issued a circular requiring that procurement 1 Another provision of the 2008 Act is that all contracts need to be subject to a legal review by the Office of the Attorney General. The practicality of this measure, and the capacity of the Attorney General office to follow-up on this provision has yet to be ascertained. 28 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report requests above ZK 50 million (approximately equivalent to US$ 10,000) are sent to ZPPA for prior review. Of particular relevance for S3P, the MACO Procurement and Supplies unit has been rated by ZPPA as falling into Category C of procurement units (the highest rating). 106. Zambia’s procurement system is classified as being generally in accordance with the requirements laid out in IFAD’s revised Public Procurement Guidelines, and suitable for use for project procurement, subject to some modifications that will be specified in the Financing Agreement and the Letter to the Borrower. While S3P procurement will comply with Zambian procedures as per the Public Procurement Act 2008, several procurement risks have been identified, and the programme will implement a variety of risk mitigation and management measures (see Annex 8). 107. Different procurement methods (ranging from International Competitive Bidding to Direct Contracting) will be used for the different categories of procurement depending on nature, amount and other criteria, the guiding principal being economy and efficiency. These methods will be specified in the procurement plans that will be part of each year’s AWPB. An initial 18-months plan is provided in Appendix 1 to Annex 8. In terms of responsibilities, the PMU will conduct local or international shopping for contracts not exceeding USD 10,000, while the MACO Procurement and Supplies Unit (PSU) will procure for contracts above US$ 10,000, as per GRZ procedures. These include prior review by ZPPA and IFAD, and going through the MACO tender committee, whose decisions will be subject to ZPPA and IFAD final clearance. IFAD will confirm its prior review thresholds, above which clearance will be needed at critical stages of the procurement process (currently US$ 50,000 for Goods/Civil works and US$ 25,000 for Consulting Services) in the Letter to the Borrower. If the procurement process is within the relevant threshold, the programme can carry out the process and report, and IFAD will conduct ex-post verification based on a sample. The clearance of terms-of-reference for all Consulting Services will require a “No Objection” from IFAD, irrespective of the threshold. 108. S3P procurement activities will be coordinated by a Procurement and Contracts specialist who will be responsible for undertaking procurement activities within the S3P threshold and preparing documents for procurement processes. This specialist will have the necessary experience and sound understanding of GRZ procurement guidelines and the procedures applying to internationally financed projects, including those of IFAD. MACO Procurement and Supplies Unit through the Ministerial Tender Committee will undertake procurement activities above the limit of the S3P. Governance 109. The context is set by Transparency International’s 2010 Corruption Perceptions Index, which ranks Zambia 101st out of 178 countries, or in the top one-third of countries of sub-Saharan Africa; and by the fact that to date, no cases of corruption in the IFAD country programme in Zambia have come to light. Full fiduciary compliance under S3P will be facilitated by the PMU’s inclusion of both a procurement and contracts specialist, who will work closely with MACO’s PSU to track procurement activities on a continuous basis, and a financial management specialist with specific responsibility for the programme’s financial management. The holding of separate programme accounts, the specific safeguard measures established for expenditures at the provincial level (para.100) and the internal and independent external auditing of these accounts, will also all contribute to preventing misuse of programme funds. At programme start-up, a loan administration workshop will be conducted and, with inputs from Zambia’s AntiCorruption Commission and the local chapter of Transparency International, an S3P governance and anti-corruption strategy will be defined. In addition, the operational procedures for the Local Agricultural Investments sub-component will include mechanisms that enable rural communities and groups to prevent and/or whistle blow on any corruption they encounter. Finally, the programme will conduct publicity and awareness campaigns to ensure transparency, and wide participation in programme 29 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report planning, implementation and monitoring will allow potential beneficiaries (and NGOs and civil society) to become aware of what they are entitled to expect, thereby stimulating demand for accountability from programme partners. 110. IFAD will also play its part in ensuring the good governance of programme funds through prior review of all major procurements and ex-post review conducted on a sample basis. IFAD’s direct supervision process includes modules on fiduciary compliance and the responsibility and accountability framework, and all supervision missions will include a team member with specific responsibility for financial management and procurement issues. E. Supervision 111. Supervision of S3P will be carried out directly by IFAD as an ongoing process of implementation support; a process made easier by the presence of the IFAD Country Officer, who will provide hands-on, day-to-day support. Experience in Zambia shows the importance of strong implementation support, particularly in the early stages of implementation. Thus the annual implementation support/ supervision missions would be consistently followed by shorter follow-up missions six months later, in order to maintain the hands-on support. Supervision will serve on one hand to ensure fiduciary compliance, and on the other, as an opportunity to assess achievements and lessons jointly, and to reflect on adjustments that may be needed to the programme approach or activities to improve implementation performance. Missions would therefore be an integral part of the KM cycle, with mission members playing a supportive and coaching role. To ensure continuity in this process, missions would be carried out by a core team of resource persons returning regularly, joined by specialists to address the specific needs of a given year. An in-depth joint mid-term review would be organised by government and IFAD in the first semester of the fourth year of implementation. It would be carried out by consultants not involved in supervision missions so as to bring a fresh look at three years of project achievements and learning. F. Risk Identification and Mitigation 112. The Programme is regarded as only moderately risky. The design draws lessons from previous and ongoing IFAD-supported projects and programmes initiatives in the country, as well as of other initiatives within Zambia and the region. The programme will be embedded in MACO at central, provincial and district level, and measures are included to support capacity building at these different levels. Robust implementation arrangements and inclusion of a management team as well as a technical team should help ensure programme execution. Risks and appropriate mitigation measures have been identified and incorporated in the Programme design. The principal risks, their possible consequences and proposed mitigation measures are detailed in Table 3. Table 3: Programme risks, possible consequences and mitigation measures. Risks Possible Consequences Mitigation Measures Marketing problems for crops in S3P supported farming systems (cassava, mixed beans, rice and groundnuts) Diversification of agricultural sector gets delayed. Over dependence on maize increases. National food security becomes less stable Coordinate with ongoing SAPP programme, which includes focus on cassava, mixed beans and rice value chains. Joint SAPP/S3P Steering Committee. Support the public policy and planning framework of the agricultural sector. Reluctance of smallholder farmers to fully engage with the Programme Farmers knowledge of and access to improved technologies will not improve. Farmers will not gain access to productivity enhancing works, Strengthening smallholder farmer organizations Linking with marketing service providers and value chains, in particular by working with SAPP in the same areas and on the same commodities. Using participatory extension approaches. Using participatory, bottom-up planning methods for productivity enhancing works and the like. 30 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Risks Possible Consequences infrastructure and equipment Delayed and/or ineffective provision of extension and advisory services. Delayed release of improved planting material, technologies and equipment. Limited implementation capacity in MACO (Dept. of Agriculture and ZARI) at central, provincial and district levels Financing constraints limit smallholder production and productivity increase Delay in Programme start-up Farmers are unable to obtain funding needed for short- and mediumterm investments The impacts of HIV/AIDS and increasing the exposure to risk of HIV infection Attention diverted from productive activities to coping strategies Higher risk of infection due to greater mobility and increased incomes Accelerated soil erosion and/or fertility depletion Pursuit of shortterm productivity objectives will cause environmental damage Possibly lengthy PMU recruitment and implementation and disbursement delays Financial management delays and irregularities Slow disbursement Cash flow problems Need to reimburse ineligible expenditures Procurement risk Delays in procurement Funds used differently than foreseen. Bank reconciliation issues. IV. Mitigation Measures Continuous sensitisation of smallholder farmers about goal and objectives of S3P Robust programme management arrangements, with teams at central and provincial levels. Tech. assistance to MACO at central and provincial levels Strengthening MACO field capacities in particular at district and camp levels. Strengthening ZARI capacities at provincial research stations. Use diversified range of service providers, including farmer organizations, PPP-type arrangements with private sector and contracted service providers and research institutions. Provide assistance in linking farmers to existing and new sources of finance including RFP Provide conditional limited financial support to obtain labour saving equipment where this has high social impact and where vulnerable groups are not able to raise all required funds Impose minimal conditions of disbursement PIM will already have been drafted. Recruit PMU on time Assistance from IFAD Country Officer and ongoing SLIP, RFP and SAPP in implementing start-up activities Integrate HIV/AIDS messages throughout capacity building and training events. Involve HIV/AIDS Focal Point Person from MACO in capacity building and training events Agricultural research includes integrated pest and production management (IPPM), and conservation farming. These topics are then integrated in extension methods and messages. Environmental safeguards will be incorporated in design and approval criteria for local agricultural investments. Build accountancy capacity in S3P PMU, plus Provincial and District Account Units Introduce safeguards in the disbursement and use of funds at province Training provincial and district FM staff. IFAD supervision and implementation support missions Annual audits Procurement specialist in PMU. Training of district procurement and accounting staff. Only limited amounts of funds sent to provincial programme accounts, according to actual needs. Incorporate asset management registry in financial management software. PROGRAMME COSTS, FINANCING AND BENEFITS A. Programme Costs 113. Main assumptions. The total programme costs have been estimated by applying price contingencies to the base costs. The price contingencies are based on inflation factors: for the entire duration of the programme, the local inflation has been assumed at 8 per cent per annum. International inflation has been assumed at 0 per cent until programme start and for the two initial project years, then 0.5 per cent per annum for the five following years. The initial exchange rate for the analysis has been set at Zambian Kwacha (ZK) 4,800 to US$ 1.00, the rate prevailing in April 2011. The conversions from current US dollar values into ZK are calculated using the constant purchasing power (CPP) exchange rate (ZK/US$) as calculated by the Costab program. Both foreign and local inflation rates are compounded at mid-year (see Annex 9). 31 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 114. Physical contingencies - accounting for changes in quantities and in unit prices that are not related to monetary fluctuation - have been set at zero percent, considering that the quantities and unit costs in the budget are meant to calculate envelopes by activity, that will be clarified and detailed during project implementation, rather than targets to be achieved. The way the budget was established contains in itself sufficient flexibility to avoid using additional physical contingencies. Price contingencies, as calculated by Costab, are 1 per cent of base costs in US$ and to 43 per cent of base costs in ZK, based on the constant purchasing power assumption. 115. Taxes and duties have been estimated using the Zambia Revenue Authority data. All items imported for Programme purposes attract import duties, while domestically purchased items are subject to national and local taxes of different types. Value-add tax (VAT) has been applied on all expenditure accounts. All taxes and duties would be paid for by GRZ, with the exception of taxes on salaries and allowances paid from the loan and grant, which are deducted at source. 116. Summary of Costs: The total investment and incremental recurrent Programme costs, including price contingencies, are estimated at US$ 39.9 million (ZK 271 billion)1. The foreign exchange component is estimated at US$ 6.9 million. Duties and taxes make up approximately US$ 6.3 million. Programme costs are summarised in Table 4 (see also Annex 9). Component 1 comprises 57 per cent of total costs, and Component 2 the other 43 per cent. In terms of expenditure by sub-component, the major investments are for 1.2 – Extension services, with 30 per cent of total funds; 1.3 – Agricultural Research, with 21 per cent; and 2.1 – Local Agricultural Investment, with 33 per cent of total costs; taken together, they represent 84 per cent of the total budget. The Programme Management and M&E costs are estimated at 9 per cent of total costs. Table 4: Total project cost by component in US$ ‘000 Total Amoun t For. Local (Excl. Duties & % Exch. Taxes) Taxes A. Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth Strengthening member-based farmers organisations and their federations Pluralistic participatory extension services Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) Subtotal Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth 2 517 11 809 8 540 22 866 6 30 21 57 126 1 214 2 282 3 622 2 265 8 953 4 686 15 904 126 1 642 1 572 3 340 B. Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth Local Agricultural Investments Support to the Policy and Legal Framework Programme Management, Monitoring and Evaluation Subtotal Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth 13 082 521 3 388 16 990 33 1 9 43 2 779 112 311 3 202 7 912 330 2 561 10 803 2 391 79 269 2 739 39 856 100 6 824 26 706 6 079 B. Programme Financing 117. The proposed IFAD loan amounts to US$ 24.8 million. This represents 62 per cent of the total estimated Programme costs. Finland will contribute through a grant of US$ 7.1 million (EUR 5 million), representing 18 per cent of the total budget. The IFAD and Finnish funds will be disbursed together, in a pari passu ratio of 78:22, and they are therefore presented in the tables under one and the same column. 118. The beneficiaries will contribute an estimated US$ 1.5 million, 4 per cent of the total programme budget. Their participation is expected as counterpart contribution 1 The total programme budget may vary according to the value of the Finnish grant in support of the programme, which is denominated in Euros. 32 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report under the Local Agricultural Investments sub-component; it will be made both in-cash and in-kind; and it will range, depending on the type of investment, from 25 to 50 per cent of its total cost. 119. The districts will contribute under the Local Agricultural Investment subcomponent, by participating in the financing of the District-level agricultural investments. The participation of the districts in the cost of these will be at least 10 per cent of total cost of these investments, which corresponds to about US$ 0.4 million or about 1 per cent of the budget. It will be provided principally in-kind, in the form of the staff time spent in preparing the proposals and supervising construction. 120. The Government will finance all duties and taxes. Its share of the budget amounts to an equivalent of US$ 6.1 million, representing 15 per cent of the total programme budget. Table 5: Project Financing Plan by Disbursement Account (USD '000) 1. Equipment and materials 2. Civil works 3. Services: TA and studies 4. Trainings and Workshops Total PROJECT COSTS GRZ Amount % 1,287 1,449 2,961 381 6,078 17 15 20 5 15 Districts Amount % 415 415 IFAD / Finland Amount % 4 1 5,963 6,831 11,865 7,244 31,902 77 71 80 95 80 Beneficiaries Amount % 497 964 1,460 6 10 4 Total Amount % 7,747 19 9,658 24 14,826 37 7,625 19 39,856 100 Table 6: Project Financing Plan by Component and Sub-component (USD '000) GRZ Amount % A. Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth Strengthening member-based farmers organisations and their federations Pluralistic participatory extension services Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) Subtotal Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth 126 5 1,642 14 1,572 18 3,340 15 B. Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth Local Agricultural Investments Support to the Policy and Legal Framework Programme M anagement, M onitoring and Evaluation Subtotal Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth 2,391 18 79 15 269 8 2,738 16 Total PROJECT COSTS 6,078 15 C. Districts Amount % - - IFAD / Finland Amount % Beneficiaries Amount % 2,391 10,167 6,968 19,525 95 86 82 85 - 415 3 - - 415 2 8,816 442 3,119 12,376 67 85 92 73 415 31,902 80 1 - Total Amount % 2,517 11,809 8,540 22,866 6 30 21 57 1,460 11 - - 1,460 9 13,082 521 3,388 16,990 33 1 9 43 1,460 39,856 100 4 Summary Benefit Analysis Financial Analysis 121. Without-Project Situation The average cultivated area of cassava per household is estimated 1.55 ha, of which half is harvested in a year. For mixed beans/ groundnuts, the cultivated area per household is estimated at 0.30 ha per household, and for rice at 0.25 ha per household. It is assumed that 100 per cent of the farmers cultivate cassava without mechanisation, fertiliser, herbicides nor improved varieties. 50 per cent are assumed to sell their produce fresh while the other 50 per cent transform them into chips. For mixed beans, 65 per cent of the farmers are assumed to monocropping with local varieties, no mechanisation nor commercial inputs; 5 per cent do the same but add some fertiliser; 25 per cent of the farmers intercrop maize and mixed beans with local varieties, no mechanisation nor commercial inputs. Finally, 5 per cent operate mixed beans-maize intercropping, use improved mixed beans varieties, hybrid maize and some fertiliser. Rice growers are assumed to cultivate local varieties without using external inputs. The average net margins appear much higher for the mixed beans/groundnut cropping patterns than for cassava one, and even higher for rice. Cassava however provides more stable yields under a variety of growing conditions and 33 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report therefore plays a crucial role in terms of food security. Overall, the average net margin per household in the without-programme situation is estimated at ZK 145,000 per year. 122. With-project Situation. It is expected that the programme will result in an increase in areas, ranging from 25 per cent for cassava to 35 per cent for mixed beans/groundnuts as well as for rice. Cropping patterns would change, with higher inputs and outputs, and post-harvest transformation and value addition. There would be 30,000 farmers members of the FFS-type groups organized with programme support and another 15,000 farmers assisted by partners/service providers. A further 15,000 households would benefit indirectly from community-level infrastructure investments and indirect extension that may, more gradually, promote an uptake of the improved cropping patterns. The achievement of the with-programme cropping patterns is expected to be reached by Year 10 for cassava and Year 9 for mixed beans, groundnut and rice. Overall, for an identical area of cassava, with mixed beans/groundnuts and maize combined, the net income of the households would increase from ZK 145,000 to ZK 608,000, or 300 per cent. Under these assumptions, the net margin would increase from an estimated US$ 1.16 million to an estimated US$ 5.7 million. Economic Analysis 123. Economic conversion factors: The economic crop models have been calculated by using individual economic conversion factors for all the inputs1. For the outputs (maize, mixed beans, rice), the economic prices have been estimated by calculating the import parity, either from Johannesburg (based on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange when available). For cassava, no regional representative prices could be found. The conversion factor (economic / local price) that was applied by default is 1.2. For rice, the conversion factors that has been applied is 0.9 considering that Zambia still has a competitiveness problem. For maize, considering the important stock surpluses of the year 2010 and the fact that Zambia will not be able to absorb all its production, the export parity price was used. The conversion factor applied to the overall programme costs was 1 (after retrieval of taxes and duties). 124. The calculation of programme benefits has been limited to economic valuation of increased production (mainly through increased yields and production areas), and it has not taken into consideration the potential higher prices that may be gained though improved post-harvest practices (in terms of processing and marketing). Equally, the calculation of programme costs include only a part of the costs of some subcomponents: 90 per cent of the support to agricultural research; 30 per cent of the costs of the Local Agricultural Investment sub-component, as a major part will be infrastructure and post-harvest equipment; and 20 per cent of the “Support to the Policy and Legal Framework” subcomponent (SC.2.2.) as this support will target MACO at central level and have a much wider impact that cannot be directly linked to the results expected from the present programme. 125. The discount rate used in calculating the Net Present Value (NPV) is 10 per cent per year, and while the cost of capital opportunity in Zambia is higher, in agriculture this is already considered reasonable and even quite high when targeting the poor farmers. The period of time taken into account for the discounted fund flows is 25 years. 126. Gross economic margin on area as presently cultivated: Based on these assumptions, the present economic gross margin on the total area cultivated by the direct and indirect beneficiaries is estimated around US$ 6.3 million per year. It would be at US$ 10 million per year with the programme in year 8 and slowly increase to US$ 11.3 million in year 25. 1 Most of the Conversion Factors applicable to farm production inputs were taken from the very detailed calculations operated by J. Keyser (Case study for Zambia as background document) for the Study “Awakening Africa’s Sleeping Giant”, World Bank - FAO, 2009. 34 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 127. Baseline results: Based on the assumptions as presented above, the Economic Internal Rate of Return (EIRR) of the programme is estimated at 14 per cent, while the NPV is US$ 5 million. 128. Sensitivity analysis: The EIRR has a rather low sensitivity (Table 7) to variations in costs and to reductions or delays in income. The highest risk incurred is a reduction in income due to lower output prices and / or to an increase in the costs of commercial inputs. With a 10 per cent reduction in the gross farmer income, the EIRR falls to 12 per cent, and with a 20 per cent reduction it goes down to 7 per cent. Table 7: Sensitivity analysis Standard sensitivity tests Ref. case NPV 10% (million USD) 14% 5 EIRR Costs + 10% 12% Costs + 20% 10% 0 Costs + 30% 9% -2 Income + 10% 17% 8 Income + 20% 19% 10 Income + 30% 21% 13 Income - -10% 12% 2 Income - -20% 7% -2 Income -30% Income delayed by 1 year Income delayed by 2 years 2% -7 10% 6% 0 -4 D. 3 Sustainability 129. S3P complements the ongoing SAPP, which is starting its value chain work by linking poor but organized rural smallholder producers of cassava and mixed beans to private sector agribusiness operators. In so doing it is creating new incentives for smallholder farmers to increase their production -and increasingly their productivity – of these crops. The S3P will strengthen this process by giving farmers in the cassava-based based farming systems of Luapula, Northern and a third province the access to improved technologies and techniques for increased agricultural productivity, as well as the capacity to use them effectively, and in so doing substantially increasing their marketable surpluses. 130. Smallholder producers will be more productive and better organized, capable and empowered to consolidate their demand for quality support services and link-up with DACO technical teams and/or other service providers (Farmers organizations, NGOs, private sector). This will create opportunities for (partial) payment of demanded agricultural services by smallholders, and would facilitate an eventual re-alignment of agricultural extension camps to better coincide with sub-district political boundaries with the (reduced) extension staff relocating to sub-district multi-sectoral service centres. S3P’s significant investment in social capital building of the membership-based farmers organizations as well as their federations at District level, should increase the probability that development options at this level are more inclusive of vulnerable populations. 131. Decentralized agricultural offices and institutions, in particular DACOs, DACs and CACs, will have strengthened their governance capacities by routinely engaging in bottom-up participatory planning and implementation of sustainable local agricultural and economic growth initiatives, operating with fairness and transparency. Information and knowledge management will be greatly improved and actual results obtained at the camp level will be central to the up-dated monitoring and evaluation system. This will 35 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report also support MACO in improving the quality of the devolution and decentralisation exercise that it is expected to engage in. 132. Government and non-government agricultural research and extension service providers would be working together through PPP-type arrangements which are not only supported by policy, but for the viability of which there is increasing evidence in Zambia. 133. Sustainable increase of the productivity of the cassava based farming system will be enhanced by the development of a set of soil fertility management practices (including but not limited to conservation farming and agro-forestry) adapted to local needs and capacities. This will be central to accelerating the transition from the unsustainable chitemene (‘slash and burn’) production system to sustainable permanent cultivation systems; indeed it is a necessity for such a transformation to take place, as gradually it must. It will also help increase resilience of these farming systems in the face of increasing climatic variations. Increasing production and productivity of cassava, mixed beans/groundnuts and rice is expected to continue well beyond programme duration, once the demand-driven technology development systems are operating as intended, improved plant varieties for instance will continue to be released. 134. Finally, S3P implementation in close collaboration with other programmes, such as the SAPP, FRP and the EU-financed PEP, will strengthen MACO’s capacities to execute is functions in the sector. 36 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report ANNEXES 1. Country and Rural Context Background 2. Poverty, Targeting and Gender 3. Country Performance and Lessons Learned 4. Detailed Programme Description 5. Implementation Arrangements 6. Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation and Knowledge 7. Financial Management and Disbursement Arrangements 8. Procurement 9. Programme Cost and Financing 10. Economic and Financial Analysis 11. Draft Programme Implementation Manual 12. Adherence to IFAD Policies 13. Contents of the Programme Life File 37 Annex 1. Country and Rural Context Background Key File 1: Rural Poverty and Agriculture Sector Issues Priority areas/ affected groups Rural Poverty Major Issues Rural Livelihoods: General 39 Agriculture Production and Productivity Deep human crisis in the 21st Century seen from poor MDG indicators – poverty & hunger, poor education attainment, gender inequality, child health, reproductive health, HIV&AIDS incidence and low access to safe water and adequate sanitation Zambia’s Human Poverty Index one of the highest in the world Things improving in some indicators (e.g. child mortality and malaria) and rural areas posting better trends in others but challenge still huge Rural area missing out on economic growth as extreme poverty rose between 2004 and 2006 while it fell in urban areas Poverty highest in HHs headed by old people, female, people without education (87% of whom were poor), small farmers (68% of whom extremely poor in 2006 compared to 23% in urban low cost areas) Households have few financial resources as a substantial part of people’s incomes spent on food alone (48% overall but 65% in rural areas in 2006) Poor human capital characteristics Vulnerability to long term trends – 25 years of poor economic performance leaving serious deficits in key investments (rural economic and social infrastructure); HIV&AIDS’ general debilitating impact on livelihoods (e.g. by seriously eroding the asset pentagon) with negative impacts higher among women; Natural resource depletion partly due to more intensive utilisation and use of wrong production methods Vulnerability to shocks – climate change and variability with rising frequency of droughts alternating with floods in some areas, animal diseases and deaths, death and sickness in the family, macroeconomic shocks (e.g. Kwacha appreciation, fuel price hikes, global economy business cycles) Vulnerability to seasonal factors – food availability lowest during the rain season when labour demand peaks and incidence of diseases (malaria and diarrhea) also peak, little cash income generation during slack period Area based vulnerabilities – Some areas much more prone to droughts and floods, poor soils such as due to acidity, declining soil fertility, etc. Low education levels of small farmers, especially among women, constraining ability to effectively use extension and market information Inadequate commercial orientation to farming taken as a way of life and not as a business Collapse of key marketing and rural finance institutions during 1990s agriculture liberalization High transaction costs due to sparsely populated settlements, poor rural Support MFNP to make rural development central to Zambia’s quest to achieve the MDGs by 2015 Promote revitalization of agriculture development in general to help achieve broad based growth and cut poverty and hunger (MDG 1) Promote commodities of significant importance to smallholders in general and women farmers in particular Promote small livestock to deal with labour-scarcity and the building of the rural population’s financial base Promote labour-based projects and help generate cash income during slack period Helping farmers take a more business approach to farming will enhance financial base Promote and strengthen where they exist savings and credit schemes. Help revitalize agricultural credit through innovative products Promote participatory NRM and the mainstreaming of climate change mitigation and adaptation Promote creation of livestock disease free zones for a vibrant livestock sector Promote labour-saving technologies and production techniques Promote better preparedness for Natural Disasters Help develop ability to forecast policy impacts and macroeconomic shocks on different social groups and the design of adequate mitigation measures Effective mainstreaming techniques for HIV&AIDS, gender and poverty in proposed interventions Support achievement of MDGs beyond MDG 1 Commercialisation of smallholder agriculture through appropriate interventions along value chains Household and group based approach to extension helping smallholders to: Plan, cost and record all their activities Use economic information to take key decisions and produce Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Required Actions Priority areas/ affected groups Major Issues Agriculture Sector Funding 40 for specific markets Make on-farm investments to enhance productivity and value addition Support provision rural financial services through innovative products appropriate for the rural poor Promote conservation farming to include aspects with more long term impacts such as agroforestry technologies Value chains Ensuring better access to fertilizer and hybrid seeds through access to financial services and cash income (off season agric production, off-farm enterprises, small livestock, etc) Mainstreaming of HIV&AIDS and gender Support to MACO (Agribusiness & Marketing Department) for cohesion and increased efficiency in the management of the rural economic development process. Diversify farm base through market-led opportunities. Those productive farmers with potential to respond to market signals will be able to make rational production decisions. For those smallholders with some production potential, use demand-pull/market-led approaches to build self-reliance based on commercial approach and relationships, and higher incomes. Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report infrastructure (roads, electricity, telecommunication, storage facilities, etc), poorly organized farmer groups, etc Low on-farm investments due to low financial assets, unsupportive land tenure system, etc Poor delivery of agriculture services – extension, research, irrigation, etc – and inadequate access by farmers Negative effects of climate change and variability Dominance of maize even in areas where it is not economical to produce Decline in soil fertility in the more productive areas of Zambia Labour constraints at the height of farming season due to lack of farm power mechanization, prevalence of diseases and low food stocks, AIDS, gender discrimination Inadequate access to modern farm inputs due to few financial assets by small farmers Size of agricultural sector budget constrained by the FISP allocations. Size of budget growing but achieving growth targets requires quality allocations. Planned improvement in field service delivery shown but need to be sustained. Subsidised inputs crowd out the private sector deliveries and discourage investments in new private fertiliser sales networks. Misallocation and inefficiencies in usage does not encourage sustainable fertiliser use. Diversion raises incomes of some but does little to raise crop productivity. Late delivery of inputs does not improve productivity. Required Actions Priority areas/ affected groups Commercialisati on of smallholder production and promotion of value addition Required Actions Lack of entrepreneur culture, business and financial management skills. Absence of contract loyalty/credit repayment culture among small farmers. Limited supply contract-based market linkages. Low purchasing power of local consumers, local market volumes. Limited value addition and high dependence on buying and selling of unprocessed agricultural products, dominated by food items. Limited availability of skilled service providers. Lack of adequate and timely market information. Inadequate market infrastructure: storage, collection centres, feeder roads. Limited availability/access to financial services. Limited capacity of farmer based organizations to bargain and negotiate. Lack of skills in post harvest, value-adding and agro-processing activities. Limited capability to identify/exploit value chain opportunities. High levels of illiteracy, innumeracy. Policy uncertainty affects the efficient operation of the private sector e.g. Export bans, import quotas. Uncertainty over changes in import tariff rates. When and where will FRA enter the market - prices at which FRA buys and sells unpredictable uneconomical for private sector to compete. Farmer and trader inventory carrying risks high. All of these sources of unpredictability impede private traders servicing small farmer needs Impedes investment and competition in output and inputs markets. FRA and FISP accounting for two-thirds agriculture budget with emoluments claiming significant share of the rest leaving little for other operations ABM which should support private sector has no policy framework and strategy and service delivery systems yet to be fully developed. ABM does not yet have sufficient numbers of professional and technical staff (some assigned to the FISP on a full-time basis) with competencies to support development of a competitive agribusiness sector. ABM Posts at District level only filled in 2008, by direct entry staff who need to be equipped with the necessary skills to support agribusiness. A weak extension service – poorly staffed on the ground due to high turnover, poor camp infrastructure, little operational funding (e.g. for fuel), lack of in-service training to update officers with current messages, many not fully equipped in PEA facilitation Centralized decision making to support Community-Driven Development Facilitate resilient market linkages based on sustainable business relationships. Promote market-led agro-processing ventures. Facilitate generation of market information and timely dissemination. Facilitate development of storage and market infrastructure by private sector/joint venture. Collaborate with relevant stakeholders to promote financial services to support business ventures. Develop marketing skills among service providers. Identify market opportunities and convey to farming community. Avail both agribusiness technical advisory services and matching grants to boost agricultural commercialisation through: Mentoring. Product Development. Market Development. Supply Chain Development. Market Information Dissemination. Support MACO to build policy and planning machinery to ensure coordinated rural commercialisation process. Support MACO to work out detailed investment plan and strategy to guide SNDP implementation Support policy dialogue on how to ensure sector funding is according to sector priorities Support reinvigoration of the extension service Strengthen MACO ABM to be able efficiently to play its public sector role in the private sector-led agribusiness agenda. Promote private sector/NGO provision of services, in tandem with public services. Promote service provision that responds to market-oriented knowledge needs of the poor. Strengthen capacity of ABM staff in the Districts and Provinces. Promote public/private/NGO partnerships for synergy, sustainability. Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 41 Public sector capacity to support rural development. Major Issues Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Source: Central Statistical Office www.cso.zm, downloaded 24/10/10 Figure 2: Long-term average annual production and productivity increase of the main Zambian food crops (expressed in tons cereal equivalent). 42 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 1: Millennium Development Goals Indicators, 1990 - 2006 MDG INDICATOR Proportion of people living in extreme poverty (%) Underweight children (%) Stunted children (%) Wasted children (%) Net enrolment ratio (%) Proportion starting grade 1 reaching grade 7 (%) Literacy rate of 15-24 year olds (%) Ratio of literate females to males Share of women in wage formal employment (%) Infant mortality rate Maternal mortality rate ESS trends of HIV infection among ANC (%) ZDHS HIV prevalence New cases of malaria per 1,000 Malaria fatality rate per 1,000 Proportion without sustainable access to improved water source Proportion without access to improved sanitation Source: UNDP/GRZ, various MDG Reports 1990 Value 58.2 25.0 40.0 5.0 80.0 64.0 79.0 0.97 39.0 107.0 649.0 20.0 121 11 26.0 43 Actual Year 1990 1992 1992 1992 1990 1991 1990 1990 1990 1992 1992 1994 1990 1990 1991 2002 Value 58.0 28.0 47.0 5.0 68.0 73.0 75.0 0.98 35.0 95.0 729.0 19.1 16.0 377 48 43 Actual year 2002 2002 2002 2002 2002 2003 2003 2000 2000 2000 2002 2002 2002 2002 2002 1998 2004 2006 43.1 40 2015 Target 29.1 12.5 20.0 2.5 100 100 100 36 162 20.0 121 11 24.5 34.0 1998 29.9 36.1 13.0 53.0 20.0 50.0 6.0 85.0 82.0 70.0 0.8 51.0 19.7 54.2 5.9 97.0 83.0 - - 70.0 449 14.3 Table 2: Proportion Below Poverty Line, 1991 - 2006 1991 1993 1996 1998 2004 2006 Extreme Poverty 58 Poverty Incidence 74 Extreme Poverty 61 Poverty Incidence 69 Extreme Poverty 53 Poverty Incidence 73 Extreme Poverty 58 Poverty Incidence 68 Extreme Poverty 53 Poverty Incidence 64 Extreme Poverty 51 Rural Urban 88 49 81 32 92 45 84 24 82 46 68 27 83 56 71 36 78 53 53 34 80 34 67 20 Central Copperbelt Eastern 70 61 85 56 44 76 81 49 91 71 28 81 74 56 82 59 33 70 77 65 79 63 47 66 76 56 70 63 38 57 72 42 79 59 27 65 Luapula Lusaka 84 31 73 19 88 39 79 24 78 38 64 22 82 53 69 35 79 48 64 29 73 29 61 16 Northern N/ Western 84 75 76 65 86 88 72 76 84 80 69 65 81 77 66 64 74 76 60 61 78 72 64 57 Southern 79 69 87 76 76 59 75 59 69 54 73 58 Western 84 76 91 84 84 74 89 78 83 73 84 73 Zambia Source: Central Statistical Office, Living Conditions Monitoring Survey 2006 44 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Poverty Incidence 70 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 3 : Estimation of marketing potential for cassava and mixed beans in districts of Luapula and Northern Province12. Cropholder (Nber of HH) /a Cassava (average/ HH) Cassava Area Fresh Dry Market Pot. (ha/HH Prod. Prod. Prod. Market ) /b (kg/year) (kg/year) (kg/year) (t/year) MIXED BEANS (average / HH) ProdMarket Area Prod. (ha/HH) uction /b (kg/year) (kg/year) Mixed beans Pot. Market (t/year) LUAPULA Chienge 14 824 1.26 6702 1676 776 11 497 0.04 17 -33 18 502 0.98 4634 1159 259 4 784 0.04 21 -29 Mansa 16 773 1.95 7661 1915 1015 17 028 0.17 62 12 Milenge 3 419 1.44 7703 1926 1026 3 507 0.08 36 -14 Kawambwa Mwense 204 10 476 1.61 5606 1401 501 5 252 0.01 3 -47 11 165 1.44 6682 1670 770 8 603 0.05 11 -39 4 964 3.72 17305 4326 3426 17 009 0.02 5 -45 80 124 1.57 6979 1745 845 67 680 7 500 1.42 7098 1775 1175 8 809 0.01 2 -48 Chinsali 12 500 0.90 4522 1130 530 6 630 0.30 231 181 2 258 Isoka 17 500 0.33 1674 419 -181 0.19 86 36 636 8 500 0.18 882 221 -379 0.00 1 -49 Kasama 15 500 1.04 5190 1298 698 10 811 0.32 248 198 3 075 Luwingu 10 000 1.49 7465 1866 1266 12 663 0.80 450 400 3 996 Mbala 20 000 0.79 3937 984 384 7 683 0.64 418 368 7 356 Mpika 17 000 0.62 3102 775 175 2 983 0.21 181 131 2 221 11 000 1.10 5507 1377 777 8 545 0.74 449 399 4 385 Nchelenge Samfya Total 204 NORTHERN Chilubi Kaputa Mporokoso Mpulungu 8 500 1.21 6045 1511 911 7 746 0.29 226 176 1 493 Mungwi 14 237 1.26 6316 1579 979 13 936 0.22 170 120 1 707 Nakonde 13 772 0.71 3545 886 286 3 943 0.23 177 127 1 744 156 009 0.88 4383 1096 496 83 748 31 991 0.01 64 16 -134 0.05 33 -17 2 941 0.00 0 0 -150 0.03 16 -34 Kapiri Mposhi 27 653 0.02 76 19 -131 0.04 32 -18 Mkushi 13 075 0.09 475 119 -31 0.04 36 -14 Mumbwa 19 229 0.09 29 -21 Serenje 21 583 0.16 65 15 Total 28 871 CENTRAL Chibombo Kabwe Total 116 472 /a: Source: Adapted from District Agricultural Office Kasama (2007) and HH Survey 2008/09 (CSO)-Luapula. /b: Source: Crop Focus Survey Data 2009-10, Central Statistical Office (CSO). (Unpublished) 1 2 Marketing potential calculated on basis of combined data from Crop Focus Survey 2009/10, HH Survey 2008/09 by CSO, and pers. Comm. to the mission. Average annual cropped areas and production for cassava and beans for 2009/10 cross checked with CSO time series for 2000/09 and adjusted as appropriate. For cassava, annually harvested area considered at 50% of cropped area, dry yields at 25% of fresh root yields. Average consumption/person of cassava estimated on basis of proportion of 60-70% (150 kg/year), 4050% (100 kg/year) and 10-15% (25 kg/year) of average caloric intake Luapula, Northern and Central Provinces. Considering 6 persons per HH, the total cassava consumption at district level and the potential for annual marketable dry cassava have been derived. Due to high market value, mixed beans are generally considered as a ‘cash’ crop and farm HH consumption is not known. Average annual household retention estimated at 50 kg, the rest as marketable. 45 320 320 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 2 Poverty, Targeting and Gender Poverty Context 1. General situation: Rural smallholders make up about 60 percent of the national population and about 79 percent of smallholders nationwide are reported below the poverty line with 66 percent reported as extremely poor 1. Although rural poverty has declined from 88 percent in 1991 to 78 percent in 20062, it remains widespread among smallholders, effecting women more than men, by a 7 percent difference in poverty incidence (see figure below). Zambia has a young and dependent population, with 46 percent under the age of 15, which poses a great socio-economic burden on the family and the entire nation. Job creation has not been commensurate with gains from economic growth, which has been hampered by low education levels and HIV/AIDs. 2. The majority of households nationwide are relatively asset-poor, with trends showing that farmers with better access to markets have increased farm size, asset values, gross revenue and household incomes 3. S3P-targeted Luapula and Northern Provinces have poverty incidences of 73 percent and 78 percent of the population respectively, and extreme poverty incidences of 61 percent and 64 percent. 3. In general, smallholders in Zambia are subsistence-based small-scale farmers, poor yet productive men and women farmers who have potential to take advantage of development opportunities and improved assets. The 23 percent of smallholder households who are women-headed show higher levels of poverty (see Table 1 below), largely due to unequal opportunities, access to services, status and representation. Table 1: Incidence of Household Poverty by Gender, 1998 and 2006 (Source: CSO, LCMS 1998 and 2006) Poverty Status Overall Poverty Extreme Poverty Moderate Poverty Gender of House Head Male Female Male Female Male Female per cent Households 1998 2006 72 63 77 70 56 49 65 57 16 14 12 13 4. Women are not formally excluded from smallholder farming opportunities, but are greatly disadvantaged due to cultural norms, which prevent women from fully benefitting from equal opportunities and undermine their ability in accessing land, services, training, credit, and voice and representation in decision-making policy and planning4. Because women are more directly faced with meeting household basic requirements, have fewer economic resources and are disadvantaged in accessing financial assets, it is reported that women have increased their participation in the labour markets, including the urban informal sector5. Women contribute to at least 60 percent of farm labour, collect water and firewood, and assume the major role and responsibility for childcare and numerous household tasks6. 5. Multidimensionality of Poverty: variation of poverty levels and livelihood conditions among households within provinces and districts depend on a range of factors - notably the natural resource base (soils, water, climate conditions), remoteness and 1 2 3 4 5 6 National Agricultural Policy (NAP) 2011-2030 draft version 2011; and SAPP:WP1(2010). Central Statistic Office in NAP, draft (2011); Living Condition Monitoring Survey (LCMS) 2006. Food Security in Zambia, FAO, draft, 2011. Discussed in NAP draft 2011; and The Household Approach as an Effective Tool for Gender Empowerment: A Review of the Policy, Process and Impact of Gender Mainstreaming in the Agricultural Support Programme (ASP) in Zambia. March 2008. From Chiwele, D. for UNICEF (2008) Situation Analysis Women and Children: Household Income and Poverty. SAPP (2009) WP1; and NAP draft 2011. 46 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report access to key infrastructures and services (roads, agricultural extension services, markets, storage, social services, information etc), level of education of household members, household asset-base and accumulation, labour availability (including conditions of health) and gender. Seventy percent of female-headed households fall below the aggregate poverty line, compared to 63 percent of male-headed households. Further, extreme poverty is found to be more prevalent among female-headed households (57 percent) than poor male headed households (49 percent)1.As indicated in the table above, the incidence of overall poverty is falling slightly faster among maleheaded households than among female-headed households2. 6. Pockets of rural households exist that have comparatively less resilience to shocks than other households, and under stress are likely to fall back into conditions of vulnerability and extreme poverty. In these situations, they are forced to rely on traditional coping strategies such as skipping meals, reducing dietary diversity, engaging in causal labour on farms or other occupations at low rates, depending on familial social networks, bartering, selling assets, pulling children out of school etc) 3. Vulnerability to falling into poverty is caused by factors such as collapsing social capital, high prevalence of HIV/AIDS, effects of maize monoculture bias, lack of capital to expand agricultural activities4. An important factor keeping households strapped in the cycle of poverty is low production and productivity - resulting in low incomes which create limitations in purchases of inputs and labour. Self-assessments from the LCMS (2006), show that many farmers mention low agricultural production and productivity as a main cause of poverty, commonly citing : inability to afford agricultural inputs, lack of capital to start or expand agricultural outputs and lack of labour. Labour is a critical constraint for smallholders, particularly because most poor smallholder producers depend only on hand hoes for cultivation. As most households are labour constrained, this situation is particularly acute for those households with particularly limited labour availability notably female-headed and those affected by HIV/AIDS. 5 7. Food insecurity: appears widespread and severe in the Luapula and Northern provinces. Stunting, a good indicator of long-term exposure to food insecurity among preschool-age children is highest in Luapula, reported at 50 percent compared to a national prevalence of 42 percent; among school-age children, Luapula records the highest prevalence rate 51 percent, followed by the Northern province at 50 percent, compared to a national average of 31 percent6. Further, Luapula and Northern were among provinces with the highest prevalence of chronic energy deficiency among women (13-14 percent compared to national average of 10 percent), while the average share of household expenditure on food, typically expressing the extent of poverty and food security, were also among the highest in the country (between 60-67 percent), see Table 2 below. 8. Self-sufficiency and adequate daily intake is insufficient for a balanced nutritional diet. Reports7 indicate that at national and household levels there is inadequate emphasis on production of vegetables, fruits and legumes (protein-rich food crops providing adequate vitamins and minerals) and preparation of nutritious meals. In addition, food production is not evenly distributed among households. Chilewe (2008) found the biggest differences among undernourished children below age 5 years was 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Chiwele (2008). LCMS 2004. IFAD (2006) Study on Poverty and Targeting in Eastern and Southern Africa: Zambia Country Report, and (2008) Zambia: Vulnerability Assessment Committee (ZVAC) Thurlow J. and P. Wobst (2004) The Road to Pro-Poor Growth in Zambia: Past Lessons and Future Challenges. IFPRI; and SAPP WP1. Labour is limited in efficiency and intensity, reinforced or caused by a complexity of factors: low population densities (15 persons/km2), illness and disease e.g. HIV/AIDS, limited use of labour-saving technologies, costs of hiring labour with low returns to investment, peak labour-demand periods falling during the hungry season when hunger and disease is highest, etc. Central Statistic Office (CSO) 2009. NAP draft (2011). 47 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report between male and female headed households1. Stunting in non-poor female headed households was as high as in extremely poor male-headed households leading to a conclusion that a child growing up in a female-headed household was more likely to be undernourished even if that household was not poor. Probable causes for this include that female household heads take up more responsibilities than their counterparts in male headed households, resulting in less time to safeguard the nutritional health of their children. Important as well, women have lower economic assets and access to financial resources compared to their male counterparts resulting in daily struggles to obtain enough for their families. Table 2: Proportion of household income spent on food and non-food items, 1998 and 2006 (Source: CSO, LCMS 1998 and 2006). Zambia Rural Urban Female Rural Areas Small-scale Medium-scale Large-scale Non-agriculture Urban Areas Low-cost Medium-cost High-cost Food 59 72 51 62 58 1998 Non-Food 41 28 49 38 42 Food 48 65 38 2006 Non-Food 52 35 62 74 63 41 62 26 37 59 38 67 60 46 49 33 40 54 51 52 49 39 48 51 61 42 32 29 58 68 71 Determinants of Rural Poverty 9. Isolation and poor infrastructure conditions are particularly prominent in S3P target provinces, undermining the commercialisation and expansion of the rural economy. The Zambia Livelihood Map Rezoning and Baseline Profiling (2004) 2 describes the targeted S3P zones as subsistence-based agricultural zones with limited trading in agricultural products, generally poor infrastructure, with livelihood activities of fishing in Luapula and livestock in Northern province. Zambian farmers have lower access to roads and markets than farmers from neighbouring countries (to some extent due to low population densities3). Studies and data suggest that proximity to urban centres are critical factors effecting smallholder potential for poverty reducing commercialization 4 (see Figure 1 below). 10. Neglect of road maintenance and little extension of roads into more remote rural areas (i.e. feeder roads) have contributed to rural household dependency on subsistence farming and limited access to markets. In addition, storage facilities have been reported to be inappropriately located and in need of rehabilitation and post harvest losses are reported between 15 and 30 percent. Even those farmers who are able to increase productivity and produce some surplus for sale face constraints that limit the profitability of the commodities they produce. 1 2 3 4 Chilewe (2008). Final Report by the Zambia Vulnerability Assessment Committee (ZVAC) (2004) FAO draft (2011). IFAD 2006; Thurlow and Wobst (2004); and Siegel Paul B. (2008) Profile of Zambia’s Smallholders: Where and Who are the Potential Beneficiaries of Agricultural Commercialization? Africa Region Working Paper Series No. 118. World Bank. 48 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Figure 1: Average household distance to markets and poverty headcount by Province (Adapted from: Thurlow & Wobst, 2004. Calculations from CSO/LCMS 1998). 11. A second and extremely vital constraint to agricultural growth and commercialization as mentioned is labour availability. In Zambia, land is not the issue, but rather the ability to cultivate the land1. Household wellbeing and viability of commercial agriculture is based on productivity, closely correlated with availability of labour. 12. Zambia’s high HIV/AIDs prevalence, estimated at 15 percent of the adult population, has weakened household resilience, decreased labour availability and created barriers to economic development. HIV/AIDS pandemic has effected disproportionately more women compared to men2 and is creating new food insecure categories. This is putting stress on the extended family system as already vulnerable families take in more dependent members, raising the burden of acquiring enough food for all. The phenomenon of child-headed households has also been rising, particularly limiting opportunities for the girl child – often withdrawn from school to help with home care of sick members.3 About 60 percent of farm households have suffered losses due to HIV/AIDs. Households caring for sick members, having lost productive household members, or those caring for orphans and additional dependents are confronted with heavy economic burdens. Moreover, the impact of HIV/AIDs has resulted in severe absences and vacancies among MACO extension staff and also decreased numbers of progressive farmers. Programme Targeting Strategy 13. Overview: the targeting strategy of the S3P will be inclusive, aim to reduce barriers to participation, and be guided by farmer interest and willingness to participate. Smallholders in targeted camps will access programme support as direct beneficiaries as members of existing PEA/FFS-type groups or if they are interested to form such groups. Farmers who are not members of groups and other rural household members located in target areas will have opportunities to indirectly benefit from a range of programme support. The S3P targeting strategy is designed based on a two-step approach, including 1 2 3 IFAD (2006). Chiwele (2008) reports that women accounted for more than half of the adults estimated to be living with HIV and that young women are especially hit by the pandemic with those aged 15 to 19 years five times more likely to be infected compared to their male peers. Chiwele D. et all (2004) for FAO. Agricultural Development and Food Security in Sub-Saharan Africa: A Case Study of Zambia; and NAP draft (2011). 49 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report geographic targeting followed by self-targeting (see Table 4). Direct targeting may be an option considered for implementation based on mid-term findings from monitoring the targeting strategy, - particularly to enhance mechanisms across programme activities for strengthening gender inclusion, HIV/AIDs-affected households and youth. 14. Geographic targeting will be based on the location of cassava-based farming systems. Selection of target areas based on viability of market-oriented production rather than exclusively on poverty profile criteria has been recommended as the most logical targeting mechanism for Zambia to promote commercialisation 1. SAPP has applied the geographic targeting approach using the main criteria of high-production areas of cassava and mixed beans with high potential for engagement with existing or prospective producer groups. S3P coverage areas will be aligned as much as possible with SAPP coverage areas although it will include specific areas of interest for rice and groundnut production in addition to cassava and mixed beans. A total of four commodities (cassava, mixed beans, groundnuts and rice), therefore, have been selected as entry points based on the following criteria: potential to generate income by smallholders, particularly smallholders who have high poverty prevalence; potential to show quick and tangible results; potential to integrate women into value chain activities, i.e at least 50 per cent; potential for efficiency gains and value addition in the value chain; potential contribution to food security; resilience to potential shocks (disease, drought); complementarity with other agribusiness support initiatives; sustainability in terms of natural resource management; up-scalable; balancing agro ecological zones; existence of strong commodity/sectoral organizations; existence of market opportunities 15. S3P will initially focus on Luapula and Northern Provinces which together account for some 70-90 percent of national cassava and mixed bean production, as well as 50 per cent of national rice production. Improving productivity and marketing opportunities of these commodities, correspond to interests and needs of smallholder farmers and particularly the poor in these regions. While poverty has not been the principle criteria for targeting, it is noteworthy that Northern province ranked the second highest of provinces in poverty incidence and extreme poverty in 2006, while Luapula ranked third highest. 16. While SAPP aims to target 20-30 districts nationwide over the project lifetime, S3P will prioritize a total of 24 districts from three provinces, including Luapula and Northern. The main selection criterion is the potential to increase marketable surpluses (see Table 3 of Annex 1). Within each district, and average of about six to seven camps will be selected, using the same criteria as district selection, with consideration of additional criteria as appropriate such as existing projects/interventions/NGOs to optimize synergies, demonstrated or particular commitment/interest/capacity of local authorities, leaders, CACs (for example through past efforts), presence or proximity to particularly favorable resources/infrastructures, etc. S3P will be implemented through a phased approach, scaling up gradually. 17. Self targeting: once programme areas are defined through geographic targeting, a self-targeting approach will be activated in complement with SAPP. Selftargeting in S3P will be guided by the core criteria of smallholder farmers who are already organised in farmer groups (producer groups, cooperatives, informal associations etc.) or are willing and have potential to join such groups, having limited external support, and potential to be linked to markets (see SAPP: WP1). To effectively 1 IFAD (2006). 50 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report implement self-targeting mechanisms, expansive awareness raising and sensitization will be undertaken, through information and communication campaigns targeted to all categories of smallholders. This will be essential to promoting inclusiveness and broadbased participation among the diversity of smallholders. Measures such as multistakeholder participatory decision-making (e.g. CACs, DACs) and mechanisms for exchange and dialogue will be strengthened to reinforce equity and fair access to programme support, reducing disproportional benefits that often favor the more elite, powerful and less poor. 18. Target group. Agricultural camps in the target area consist on average of 1,000 (Luapula) to 1,500 (Northern) rural smallholder households. S3P aims at working in about 150 camps distributed over three provinces, reaching an average of 200 smallholders per camp that would participate directly in the main activities of S3P, notably the FFS-type groups (about 10 groups/camp) to improve access to improved technology and markets The core target group beneficiaries would therefore consist, of 30,000 smallholders households, equivalent to around 150,000 people (average size of 5 persons/household)1 in the associated households or about 20 per cent of the rural population in targeted camps. An expected 50 per cent of these core participants would be women farmers2. Selection of these groups would be based on self-targeting mechanisms according to core criteria of the programme (see Table 4). Eligibility will require that group members are involved in small-scale cassava and/or mixed bean production systems (which includes groundnuts in the rotation amongst other crops) and/or grow rice or are interested in growing rice. Groups will range in extent of formality (from cooperatives to “clubs”) and diversity of membership will be encouraged, e.g. women, youth, members from disadvantaged households. 19. The core target group also includes those (i) farmers who gain access to improved planting material (output of component 1.3), as well as other technological improvements through farmers organizations supported by Component 1.1 and/or partners (sub-component 1.2) and (ii) households who benefit from improved community investments and infrastructure (Component 2.1) but which are not counted in above. This second direct beneficiary group is estimated to consist of a further 30,000 smallholder households, equivalent to some 150,000 people or 20 per cent of the population in targeted camps. The total number of direct beneficiaries, would therefore amount to 60,000 households, equivalent to 300,000 people, or 40 per cent of the population of targeted camps. Table 2. Summary of Project Beneficiaries (conservative estimates) Description Provinces targeted Districts targeted Coverage Luapula, Northern and third Province 24 districts in 3 Provinces Agricultural Camps targeted for intensive support Farmer groups and households targeted Other farmers/HHs in target area benefitting from improved planting material, seeds, advisory services and/or community infrastructure Total direct beneficiaries 1 2 Assumptions 150 1,500 groups with 30,000 smallholder HHs (150,000 people) About 30% of total camps in 3 provinces. Average 1,000 HHs per camp 10 groups per camp 20 HHs pr group 5 persons/HH 30,000 smallholder HHs (150,000 people) 20% of camp HHs 60,000 smallholder HHs (300,000 persons) About 40% of total population of targeted camps Zambia census 2000 The standard minimum percentage of female project beneficiaries/participants in Zambia. 51 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 20. Indirect beneficiaries would include cassava, mixed beans/groundnut and/or rice producing smallholders that do not live in the targeted camps, but who would nevertheless (in due course) be able to gain access to improved technologies (in particular varieties and CF technologies) generated by S3P. It is assumed that those living within Luapula, Northern and third province to be determined and included in the programme would be the first to gain access to improved planting material. Those living outside Luapula and Northern provinces, but within Agro-Ecological Region III would be the second indirect beneficiaries. 21. Finally, an important category of stakeholders who will benefit from S3P support include both men and women MACO staff, particularly Camp Extension Officers (CEOs) working in the 150 target camps, their Block Extension Supervisors (BESs), the 24 District Agricultural Coordinators and their technical teams, will be included in programme capacity building (including the MACO district gender focal points). Staff from ZARI research stations in Mansa and Kasama will greatly benefit from the capacity development activities foreseen by the project. Technical staff from partner organizations working with the project including service providers will also be able to benefit from S3P’s capacity building programme. In complement, members of the Camp Agricultural Committees (CACs) in the targeted camps, and members of the 24 District Agricultural Committees (DACs) will benefit from capacity building. Table 4: Summary of S3P targeting and gender mainstreaming mechanisms Geographic targeting – focus on poor rural areas with potential for growth Self-targeting measures- create an inclusive environment that reduces barriers and attracts participation among the productive poor ensuring benefits respond to their priority needs & livelihoods Direct targeting – programme benefits channelled to specific individual or households Empowerment measures –give target groups at least equal chances to access project activities Based on criteria prioritizing entry points as high-production areas of cassava, mixed beans/groundnuts and/or rice - with potential for participation of existing or prospective producer groups; these are subsistence-based, food-security crops with market potential , greatly cultivated by women (see above for commodity selection criteria); Alignment with SAPP MACO will advise on district and sub-district target Camps for intervention based on agreed criteria Guided by core criteria: smallholder farmers are already organised in farmer groups (producer groups, cooperatives, informal associations etc.) or willing and have potential to join such groups, having limited external support, and potential to be linked to markets. Inclusive, adaptive approaches and graduated packages and capacity building programmes responding to needs, livelihood conditions and endowments of potential target groups Participatory Capacity building programmes (FFS-type) responding to smallholder priority needs If M&E results at mid-term show evidence of poor gender mainstreaming, quotas would be established and earmarked to ensure 30 % of project activities benefit women (trainings; membership in producer groups; support to women’s producer groups; leadership roles; matching grants earmarked for women groups) Appropriate agricultural technologies, cooperative and group activities and enterprises that take labour and other constraints of HIV/AIDS-affected households into account will be promoted. Specific attention focussed in supporting institutional strengthening of existing farmers associations and their federations at district level; Ensure that capable women groups and women members in mixed groups are included among groups/committees supported. Also promote involvement of members of HIV/AIDs- affected households and youth Gender issues will be included modules of capacity development programmes in order to promote gender mainstreaming –Attention given to women’s needs/priorities for adaptive research, technology adaption etc. (i.e. time/ workloads, labour-saving) Promote women as officers in providing agricultural services (i.e.. MACO, others) and encourage service provision to target needs and priorities of women and other marginalized groups. In parallel, strengthen role and effectiveness of MACO Gender Focal Points at District level. Promote women’s participation in all capacity development activities of S3P (agricultural training, farmer field schools, lead farmers commodity groups, organisational and business training, committee support) Promote activities that benefit women in local planning processes 52 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Enabling measures – create an sustain a policy & institutional environment favourable to gender equality and women’s empowerment Procedural measures – ensure gender-equitable participation in , and benefit from planned activities Monitoring targeting – monitor outputs, outcomes, & emerging impacts as they relate to target groups Policy and legislative reviews, studies and workshops related to Component 2.2 will give attention to gender equality and empowerment (e.g. MACO devolution strategy, demand-driven research-extension services, cassava-based farming systems) Women will be encouraged to participate in advocacy, policy dialogue events Relevant messages about gender mainstreaming and HIV/AIDS will be integrated in programme activities, e.g. in the terms of reference of service providers, and linked to trainings District-level Gender Focal Points supported toward sustaining gendermainstreaming in MACO policies, programmes and activities During staff recruitment processes/selection should give consideration to capacity, qualifications and performance in gender mainstreaming (TORs) and women should be encouraged to apply Service providers should evidence competence/experience with gender mainstreaming and be encouraged to have women staff, and partners should be encouraged to participate in gender capacity building Key project events: launching, workshops, and communications and circular should include aspects of gender and also HIV/AIDS Project should allocate sufficient resources to gender mainstreaming Use of participatory M&E methodologies to analyse and learn lessons at regular intervals the extent to which programme interventions have reached expected target groups: smaller and poorer producers including women (and youth) and how project has adequately addressed their priorities. Remedial actions, notably at mid-term review, to adjust programme approaches as required in response to M&E results to ensure compliance with targeting and gender mainstreaming strategies Use of gender-disaggregated indicators for logframe and M&E systems to analyse project benefits (agricultural knowledge & practices, economic, organisational, social and representative) accessed by women, and if possible, other marginalized groups (youth) Gender-sensitive beneficiary and impact assessments to determine project outcomes and impacts on women (might include case studies on increased empowerment of women and female-headed households as a result of programme activities) Gender Targeting 22. Institutional environment: MACO has committed to mainstreaming gender in its current policies, programmes, organisational structure and procedures and activities in line with Zambia’s National Gender Policy (2002) and the subsequent Strategic Plan of Action for the National Gender Policy (2004-2007), as well as the Fifth National Development Plan (2006-2010).1 MACO, like other line ministries and government institutions have been supported in this effort by the Gender in Development Division (GIDD) of the Cabinet Office, who is the responsible coordinating body for supporting implementation of, and to facilitate research and resource mobilisation in gender mainstreaming in development programmes. 23. To champion this task, each ministry has designated Gender Focal Persons (GFPs), in the case of MACO, a Senior Rural Sociologist of the Policy and Planning Department (PPD), complemented by designated GFPs in each department at national level and in each District. The GFPs has received gender training and orientation, but have realised little in practical results. A number of institutional constraints prevent promotion of gender mainstreaming within MACO e.g. inadequate resources and prioritisation; legal frameworks regarding MACO and its activities are largely silent on gender; accountability for gender mainstreaming and buy in – notably at leadership levels from the top– is unclear and in need of strengthening; limited reporting exists and no formats are designed for tracking gender inclusion in MACO activities or capturing progress made; MACO staff lack gender awareness and training in gender mainstreaming in order to effectively incorporate gender issues in their work; little orientation of new staff; no gender mainstreaming in curricula of agricultural colleges; and little attention 1 With clauses including e.g. 30 % of land allocated reserved or women; ensuring women’s access to agricultural extension and credit; collection of gender disaggregated data. 53 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report given to best practices with few examples despite the significant role of women in the agricultural sector. 24. Within MACO, there are no gender equity measures for recruitment, promotion, training or careers paths. The GIDD Audit (2010)1 reports four women are Directors but most women are positioned at middle to lower ranks. Overall, MACO seeks to ensure that the standard 30 percent of its workforce are female (of a total staff roster currently in the range of 650) and this goal appears to be achieved, notably in the extension services2. Two of nine PACOs are currently women, but only three of 72 DACOS are women3. The posting of female staff as Camp Officers to remote rural areas remains a challenge as women prefer to work closer to urban areas where better social services are accessible4. However women farmers indicated that they found it easier to work with female extension workers5. Further, it has been reported that women who attend group meetings found it difficult to persuade the whole family to adopt extension messages and that the group approach alone does not empower women sufficiently because the whole household must be involved. 25. MACO GFPs in Districts6 face similar constraints as at national level, and have expressed feeling a lack of support that they require to assume their roles. Exchanges with GFPs indicate frustration - they are insufficiently briefed and equipped to perform their tasks. At district levels, it is repeatedly said that there is insufficient priority on gender mainstreaming, notably in MACO and also among many other line ministries. Despite that GFPs exist at Province level (MFNP) to support district-level GFPs from all ministries (through capacity building, information sharing, etc.), there is inadequate attention. According to GFPs, sensitization and awareness raising within ministries is vital to improving gender mainstreaming – this includes from camp level up. Capacity building, with analytical tools and support for planning and M&E with disaggregated data collection is also lacking. Perhaps most important, one GFP mentions, ministries need to get serious about gender: internalisation is lacking. The enabling environment for gender mainstreaming within MACO merits strengthening and commitment. The GIDD Audit has provided a range of recommendations but progress has been slow in their uptake. 26. Overview of gender roles in rural context: women play a central role in the agricultural sector as described above (80 percent of food producers), but are traditionally marginalized from decision-making and control of assets and incomes 7. Division of labour is differentiated, with fields and farming activities separate along gender lines. Women are overburdened with subsistence farming and other household chores –contributing to at least 60 percent of farm labour, collection of water and firewood, and assuming responsibility for childcare and numerous household tasks 8. When subsistence-oriented, household-based enterprises dominated by women become more commercial however, husbands are more likely to become involved. Men control most income from the sale of crops (cash crops). Women have little access to laboursaving technologies, hired labour, extension services, and are in weak decision-making positions in traditional rural households9. Women and youth have been reported as unable to access land, customary inheritance practices continue to discriminate against women, and land-grabbing from widows and orphans has also been reported 10. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 GIDD (2010). Farnworth C.R. and M. Munachonga (2010) Gender Approaches in Agricultural Programmes – Zambia Country Report. A Special Report of Agricultral Support Programme (ASP), Sida Mr. Kunda, MACO Gender Focal Point and Rural Sociologist, personal communication. For example 23 Camp Extension Officers (CEOs), or 16 percent of all CEOs in Luapula are reported to be women. Personal communication. John Myunga. Farnworth C.R. and M. Munachonga (2010). District Gender Committees also exist as a sub-committee of DDCCs Bishop-Sambrook, C and C. Wonani (2008) The Household Approach as an Effective Tool for Gender Empowerment: A Review of the Policy, Process and Impact of Gender Mainstreaming in the Agricultural Support Programme (ASP) in Zambia. SAPP WP1; NAP draft (2011). Bishop-Sambrook, C and C. Wonani (2008). Zambia Land Alliance. Luapula Province. 54 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 27. However gradual changes are possible, and some projects working with MACO, such as the recently completed Agricultural Support Programme (ASP) show promising results concerning gender empowerment and also HIV/AIDS mainstreaming through that MACO could build from1. Lessons and recommendations particularly relevant to S3P include: Strengthen MACO commitment to gender at the highest levels, stress accountability and ensure gender-disaggregated data in M&E to evidence the difference gender mainstreaming makes in people’s lives; promote a gender-sensitive environment for community mobilisation and service delivery; ensure all staff - notably service delivery - are involved in gender mainstreaming and sufficiently build their capacity to do so (with accompanying materials and manuals); continue to apply the 30 percent women’s participation minimum target that is commonly used in all gender mainstreaming approaches nationally; ensure communication strategies incorporate gender mainstreaming; make use of local contact /lead farmers to enable them to train others and deliberately target local women to improve gender equality and ensure that women farmers have a cadre of extension workers that specifically address their practical and strategic gender needs; strengthen women’s empowerment capacities in organisation, leadership and business planning. 28. Gender mainstreaming approach: to ensure adequate gender mainstreaming in the project, a pro-active gender targeting will be incorporated into the programme through the design of a gender mainstreaming strategy that will be cross-cutting throughout all interventions. This strategy will be detailed during the S3P design of the programme implementation manual (PIM). The strategy will align with both IFAD and Zambia national policies, which advocate that in addition to ensuring equal opportunities, special attention or affirmative action (such as sensitization, training, pro-active measures, targeted adapted technologies) may likely be required to promote women’s participation in and access to programme activities and benefits. These mechanisms will require monitoring continuously over time to ensure not only quantitative achievements (numbers of women trained, lead farmers etc.) but also qualitative changes (e.g. leading roles played by women, gradual changes of women’s roles and voice in the household, in groups, in communities). 29. Across programme activities, notably those concerning improved agricultural services, adapted technologies, strengthening research-extension linkages of Component One, attention will be given to addressing priorities of households that may be marginalized or disadvantaged and less endowed but capable to participate (femaleheaded, HIV/AIDs-affected and youth-headed households etc.). For example laboursaving technologies such as conservation farming, and adapted farming systems that include mixed farming practices contributing to labour efficiency and dietary and nutritional benefits will be promoted. Likewise, activities supporting smallholder land use planning, community-level land use management rules and land tenure security will be gender sensitive and include for example boundary demarcation of female-headed households and women’s fields according to households as appropriate. These activities would include collecting disaggregated gender and wealth ranking data on the range and average size of land parcels being accessed by various users for cultivation purposes, eventually resulting in clarification of landholdings and greater security among women farmers. This information would strengthen measuring S3P impact disaggregated by gender, and also facilitate women’s increased investments in production and access to financial resources. 1 see the household approach model of ASP applied in Northern, Central and Southern Provinces in BishopSambrook and Wonani (2008); and Farnworth and Munachonga (2010). 55 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 30. As outlined in the summary targeting and gender mainstreaming table above, a number of measures will be undertaken in S3P to promote gender-sensitivity: programme management and implementation procedures; access to programme services and benefits that are adapted to priorities and needs of women (e.g. adapted technologies); promotion of women’s empowerment; strengthening a gender-equitable enabling environment in the agricultural sector; monitoring programme interventions to ensure adequate strengthening of women’s equity and empowerment. 56 Annex 3. Country Performance and Lessons Learned Key File 2: Organizational Capability Matrix Weaknesses Opportunities/threats Remarks Ministry of Agriculture and Cooperatives National influence and expertise in all facets of agricultural production. Existence of necessary extension network (camps, blocks and district structures) and working as main interface with farmers Has attempted to rollout Participatory Extension Approach for a number of years Extension workers, block supervisors and subject matter specialists qualified enough to adapt to introduction of new methodologies Existence of farmer institutes training centres in each district for demonstration of appropriate technologies and training of farmer management skills Existence of Farm Institutes for In-service Training and higher level farmer training Many messages on farm production and productivity still relevant Need for strong leadership to modernize and fully decentralize functions Existence of necessary network for veterinary services and livestock extension Both DoLVS and DoF OPPORTUNITIES: MACO has noted legal constraints. Planning to review and rationalize relevant statutes MOL has adopted policy of allocating at least 30% of land titles to women in the state land to improve their access to land; CAADP under the AU/NEPAD supporting Zambia and other African countries to develop Compact as a rallying initiative for coordinated support to agriculture – targeting 6% agric growth, 10% expenditure allocation to the sector A re-emergence of global interest in funding agriculture Many organisations willing to partner with MACO’s extension and research services Accepted by farmers as the lead institution to provide agric services Existence of PPP models in extension and research that could be extended to other areas THREATS Most of the traditional systems that regulate land tenure treat women as minors who cannot directly own land Centralization of political power unsupportive to Community-Driven Development Agriculture governed by many pieces of legislation managed by different organisations. Contradictory statutes in some cases Absence of key legislation like the Agric Credit Act constraining private sector role in agriculture Ministry of Livestock and Fisheries Development FRA and FISP accounting for two-thirds of budget leaving little for operations Reduced number and quality of MACO publications (e.g. annual statistics and monthly bulletins) indicative of weak M&E systems. MACO’s inability to deliver quality services due to: A lack of organisational flexibility Inadequate operational resources in general Inability by officers at district, block and camp level to visit farmers or support farmers’ initiatives due to lack of resources High number of unfilled positions at district, block and camp levels Inadequate training and exposure to modern methodologies by extension staff Assumption during the 1990s liberalization that extension would be largely privatized leaving a big gap Lack of coordinating mechanisms with other ministries and organisations (MOL, MCDSS, MCTI, ZDA, etc) Weak sector policy leadership Weak financial management systems Weak capacity to modernize and discharge key functions for a Ministry of Agriculture in a modern pluralistic paradigm for service provision Weak partnerships with DPs mostly due to lack of agreement on budget allocation Weak capacity to enforce existing legislation New ministry in existence for only two years. Still developing systems and strengthening sub-national structures Yet to demonstrate strong sector policy leadership OPPORTUNITIES Increasing appreciation of the importance of livestock including small livestock and fisheries in rural livelihoods New chance to think through legislation, Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Strengths 57 Organization Organization Strengths adopted participatory approach. Strongly backed for DoF by the amended Fisheries Act of 2007 Ministry of Community Development and Social Services (MCDSS) Existence of an elaborate institutional framework for social protection (SP) in general and the Public Welfare Assistance Scheme (PWAS) in particular rising from community to national level The PWAS has a well elaborated reporting system targeted at Huge capacity deficit due to historical neglect in public funding to livestock and fisheries to prevent and control diseases of nat’l economic importance leading to a broad decline in livestock service delivery over the years High number of unfilled positions at district and sub-district levels with the DoF especially only having token presence in most fisheries, except during the annual closed season (1st December to 28th February) when it makes a concerted effort to enforce the ban on fishing activities. Weak capacity to enforce existing legislation by both livestock and fisheries departments Inadequate clarity regarding authority to allocate land between the state (president), traditional leadership and local authorities Centralized issuance of certificate of title makes it very costly for potential title holders ; Lack of coordination of land use functions spread among different institutions; Lack of systematic planning in the land delivery process; and, Lack of a systematic mechanism to deal with abuse of office by the agent of the Commissioner of Lands. MCDSS occupies weak space in the wider GRZ institutional framework to be an effective champion of SP agenda and policy due to: SP roles spread across a range of ministries besides the MCDSS (e.g. Labour, Agriculture, Health and Education), grant funded organisations like NAC and NGOs. Weak liaison between the SP-SAGs, the MFNP and sector ministries MCDSS has challenges to secure wider Opportunities/threats Remarks policies and strategies in the new ministry THREATS Livestock farmers low willingness to pay hindering development of a private sector driven veterinary services Important legislation like the Water, Wildlife and Land Acts paying scanty attention to fisheries Some chiefs owning personal lagoons not subject to seasonal closure interfering with management of legislation THREATS Inadequate sensitisation on conversion of customary tenure to lease hold tenure; Differences in the nature and form of customary land tenure across the country. Lack of guidelines on the role and functions of traditional authorities and local authorities in land dministration; Unclear assignment of land rights and responsibilities; Lack of popular participation by the local people in land alienation decision; OPPORTUNITIES Existence of coordination forums at provincial, district and sub-district levels provides many opportunities for the MCDSS to sell and allow other agencies to buy into its agenda Donor keenness and willingness to support social protection THREATS Little public pressure on government to provide social protection to the poor Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Recent improvements in data capturing and management in land allocation and ownership 58 Ministry of Lands Weaknesses Organization Strengths Weaknesses 59 Research Institutions Zambia Agriculture Research Institute (ZARI), Golden Valley Agricultural Research Trust (GART), University of Zambia (UNZA) Local Government Structures ZARI’s research agenda setting participatory in a bottom-up fashion ZARI stations located strategically in the three agro-ecological zones GART’s diverse nature of funding sources allows it to undertake research of interest to both small scale and commercial farmers UNZA research playing special role as main objective is to contribute to qualifications of UNZA staff and add to their publications lists Current staffing of ZARI at 73% of the establishment in 2009 as well the qualification and quality of researchers (MSc and PhD holders) judged as satisfactory Deconcentration of MACO to provinces, districts and camps better political buy-in in the SP agenda Limited capacity for policy analysis and training and professional development undermining needed confidence to assume strong leadership role Weak ownership and commitment within the MCDSS to some aspects of SP such as cash transfers which are more championed by donors The functionality of PWAS undermined by the low and erratic funding Weak sustainability of the PWAS system due to dependency on volunteers MCDSS state of physical assets and infrastructure in districts including office accommodation very poor Of late and due to funding challenges, ZARI participatory approach to research agenda setting not working as well as it once did with frequency of meetings and the participation of a wide range of partners declining. Low budget execution rates for ZARI, especially for regional stations as well as the erratic and unpredictable monthly releases affecting negatively the continuity of the work. All donor contributions to GART (more than 50% of research funding) earmarked grants for specific activities which restricts its research agenda setting based on perceived needs Links between UNZA research, ZARI and extension service virtually non-existent Socio-economic researchers underrepresented in the research system, undermining understanding on low productivity despite existence of necessary technologies Very limited management capacities. Few resources reaching sub-national levels. Staff demotivated Opportunities/threats Remarks Not seen by more “powerful” ministries as a particularly convincing policy champion in the field of poverty reduction OPPORTUNITY Increasing regional cooperation in agriculture research Reemerging international interest in supporting agriculture research THREATS Most senior researchers at ZARI nearing retirement age. OPPORTUNITIES Existence of a Decentralisation Policy Inclusion of decentralisation in the draft Development of local Government structures is ongoing but Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report financial allocations, resource provision and beneficiary targeting and receipts. Data aggregation and provincial performance reports are produced at provincial level before submission to the HQ Organization Weaknesses Opportunities/threats advanced under MACO compared to other ministries. MACO at all these levels Some political accountability for local services. Inadequate staffing levels Too much staff hours spent on FISP management at critical time in farming season constitution District and sub-district structures (DDCC, ADC, ZDC, VDC) allowing interorganisational cooperation MACO well recognised at district and subdistrict levels Traditional Authority Very good understanding of and strong influence on communal life. Limited technical capacity. Inexperience in market-based development. Apex Farmer Organisations (AFOs) – Zambia National Farmers Union, Peasant Farmers Association of Zambia, Women in Agriculture Membership driven and thus credible with farmers Committed leadership Written constitutions to guide operations Available support (technical and financial) from donors For ZNFU, a functional secretariat with capable management and technical staff Extensive networking and linkages among farmer organizations Represented on key dialogue platforms. Have opportunity to influence policy/ operating environment Credibility with governments and other stakeholders. Cooperatives and other farmer groups Voluntary grassroots organization High level farmer interest THREATS Inadequate political will to carryout decentralisation in eight years since Policy adopted Remarks incomplete. OPPORTUNITIES Partner in participatory development. Not necessarily representative of participating smallholders Limited financial resources and funding sources although things better for ZNFU Donor dependency especially ZNFU Poor and limited communication systems Apart from ZNFU, other AFOs have inadequate office accommodation Non-ZNFU AFOs lack own assets Inadequate human capacity at leadership and secretariat levels in non-ZNFU AFOs Inadequate skills in leadership, advocacy and lobbying Non-ZNFU AFOs lacking adequate accounting systems Inadequate promotional activities, marketing OPPORTUNITIES A vast untapped membership Increasing donor support to social economic development Political stability and improving policy environment Weak management and poorly organized Dominance of only a few individuals Cooperatives that only become active OPPORTUNITIES Good entry point for farmer mobilization and service provision THREATS Government policy inconsistency Majority of potential members engaged in low profit agriculture activities Poor rural infrastructure hampering effective communication with members as well members access to markets leading to low earnings The devastating impacts of HIV&AIDS Non payment of registration and annual subscription Inadequate support from donors (for nonZNFU AFOs) and government Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 60 Strengths Organization 61 Bank and Micro-Finance Institutions Weaknesses Opportunities/threats Good interface with other structures at community level Strong and vibrant in areas where projects worked with farmer groups/ cooperatives during fertilizer distribution Cooperatives not fully compliant with the Cooperatives Act Few financial resources THREATS Political interests able to hijack agenda of farmer organisations Driven by profit motive. Efficiency. Growing interest in providing services to smallholders. Flexibility in matching supply and demand. Outgrower funding for some crops – cotton, tobacco, flowers. Rising domestic savings as a share of GDP from about 6% in the 1990s to around 16.5% in the 2000s – surpassed SSA corresponding average in 2006 Number of commercial bank branches has grown rapidly in the period 2006-2009; reaching 264 across 17 banks as of September 2009 Number of ATMs increased from 54 to 295 over the period 20042008 Innovative money transfer schemes emerging such as mobile transfer systems Small stock market intermediaries colluding. Limited access to credit. Limited outreach of support services. OPPORTUNITIES Extension and marketing services. BANKING SECTOR Low financial intermediation due to small size and coverage of banking sector; Dependency of bank earnings on lending to blue chip corporate companies, foreign exchange trading and trading in Government securities; Labour market rigidities – restrictive labour legislation, immigration procedures and limited training programmes for banking professionals Complex liquidation process for banks in liquidation; Poor credit culture; Weak legal infrastructure; The high cost of banking services; High cost of credit despite declining inflation rates due to high operational costs and risk OPPORTUNITIES Improving policy and regulatory environment An increasingly stable macroeconomic environment Small farmers willingness to participate in savings and credit schemes MICRO-FINANCE INSTITUTIONS Micro, small and medium enterprise finance continues to lag behind peer countries, in part driven by the predominantly informal status of micro and small enterprises THREATS Policy inconsistencies Unsupportive regulatory environment THREATS Poor credit culture due to lack of a credit reference bureau, Inadequate legal infrastructure, significant share of business owners is unaware of micro-credit opportunities Low demand for financial services due to high poverty levels Remarks Poorly developed wholesale supply chain and transport infrastructure. Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Private sector Strengths Organization Strengths International NGOs Have secure sources of funding. Ability to employ capable motivated staff. Limited knowledge of local environment. Limited local capacity building. Local ownership of development interventions sometimes weak. Opportunities/threats OPPORTUNITIES Able to build own capacity through work with international NGOs. Possible partners for community capacity building interventions. THREATS Steady increase in number and quality of Local NGOs focused on rural and agricultural development. OPPORTUNITIES Economic group mobilisation and training. Rural finance initiatives. Remarks Mixed experience of contribution of I-NGOs to IFAD-funded projects in Zambia. Confusion between roles of service provider and donor. Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Good understanding of local environment Dearth of skilled human resource occasioned by: Different accounting and auditing standards, Lack of financial safety nets, Inefficient payments system Inadequate rural branch network Limited liquidity due to the crowding-out effects of Government’s borrowing from the banking system and tight monetary policy (i.e. high statutory reserves) Cumbersome procedures and requirements for opening a savings account Commercial banks consider lending to smallholder farmers to be very risky Lack of understanding of business and markets. Operating on very small scale. 62 Local NGOs Weaknesses Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Lessons learned 1. A general lesson from all interventions supported by Zambia’s development partners is that GRZ agencies working in agriculture and rural development face challenges taking on new functions or assuming new ways of delivering services. This points to the need for simplicity in project design; for the establishment of coordination units that can support the line functions; for implementation support to assist project coordinators manage for development results; and for building national ownership over the projects. The establishment of informal stakeholder reference groups to guide project design and implementation processes – something that has been done during recent design processes – has proved a useful mechanism for doing so. In addition, financial management and accountability is not consistently strong within GRZ, and this mean that it is not appropriate to fully rely on national systems for disbursement and management of loan funds; there is instead need for separate accounts, careful cashflow management and active support to financial management systems, as well as specific safeguard measures to avoid the possibility of funds being used for non-project purposes. 2. Projects have typically been managed by national coordinators recruited specifically for the posts, and some have involved recruitment of service providers to conduct key project activities. Experience has shown both that the recruitment process itself can be slow – and in this support to GRZ may be necessary; and that contracted staff and service providers have not always performed to the standards required. Here, it is critical that contracts allow for regular review of performance and opportunities for renewal or termination, according to that performance. There has also been insufficient collaboration and learning between projects; insufficiently strong governance arrangements; and, till recently, inadequate follow-up and support from IFAD. A related key lesson has been that projects have benefited enormously where they have been able to mobilise a pool of short-term business consultants to address specific constraints and to make use of specific opportunities for rapid response to problems and opportunities. 3. GRZ decision making is consensual, though this can be slow and it can result in delays in project implementation. Nevertheless, it is important to respect these processes and time spans if ownership for the projects is to be maintained. An example is new ways of working with the private sector. GRZ in general, and MACO in particular, is committed to giving a greater role to other stakeholders in the agricultural sector. Yet in practice, it is still at an early stage of implementing these principles, and it needs assistance to develop appropriate models and pilot partnerships. 4. Historically, Zambia has had a strong welfare culture, reflected both in government policies and donor-supported projects that offered investments and grants without commitment from the rural population. This led to a culture of dependency and stifled initiative, as well as wasted public resources. Government is now trying to promote a “mindset change”, promoting farming as a business and encouraging a savings culture. These efforts need to be actively supported, and located within a larger vision of private sector-led agricultural development; and at the same time care needs to be taken to avoid approaches that could undercut the efforts being made to bring about this important change in mindset. 5. A set of lessons highlighted in the recent PCR validation exercise for SHEMP conducted by IOE, of particular importance for S3P, is that the support provided for farmers’ participation in commodity value chains is appropriate and that there are agribusiness value chains that have the potential to improve small-farmer incomes in a relatively short period of time. The rapid development of communications technology offers many agribusiness development opportunities which could not have been imagined a few years ago. However, it is not appropriate to look at the post-production links in the value chain without also looking at on-farm production, which is of course a key link in the value chain. This was not addressed under SHEMP; and indeed, a market for cassava was found but then lost again as farmers proved unable to expand their 63 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report production to supply in the quantities required. The follow-up to SHEMP – SAPP – was developed too soon to take on board this lesson, and it too provides no direct support for farm production. It is now clear that if farmers are to participate more effectively in commodity value chains, then they need support to increase their productivity and respond to the demands of the market – all within a context where farming is seen as a business which is part of complex commercial networks. These are the issues that S3P will respond to. 6. The PCRs for both SHEMP and FRMP pointed to the enormous importance of rural infrastructure – particularly access roads, to link remote rural communities to markets for agricultural inputs and produce, and consumer goods, and to health and education services. Although labour-based techniques for road works have had a mixed success, they bring important benefits beyond the road itself; lessons have been learnt under SHEMP, and they should be supported. However, prioritisation and selection of roads is a key issue; as is road maintenance, and arrangements for the subsequent maintenance of any road constructed or rehabilitated need to be in place prior to making investments. 7. Finally, there have been a number of lessons learnt regarding project sustainability: (a) implementation of interventions that have been anchored in farmer or trader representative organizations greatly improves the prospects of sustainability; (b) capacity building within the public sector is needed to provide “public good” services and improve the enabling environment for private sector development; (c) utilising existing farmer groups, rather than creating new ones, avoids duplication and improves sustainability; (d) linkages to, and cooperation with, other agribusiness development programmes offers scope for further development of interventions; (e) encouraging relevant private sector companies to participate in and co-finance aspects of the intervention plans ensured a sense of ownership and commitment; and (f) some interventions may need to be extended in time to become fully sustainable – this calls for periodic review and refinement of intervention plans. 64 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 4. Detailed Programme Description 1. The Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) has as overall goal: Income levels, food and nutrition security sustainably improved for poor agricultural households in target areas. The indicators at the goal level include: up to 48,000 smallholder households (80% of direct beneficiaries) achieve at least one of the following by programme completion: (i) increase in HH asset ownership; (ii) increase in HH savings; (iii) reduction in prevalence of child malnutrition; (iv) reduction in food insecurity (see Logical Framework). 2. The S3P purpose or development objective is: Production, productivity and sales of smallholder farmers in target area sustainably increased. The associated indicators include: (i) average crop yields of cassava, rice, mixed beans and/or groundnuts of 30,000 smallholder HHs increased by at least 30 percent; (ii) quantities of cassava, rice, mixed beans and/or groundnuts marketed by 40,000 smallholder HHs increased by at least 20 percent; (iii) vulnerability of 10,000 smallholder HHs to climatic variation affecting crop production and/or market access reduced. 3. The main farming system in the programme area is the traditional chitimene slash and burn system in which maintenance of soil fertility is ensured by cutting shrubs and branches of bigger trees, concentrating these on the area to be planted and burning them. The plot is then planted with finger millet, usually mixed with other crops (pumpkin, cassava, sorghum for example) in the first year, followed by a mixture of cassava, mixed beans, and groundnuts in the following three or four seasons. The plot is then left fallow for 20 to 25 years to restore forest cover and soil fertility. Farmers with access to suitable lowlands in areas with sufficient rainfall cultivate small plots of rice, especially in Northern Province. The main food crops are cassava and mixed beans, while rice, groundnuts and finger millet (for the production of local beer) are partially consumed and represent the main cash crops. 4. Although population density is still low, it has become too high to sustain the chitimene system, especially in areas with better road access. Farmers are therefore gradually adopting technologies for more permanent cultivation of their fields. This includes preparing semi-permanent or permanent ridges where soil fertility is managed by incorporation of green manure, more careful crop rotation with leguminous crops and localised use of manure and fertilizer. 5. Cassava, mixed beans and groundnuts will serve as main entry points to improve stability, productivity and profitability of smallholder production systems in the target areas. In addition, S3P will support diversification of farming system in response to market opportunities, including rice. Smallholders and their organizations will be supported to better understand and respond to market opportunities. Cassava, mixed beans and rice are also targeted by SAPP for improvement of the overall value chain. S3P investment in the “supply-push” side of production development is expected to complement the “market-pull” investment under SAPP, and also complements other initiatives supported by GRZ and development partners1. These commodities are central in high rainfall smallholder farming systems, significant for household food and nutrition security and income, and central for women farmers, with high potential for value chain up-scaling. Increased smallholder production and productivity is expected to generate substantial additional rural economic activity and contribute directly to improved household and national food security, as well as improved livelihoods. 6. The programme area is largely determined by the production area of the crops targeted. Initially, intensive support from both SAPP and S3P will focus on Luapula and Northern Provinces, which together account for some 70-80 per cent of national cassava 1 For example, the Finnish cooperation in Luapula are strongly supporting the development of cassava, beans and rice; JICA is particularly active in promoting beans and rice both in Luapula and Northern province; whereas SNV is the main supporter of the rice value chain development in Northern Province. 65 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report and mixed bean production and are also areas of significant potential for groundnut and rice production. Some activities target the entire Province (strengthening of MACO including research) while other activities target key production areas for the different crops (clusters)1 with highest potential for increased marketable surpluses. S3P will also have a broader impact from the wider adaptation of technologies developed, infrastructure constructed, and improved policy and legal framework. 7. The target group consists of productive smallholder/small-scale farmers2 who derive a majority of their livelihood resources from agricultural production with a potential for increasing significantly their share of marketed production of cassava, mixed beans, rice and/or groundnuts. Direct beneficiaries will be organized farmers groups and/or cooperatives, or producers willing to join such groups. Further to the direct beneficiaries, technologies and approaches developed under S3P will induce spillover and feed scaling-up processes within the cassava based production systems of AEZ III. 8. S3P will adopt a phased programmatic approach, and will have a duration of seven years. It will start in eight districts in Luapula and Northern Provinces and will gradually expand to cover up to 24 districts in these plus a third provinces. S3P will have two components, each divided into three sub-components: (i) Sustainable smallholder productivity growth; and (ii) Enabling environment for productivity growth. Component 1: Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth (US$ 24.2 million) 9. The objective of this component is to improve smallholders access to knowledge, extension3, adapted technologies and improved planting material. These improved services will support sustainable productivity growth and diversification of smallholders involved in cassava-based production systems in target areas. The programme will contribute to gradually increase farmer group capacities to identify and analyse opportunities for local agricultural and economic growth, to advocate for changes in agricultural policies and demand quality services from the responsible authorities. The project will strengthen the capacity of MACO to coordinate and deliver quality advisory services in the target areas including the generation of technology adapted to local needs. S3P will also facilitate the establishment of partnerships with other players in the target areas (private sector, NGOs etc) to scale-up positive experiences. 10. The expected outcomes are: (a) smallholder groups and organizations in target areas functioning more effectively and empowered to respond to market and rural development opportunities; (b) smallholder farmers in target areas have improved access to more pertinent and effective extension services delivered by MACO as well as farmer organizations and/or private sector; (c) agricultural research and seed multiplication services more responsive to priority needs of smallholder farmers. 11. Component one is organized in three sub-components: (i) strengthening farmer organizations and their federations; (ii) pluralistic participatory extension services; and (iii) agricultural research for development. Sub-component 1.1: Strengthening farmer organizations and their federations (US$ 2.5 million) 12. This sub-component will strengthen membership-based farmer associations and cooperatives in the target areas at camp and district level to improve and diversify the offer of services to farmers. Farmer groups, associations and/or cooperatives and their federations provide services which go beyond, but include, both technical advisory services as well marketing services (for instance bulking). These organizations already exist at camp, block and district level, but their effectiveness is variable depending mainly on their cohesiveness and management capacity. 1 2 3 Clusters will comprise a number of camps/extension blocks where targeted commodities form a key element of production systems and high potentials for value chain development. About 75% of rural population in targeted areas in Northern, Luapula Provinces. In this document, extension and advisory services are used as synonymous 66 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 13. The target is to strengthen 12 DFAs and/or DCUs (50 per cent of the Districts in the project area) and 750 camp level associations in terms of knowledge of their members’ rights and duties, transparent procedures and accounting, consensual decision making, quality of services provided and business planning. Lead farmers and technical staff of District Farmer Association (DFAs) and/or District Cooperative Unions (DCUs) will benefit from technical training provided in Sub-component 1.2, which focuses on technical extension services. They will also be empowered to participate in the planning and review meetings at PACO and DACO level. Although the focus is on strengthening existing farmer organizations, S3P will also assist farmers who are not yet organized but who are interested and willing to start their own association. Once a group has evolved through a series of development stages (see Table 1 below), S3P will assist them to link up to financial institutions that promote saving and credit activities, such as for instance those supported through IFAD-financed Rural Finance Programme (RFP). It will also seek to explore the issue of identifying a sustainable institutional development path for them. 14. The implementation will be outsourced to service providers1 working in this field in Zambia. The contract will foresee the following activities: (a) A detailed assessment of the existing farmer organizations as well as their federations in the target areas, their level of development and capacity and the quality of the services they offer to their members; as well as the main capacity development requirements. (b) Provision of training on priority issues identified in (a). These could include group formation and group dynamics, leadership skills, governance, entrepreneurship skills and business planning (farming as a business), financial management, accounting and legal aspects. (c) Follow-up and on-the-job mentoring of district level federative structures in terms of developing capacities for coordination and service provision. 15. The objective is to improve the access, quality and sustainability of advisory services available to smallholders in target areas. Evolution towards pluralistic smallholder knowledge support and advisory services involves: (i) increased efficiency and result-oriented services provided by MACO through harmonised participatory extension approach; (ii) increased ownership and involvement of local farmer organizations in support service provision to their members (see sub-component 1.1); and (iii) increased provision of services from private enterprises involved in processing and marketing of different commodities. 16. S3P will, therefore, support different sources of advisory services to farmers: MACO, farmer organizations, private or commercial enterprises and NGOs. Subcomponent 1.1 deals with strengthening of farmer organizations. Sub-component 1.2 will strengthen MACO field capacities and establish partnerships with private enterprises and NGOs, to promote an extension process in which: (i) farmers are empowered to demand quality support services (linkage with sub-component 1.1); (ii) service providers work with organized market-oriented farmer groups; (iii) collaboration between MACO and non-government service providers is encouraged; (iv) modern information and telecommunications (ITC) technologies for information access and feedback are increasingly used; and (v) cross-cutting issues, such as gender and HIV/AIDS are mainstreamed. Sub-component 1.2 includes three sets of activities: (a) strengthening of MACO capacities; (b) harmonization of participatory extension services; and (c) partnerships with other providers of extension. 1 There are various international and national organizations working in capacity building of farmer organizations including ActionAid, Zambian National Farmers Union (ZNFU), Zambia Agribusiness Technical Assistance Centre (ZATAC), Community Markets for Conservation (COMACO), CLUSA, MS-Zambia, etc. 67 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 1: Group development stages, characteristics and examples of training modules (Source: adapted from SHEMP - Africare 2002-2007 Closeout Report) Development Stage Stage 1: Inception Characteristics Training modules Indicators -Farmers come together for a purpose -Un developed organizational structure -Loosely structured activities -Direction is lacking -Functions and roles are unclear Awareness -Contact meetings -Benefits of enterprise groups -Examples of success stories and exchange visits -Consolidation/formation of smallholder enterprise group Leadership Training -Roles of members in a group: rights and duties of members -Leadership styles -Qualities of a good leader -Consolidation of group structure Name of group and membership Stage 2: Emergent -Basic organizational structure in place -Purpose and organizational objective clarified -Activities more clearly defined Group registration & functioning -By-laws/constitution formulation -Need for registration and membership fee -Importance of accountability & transparency Leadership Training -Training of Executives -Animator training -Consultative decision making -Development of smallholder enterprise group Entrepreneurship Training -Developing business ideas -Group executives elected -By-law/Constitution -Group registered -Regular group meetings -Bank Account opened -Membership fees Stage 3: Maturing -A group consolidates into an Apex organization -Plan of activities on a wider coverage -Employs some permanent staff to run depot -Focus on the benefits of the members -Vivid linkages with business intermediaries Leadership Training -Planning, organizing and monitoring -Financial management -Property and material management -Group dynamics Entrepreneurship Training -Developing business ideas -Choosing an enterprise -Budgeting -Cash flow plan -Record keeping -Sourcing and handling capital Enterprise Training -Group belongs to an Association -Group linked to savings & credit -Group buying inputs or selling produce together -Group has documented Business Plans Stage 4: Mature -Apex organization able to run own affairs Communication Training -Action planning and resource mobilization -Writing a project proposal Marketing Training -Linkages with service organizations Stage 5: Selfsustaining Group successfully runs profitable enterprises with minimal need for external assistance Recapitulation of modules on the basis of gaps identified -Volume of business and Turnover -Use of own resources -Level of profits realized and management Source: Africare Smallholder Enterprise and Marketing Program (SHEMP):2002-2007 Closeout Report 68 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Sub-component 1.2: Pluralistic participatory extension services (US$ 11.9 million) 17. Strengthening MACO field capacities at Provincial (PACO) and District (DACO) levels, to improve performance and efficiency in order to be able to deliver good quality services to farmers1, including: (i) Provide provincial facilitators based in the PACO’s office to assist the PACO and his/her team and the districts and build their capacities to: (a) coordinate different activities and projects present in the province and its districts, favouring synergies and complementarities; (b) assist in information and knowledge management; (c) prepare their annual work-plans; (d) assist in processing of the investment requests under sub-component 2.1; (d) monitor results and resolve problems. (ii) Quarterly Provincial level planning and review meetings with participation of DACOs and technical staff of the district offices as well as other partners to improve synergies. These quarterly meetings will last one or two days and will provide the opportunity for the DACOs to report to PACO on the progress in the implementation of their work-plan and share useful information with other DACOs. They will also host the AR4D stakeholder platform including research, extension, farmer organizations and other stakeholders involved in the agriculture/agribusiness sector and facilitate the coordination of implementation of AR4D activities. (iii) Quarterly District level planning, information sharing and review meetings for CEOs, BESs and SAOs as well as partners, similar to the meetings at PACO level but with a more operational focus. These meetings will last one or two days and will facilitate planning and priority setting of agricultural support activities, as well as analysis and review of achievements, AR4D activities, and provision of specific training. (iv) Capacity building in procurement and financial management at provincial and district level: training and technical support. This is also linked to the implementation of sub-component 2.1 (District Agricultural Investment Fund). (v) Information and knowledge sharing to contribute to strengthening the culture of knowledge sharing and innovation within MACO field structures. This is one of the important functions of the quarterly meetings. In addition, S3P will provide resources for exchange-visits and participation to knowledge events, regular production and distribution of communication/information material as needed. (vi) Providing mobility and housing to CEOs where needed and appropriate. A total of 85 CEO houses will be constructed and/or rehabilitated in three Provinces in seven years, 30 motorcycles provided and 150 solar panels installed. 18. Harmonization and up-scaling of participatory extension approaches (PEA). MACO has mainstreamed PEA in its extension system but the capacity to implement PEA varies considerably between districts. In addition, different donor supported initiatives have introduced different versions of PEA with different names and slight methodological variations. All of these are inspired by the Farmer Field School (FFS) approach which provides the opportunity for on-farm learning, testing and development of technical options which effectively respond to farmers’ needs. Most methodologies have successfully introduced basic business planning skills, important for farmers to make the most profitable choice for them. S3P will support: 1 There is an on-going project financed by a group of donors including the European Union called Performance Enhancement Project (PEP) which will work on this capacity development at national level. This activity will be implemented in coordination with PEP’s activities (see Annex 6). 69 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report (i) Participatory assessment of current PEA methodologies in the target areas, determining their strengths and weaknesses, involving farmers and extension staff. (ii) Preparation of a harmonized curriculum for Masters training and training of trainers (ToT) in PEA/FFS-type approach, including a module on financial analysis and business planning. (iii) Training of provincial Master Trainers, targeting DAOs, SAOs, staff from partner organizations (and possibly some BESs or CEOs), to form about 10-15 Master Trainers in each targeted province. (iv) ToT at District level. Master trainers will organize ToT at District level targeting CEOs and lead farmers as well as field staff from DFAs/DCUs and other partner organizations. In some cases, the ToTs will provide training to CEOs and lead farmers from more than one District. A total of 3 District level ToTs are planned for Luapula Province, 6 for Northern province and 5 for the third province. About 280 staff/lead farmers will benefit from these trainings. (v) FFS at camp level. CEOs and lead farmers trained as facilitators are expected to facilitate at least one and no more than three FFS-type groups each cropping season; A total of 1500 FFS would be supported in 7 years in three provinces for a total estimate of 30,000 participating farmers. Focus would be on the sustainability of the activities of the group and on business training for the more market oriented groups. The ToTs will benefit not only MACO staff, but also lead farmers working with farmers organizations, the private sector and NGOs. In this way the project would contribute to building the capacities of different sources of advisory services in the project area. (vi) Regular training sessions for MACO field staff at all levels, and CEOs in particular. Training priorities will be identified during the quarterly planning and review meetings at PACO and DACO levels and possibly implemented at the same occasions to limit the costs. Priority will be given to mobilizing local human resources, such as ZARI researchers, technical assistance personnel, farmer organizations, commercial enterprises and NGOs. 19. Partnerships with organizations providing advisory services. There are interesting success stories of organizations and/or enterprises 1 involved in organizing producers for bulking of production to be marketed, medium-scale processing and marketing of mainly cassava, mixed beans, groundnuts and rice. In addition to providing a regular, ensured and growing market for these products, they provide advisory services to producers to ensure regular supply of the product at the requested quality. These organizations have gained considerable experience in the project area, work with the same farmers which will be targeted by S3P and constitute an important asset which could be further strengthened to serve a larger number of farmers. The methodologies used to work with farmers are in line with the participatory methodologies advocated by S3P. The services provided, at present, are partially financed by the profit margin of the processing and marketing business and, in future, could be totally financed by the latter. 20. At the same time, MACO has established a committee specifically to identify opportunities for promoting non-government provision of extension services. The S3P can support this initiative, by helping the committee both to identify opportunities where pluralistic service provision in the agricultural sector can add value and to define the key roles for MACO in promoting, managing and monitoring service providers, as well as by financing pilot projects. These would provide services that complement those already 1 Two particularly interesting initiatives are (i) the COMACO enterprise supported by the Wildlife Conservation Society serving 45,000 farmers, providing business training, investing in local bulking, transport and processing units for rice, beans, groundnuts and soybeans and creating market outlets both at national and international level; and (ii) SNV specialising on rice value chain and providing assistance throughout the chain including support to the newly founded Zambia Rice federation. 70 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report provided by MACO and provide an opportunity to increase the market outlet possibilities for smallholders, thus creating a virtuous circle of increased demand pulling increased productivity and production which, in turn, opens up new market potentials. Since these organizations are working both on support to production (extension, technology adaptation and facilitating access to inputs), processing and access to markets, close coordination with SAPP will be necessary. Support could be envisaged through PublicPrivate Partnerships (PPPs) where the private or non-government partner shares similar objectives, but needs some support or resources to up-scale activities in the target areas. In other cases, PPPs might not be possible or would be less desirable, and more straightforward contracting of service providers would be more appropriate. It will be important to be both flexible and very clear as to why a particular option is preferred. The expected outcome is an up-scaling of a certain ongoing successful undertakings in the target areas, increasing their outreach by an additional 15,000 smallholders. Sub-component 1.3: Agricultural Research for Development (US$ 9.7 million) 21. The specific objective of this sub-component is to broaden the technology options for increased productivity of smallholder farmers. The programme will complement ongoing GRZ and other partners support to strengthen strategic on-station and on-farm research capacities to adapt potential productivity enhancing technologies to local farming systems. Identification of new varieties of the different crops and availability of certified seed for existing improved varieties is essential to improve productivity. A gradual shift from traditional chitemene land use system to more intensive semipermanent production systems also requires the adoption of integrated soil fertility and crop management techniques aiming at increasing soil organic matter content and pH levels. Conservation farming and agro-forestry appear to be promising options. Given the labour shortage at farm level, significant increases in productivity will only be possible through the introduction of adapted tools and equipment. 22. Implementation of adaptive research activities will involve strategic agricultural research for development (AR4D) in support to on-going ZARI research programmes, integrating technical support from regional/international research institutions and programmes; as well as competitive AR4D driven by partnerships for innovation development and adaptation and involving ZARI, GART, UNZA, NGOs, private sector. Both approaches will involve on-station and on-farm activities and feed into strengthened research-extension collaboration at local level, including stakeholder planning and evaluation. In addition, S3P will support the strengthening of institutional AR4D collaboration and partnerships for enhanced research-extension-training linkages, by: (a) farmer empowerment, priority need identification, involvement in AR4D implementation and evaluation cycles; (b) instituting district AR4D platforms (research, extension services, FO, private) and research-extension linkage officers; (c) broadening partnerships for AR4D involving public and private agricultural research institutions/organizations operating at national (NARS), regional and international levels; and (d) building an integrated research-extension information management platform. 23. There is a strong linkage between sub-component 1.2 and sub-component 1.3, in that the harmonised extension methodology supported by S3P will include the identification of research priorities as well as adaptive trials at farmer level through the FFS. In addition, the quarterly provincial and district level meetings will include the research staff and could therefore include the institutionalization of AR4D thematic district platforms (research, extension, FO and private sector) without additional cost. 24. Activities will include: (a) adaptive research for improved varieties and cropping practices; (b) adaptation of Conservation Agriculture (CA) and agro-forestry practices; (c) Identification of tools/equipment and post-harvest technologies adapted to local situation; (d) support to decentralised seed and planting material production. 25. Adaptive research for improved varieties includes support for: (i) on-going on-station breeding and selection programmes for cassava (ZARI’s Mansa station in Luapula Province), mixed beans (Misamfu station in Northern Province) and possibly rice 71 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report and groundnuts; (ii) participatory researcher and farmer-led on-farm trials for most advanced lines (Advanced and Uniform Yield Trials); and (iii) specialised technical assistance and support from international institutions (IITA– cassava, CIRAD– Agroecology, CIAT– beans for example) S3P will finance some up-grading of research infrastructure of research stations and some equipment. On the basis of local productivity and acceptability criteria, key outputs will significantly widen farmers’ options for improved productivity. 26. Adaptation of Conservation Agriculture, agro-forestry practices and other improved cropping practices. In the medium term, a gradual shift from traditional land use (chitemene slash and burn) towards more intensive production systems requires a drastic change of soil management towards increased soil organic matter content and pH, to promote more sustainable semi-permanent production systems, resilient to climatic variability (flooding, drought). Within this perspective, CA and agroforestry appear among the most promising options, but need to be adapted to high rainfall cassava-based farming systems predominant in the target areas. Integrated Pest Management (IPM) is another area with great potential benefits in terms of productivity enhancement and improved quality and value of production. These options will not only allow intensifying local farming systems, increasing their productivity, reducing farmers risk and labouring input, but also allow for carbon sequestration in soils by raising significantly their organic matter level. Such a shift would adapt local farming systems to changing environment and contribute to climate mitigation. 27. Key outputs of on-farm research/testing programmes will generate a range of technology options adapted to local bio-physical and farming system conditions, targeting: (a) sustainable soil, water and crop management systems aiming at reduced soil tillage; (b) permanent soil coverage and enhanced soil organic matter management, by crop rotations and associations, improved fallows and agro-forestry; (c) adapted soil acidity management/liming and integrated soil nutrient management; and (d) reduced labour input (gender, child labour, HIV), especially for land preparation and weed management. Farmers’ access to specialised tools, equipment’s, planting material (cover and fallow crops) and inputs (lime, base fertilizer) are considered as critical enhancing factors. Research will be undertaken by ZARI in a partnership with GART 1 and FOs and will complement existing efforts being undertaken with CFU, GART and FAO support. 28. Research on adapted tools/equipment, including for transport, and on-farm post-harvest technologies. S3P will support research on improved labour productivity (including transport) for enhanced competitiveness of commodities produced in the target areas. Labour availability is an important factor limiting agricultural growth given the low population densities and the impact of HIV/AIDS. Solutions to this issue are, therefore, fundamental to significantly improve production and marketing. 29. Labour saving equipment and adapted post-harvest-processing technologies need to be developed for cassava and other crops, in close collaboration with various partners which have been working on these issues. Research should determine the priorities in terms of labour saving technology for S3P target groups, including tools and equipment for both cropping and domestic tasks. The latter has particular implications for women and children in terms of availability of labour for agriculture. Research should cover the technological as well as the socio-economic issues related to specific devices. End-users (both male and female) should be involved in the setting of the priorities and the handon testing of alternative technologies. Research will be implemented by the post-harvest unit in ZARI in collaboration with IITA in the case of cassava technology, private industries and other partners as required. 30. Access to improved Seeds and Planting Material. Cassava, mixed beans, groundnuts and rice are not considered as commercial interest crops by the private seed 1 GART: Golden Valley Agricultural Research Trust, an autonomous and self-sustaining Public Private Partnership organization created by GRZ and the Zambia National Farmers Union. 72 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report sector. Therefore, farmer-based high quality seed/planting material multiplication will be promoted and strengthened as follows: (i) Maintenance of breeder seed stock by specialised commodity research programmes in ZARI stations of Mansa (4-5 cassava varieties) and Kasama (4-5 mixed beans varieties). (ii) Production of foundation seed in both stations: cassava (about 3 ha for each variety) and mixed beans (about 2 ha for each variety over two seasons. (iii) First multiplication at district level whereby each district will organize 2-3 ha of cassava and 1 ha of mixed beans multiplication in each targeted block. (iv) Second multiplication at camp level whereby each camp will organize farmer groups and/or specialized seed producer groups/individuals for an equivalent of 5 ha of cassava and 2 ha of mixed beans. As far as possible, existing FFS-type groups will be used (linkage with sub-component 1.2). (v) Adapted certification (Quality Declared Seeds) support to be provided by the Seed Control & Certification Institute (SCCI). 31. In addition to the support for cassava and mixed beans, the project will complement the work undertaken by ZARI in Kasama with the support from JICA and SNV related to the purification of local varieties of rice used in the project area. Component 2: Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth (US$ 17.7 million) 32. This component will address critical constraints in the enabling environment for smallholder productivity growth, including: (i) improved rural infrastructure and improved access to productivity enhancing equipment and assets; (ii) the policy and institutional framework to provide the necessary support services; and (iii) programme coordination, management and monitoring and evaluation. Sub-component 2.1: Local Agricultural Investments (US$ 13.1 million)1 33. This sub-component will help finance investments that improve access to markets, increase labour productivity, reduce post-harvest losses, improve land and water management, or facilitate access to knowledge. Conditional partial grants will be provided for eligible agricultural investments and technical and facilitation assistance will be provided to prepare investment requests and help ensure correct implementation, operation and maintenance. Access to resources will be according to defined criteria that outline beneficiary eligibility and eligible type of investments. Three windows will be established, each with specific procedures and internal control mechanisms. 34. The final decision to finance a particular sub-project will depend on the costs of the sub-project and the authorized approval limits at different levels. The approval limit for the DACO is currently ZK10 million or approximately US$2,200. Where the approval ceiling goes beyond that of DACO, the DDCC reviewed and recommended sub-project proposal will be referred to the PACO, whose approval ceiling is ZK20 million or approximately US$4,400. Where it goes beyond the approval ceiling of the PACO, it will be referred through the PMU to the S3P Steering Committee for approval. In all cases, funds will be released on a case-by-case basis for payment of specific sub-projects or tranches of sub-projects. Funds will be transferred from central level to dedicated accounts at the provincial level, for specific payments. Capacity building and training for provincial and district level staff in procurement and financial management are included in sub-component 1.2. 35. District-level agricultural investments of a strategic nature, such as: (i) improvement of feeder roads (agricultural roads) connecting productive smallholder 1 For detailed operating procedures for the Local Agricultural Investment sub-component, see Annex 11, Attachment 2 73 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report areas to main roads1; and (ii) rehabilitation of district Farmer Training Centres or Farm Institutes; all investments being conditional on there being a sound business plan for sustainable operation and management. Potential sub-projects will be identified at the district level and should be of a strategic nature, for example constructing or rehabilitating a feeder road to a key productive camp or area already selected for intensive extension support under Component 1. Investments that would normally be undertaken by the private sector are not eligible for support. Requests for support will be identified by communities and prepared by the DACO, for review and approval by the (economic sub-committee of) the District Development Coordination Committee (DDCC). The proposal will then be included in the District Development Plan. It will then be submitted for final approval to the DACO (if less than his/her limit of approval authority, currently ZK10 million / US$2,200); to the PACO, (if less than his/her authority limit, currently ZK20 million / US$ 4,400), or, through the Programme Management Unit (PMU), to the Programme Steering Committee (PSC). 36. Average sub-project co-financing costs are expected to be equivalent to around US$100,000, which is the approximate cost of 10 km of feeder road. The total available S3P co-financing amount is set at US$4 million, which means that a total of around 40 sub-projects could be financed from the provisional allocation; though this amount could be increased or decreased depending on actual achievements and availability of funds. 37. S3P contribution to such investments will be up to 90 percent of total costs, with a co-financing ceiling equivalent to US$ 250,000 per sub-project. The district contribution, at least 10 percent of total costs, will include costs of identification, design, preparation of bills of quantities, social and environmental impact assessment, preparation of business and/or management and operation plans, construction supervision and the like, including non-MACO district staff as appropriate (district director of works for instance). S3P will provide engineering and supervision support, both at preparation and implementation stage, mainly to make sure the proposals meet the required quality standards and that construction is correct. 38. Community-level agricultural investments of a public nature, including for instance: (i) spot improvement of agricultural roads, such as culverts, fords or small bridges; (ii) small-scale storage sheds and drying floors; and (iii) small-scale water management or soil erosion control structures. 39. Potential sub-projects will be identified in those camps and key production areas with high potential for increased marketable surpluses selected under Component one for intensive support. This will be done through a pro-active process facilitated by a contracted service provider, who will ensure that: (i) CACs are trained to handle the planning, submission, supervision and M&E of local sub-projects, and to coordinate these with Area Development Committees as appropriate; (ii) proposed sub-projects are technically, socially, economically and environmentally feasible and meet eligibility criteria2; (iii) requesting groups are genuine (i.e. not just formed to receive inputs) and meet eligibility requirements in terms of management capacity; (iv) community/group contributions are spelled out clearly and the beneficiaries are aware and ready to provide their share; (v) sound business and/or operation and maintenance plans are included in the proposals; (vi) requesting groups are –where necessary– provided with essential training to allow them to operate and manage the requested investments; (vii) relevant district and sub-district staff are kept informed and correct procedures are followed; and (viii) final agreements are concluded in the form of a contract between the DACO and 1 2 Although labour-based techniques for road works have had a mixed success, they bring benefits beyond the road itself; important lessons have been learnt under SHEMP. However, prioritisation and selection of roads is a key issue; as is road maintenance, and arrangements need to be in place prior to making investments in road construction or rehabilitation. Here, useful lessons have been learnt under the World Bank-financed Agricultural Development Support Project with output and performance based road contracting (OPRC). Ineligible expenditures for co-financing would include land, family labour, working capital, recurrent expenses, normal business costs, tobacco and alcohol and related products/services, technologies that infringe on existing laws and regulations on patents and copyrights, etc. 74 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report the local community and/or farmer group. Community-level investment proposals prepared by eligible groups and/or communities that have been assisted by other programmes, projects or initiatives (for example PLARD) will also be considered for cofinancing support. 40. Proposals will be submitted by farmer group, cooperative or community for the review of the CACs, after which the CEOs submits the request for review by the DACO, and final approval by the PACO where the total investment is within his/her approval ceiling (currently ZK20 million / US$ 4,400), and – through the PMU - by the PSC where it is beyond this amount. S3P will provide facilitation services for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening and construction. Requesting groups or communities will need to meet eligibility criteria, while the proposals will need to include realistic operation and management plans. S3P contribution will be up to 75 percent of construction costs, with a co-financing ceiling of US$ 25,000 per sub-project. Community and/or group contributions would be largely or entirely in kind, including labour and local material. 41. The total available S3P co-financing amount is set at US$3.5 million (though this could be increased or decreased depending on actual achievements and availability of funds). Assuming average sub-project co-financing costs to be equivalent to around US$10,000 per sub-project, this means that a total of 350 sub-projects (15 per district) could be financed from the provisional allocation. 42. The preparation and implementation process will also require relevant district staff to visit concerned camps, communities, groups and sites on several occasions, and a sum equivalent to 5 percent of total construction costs (US$0.23 million) will be made available for this purpose. Cost of facilitation and training (etc) by the service provider is estimated at 20 percent of total construction costs, or approximately US$0.93 million. S3P management will also provide separate engineering and supervision support to make sure the proposals meet the required quality standards and that construction is carried out correctly. 43. Group-based agricultural investments with a high social value includes limited and conditional support to enable groups of poor and disadvantaged rural people, in particular women and girls, to purchase labour-saving equipment. The processing of the crops being targeted by S3P is usually done by women using methods which are extremely labour-intensive and time consuming. In such situations labour saving technologies can have a very significant positive impact on livelihoods of the poor and disadvantaged, in particular women and girls. In this respect it is also important to note that women are more vulnerable to HIV/AIDS and also nurse HIV/AIDS patients in the communities. 44. Investment support will be restricted to groups that: (i) have reached a sufficiently mature developmental stage; but (ii) because of prevailing poverty are not able to raise sufficient funds to obtain the required equipment on credit; while (iii) the labour saving equipment would, at a modest fee, also be available to other community members (non-group members). Requests for these investments will originate at the group level and S3P will provide facilitation services for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening and preparation of business plans. There will be stringent eligibility criteria that requesting groups need to meet. S3P contribution will be up to 50 per cent of equipment costs, with a co-financing ceiling of US$ 2,500 per sub-project and a maximum of one sub-project per group. 45. What needs to be ensured is that: (i) groups are not formed just to be able to receive financial support to acquire equipment, this is done by imposing stringent criteria on group functioning and how long it has been operating (at least 6 months, preferably one year before potentially qualifying, to be verified by service provider and CEO); (ii) the emerging micro-finance sector is not undermined, which is done by verifying that groups are not able to raise more than 50 percent of the costs of the desired equipment, and by limiting support to only one piece of equipment per eligible group; (iii) that the 75 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report subsidy is not used for private goods or commercial purposes, but instead has a major social impact in the group and surrounding community, mainly through the reduction of time-consuming drudgery labour; and (iv) that control over the equipment, its use and potential benefits remains with the eligible group, who should have a sound operation and management plan, and who may need additional training to make this happen. 46. Identification of potential sub-projects is mainly linked to the eligibility of the groups. Therefore, facilitation of the identification, planning and implementation process will be carried out by the same service provider that is contracted to implement subcomponent 1.1 (strengthening farmer organizations). Sub-projects will be submitted through the CAC, reviewed DAC, and approved by the DACO, up to his/her authorised approval ceiling (currently ZK10 million or US$2,200); beyond this sub-projects will be referred for the PACO’s approval. The total available S3P co-financing amount is set at US$ 0.5 million. Since sub-project co-financing costs are expected to be very modest, on average most likely below US$1,000 per sub-project, a total of close to 500 sub-projects (or 20 per district) could be financed from the provisional allocation. 47. Costs of facilitation and training of groups is estimated to be equivalent to the cofinancing costs. 48. Technical and facilitation assistance will be provided for: (i) training of DACO and DDCC staff, CACs and other community committees and eligible farmer groups, as required; (ii) facilitation of the participatory planning and implementation processes for community-level and group-based sub-projects and verification of eligibility of communities, groups and their proposed investments; (iii) technical assistance for the screening, assessment and design of proposed investments, such as technical, financial, economical, social and environmental feasibility, as well as (iv) preparation of business, operation and maintenance plans. A Local Agricultural Investments Manager, working closely with the programme manager as a part of the PMU, though based in one of the two provinces, will provide overall leadership to the sub-component: he/she will establish the procedural and operational modalities for the funding facilities; ensure that these function, with active community involvement; and monitor the sub-projects once financed and implemented. Sub-component 2.2 Support to the Policy and Planning Framework (US$ 0.5million) 49. S3P would support MACO’s Policy and Planning Department (PPD) to manage flows of information and communication, undertake policy reviews, and provide opportunities to learn from relevant experience. 50. Management of information and communication within MACO and PPD has for several reasons become more constrained. This is partly related to staff shortages compounded by the recent creation of the Ministry of Livestock and Fisheries Development (MLFD), and partly to the proliferation of different development partner supported projects and programmes, which MACO is increasingly concerned to coordinate. To assist MACO strengthen its knowledge management systems, S3P will finance the recruitment of a Programme planning and monitoring specialist. He/she will be based in PPD and will report to the Director PPD, and will: (i) assist with the review of the current M&E system in MACO, including reviewing current M&E indicators, reporting formats, frequency and information flow; (ii) facilitate internal discussion within the PPD M&E Unit, the M&E Working Group and progressively to larger audiences regarding the selection of key indicators, reporting formats, frequency and information flow; (iii) facilitate discussion during workshops at central and provincial level; and (iv) advise PPD regarding IT requirements for a Management Information System. This person will also build capacity and assist in: (a) coordinating and harmonizing the different initiatives, projects and programmes in relation to the SNDP, the National Agricultural Policy and the Zambia CAADP; and (b) managing information and communication flows related to these. The programme would finance this post for a period of 3 years, with any future need reviewed in the context of the institutional strengthening activities under PEP. 76 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 51. Policy reviews and studies will be undertaken that aim to improve the enabling environment relevant to sustainable productivity growth and expanded smallholders’ integration into agricultural markets. Support would be provided to undertake specific studies, draft policies and regulations; as well as for multi-stakeholder review, discussion (workshop, forums) and dialogue related to their preparation. Some of the topics already identified include, for example, those policies specific to cassava-based farming systems and the role of cassava in national food security, issues related to FISP and the FRA, the lack of appropriate CA techniques for agro-ecological region III. Other policy issues will be identified through the course of programme implementation. 52. Opportunities to learn from experience, in particular field and other exposure visit of policy and decision makers, both within Zambia and to relevant international sites or events. Sub-component 2.3. Programme Management, Monitoring and Evaluation (US$ 3.4 million) 53. The S3P will be managed on behalf of Government by a Programme Management Unit (PMU) located within the Policy and Planning Department (PPD) of MACO. The PMU will consist of management and technical teams, overseen by a Programme Manager responsible for overall programme delivery, based in Lusaka, who will report to the Director PPD. The management team will also be based in Lusaka and it will include a Financial Management Specialist; a Procurement and Contracts Specialist; a Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation/Knowledge Management/ Communication Specialist; and a Local Agricultural Investments Manager (budgeted for under Component 2.1). 54. The technical team will be based at provincial level (in a ZARI Research Station either in Northern or Luapula Province) and will include a Research for Development Specialist, and an Extension Methodology Specialist. It will also include one Facilitator per target province, who will be based in the office of the PACO (and budgeted under Component 1). All these posts will report to the Programme Manager. The PMU will also manage a budget for hiring short term technical expertise required by the programme. 77 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 5. Implementation Arrangements Approach 1. The S3P will be implemented over a period of seven years. Implementation will start in two provinces (Luapula and Northern Province): in PY1 eight districts will receive intensive support, and PY2 another eight district within these same provinces will be added. As of PY3, a third province and a further eight district will be added. Criteria for the selection of districts will be included in the PIM; and the annual work plans and budgets for PY1, PY2 and PY3 will indicate the proposed districts and camps to be covered in that year’s implementation programme. The AWPBs will then be subject to approval by IFAD. Any decision to expand target areas needs to be justified by reasonably satisfactory progress in the initial target areas, as evidenced by annual implementation reviews. 2. The S3P is expected to complement the already-ongoing SAPP, and by formally linking the two programmes to each other, the one is expected to strengthen the other’s effectiveness and enhance its ability to achieve its overall objective, and vice versa. The two programmes will be managed separately, but a number of mechanisms, including a single Programme Steering Committee for both, linked annual work planning and budgeting processes and outcomes, and regular meetings of project managers, will ensure that they remain coordinated and mutually supportive. Both S3P and SAPP will also be linked to the Rural Finance Programme, but this link will not be formal. Institutional set-up 3. S3P will be overseen by a Programme Steering Committee (PSC), managed by a Programme Management Unit (PMU) located within the Policy and Planning Department (PPD) of MACO, and implemented by MACO and a variety of non-government partners and service providers. 4. The S3P Programme Steering Committee (PSC) will be the same as the one set-up for SAPP. It will provide overall policy and technical direction and guidance to both programmes. It will be chaired by the Permanent Secretary of MACO, and will include representatives of the relevant MACO departments (Policy and Planning, Agribusiness and Marketing, Agriculture, Cooperatives, ZARI, SCCI); Ministry of Finance and National Planning (MFNP); Ministry of Commerce, Trade and Industry (MCTI); Ministry of Local Government and Housing (MLGH); Farmers Organizations (such as the Zambia National Farmers Union, ZNFU) and Industry Organizations (such as the Cassava Sub-sector Committee (CSC), relevant to the selected commodities or sectors. The PSC should meet at least quarterly; with its key responsibilities to: ensure that Programme activities are in line with national policies, procedures and legislation; provide strategic guidance to the PMU and implementing agencies (within and outside government); ensure that interventions are coordinated development programmes and projects; review and approve SAPP and S3P’s Annual Work Plans and Budgets (AWPBs) review financial progress, approve the annual financial statements and review the external auditor’s report; monitor implementation progress and impact; approve grants above a certain Investments sub-component threshold where under appropriate the Local with other Agricultural 5. It will be expected to make specific recommendations for follow-up, which the PMU should be accountable for delivering. 78 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 6. A dedicated Programme Management Unit will be created to support MACO to manage S3P implementation. It will have the following main functions: Implementation of S3P sub-components; outsourcing and contract management of service providers; Ensuring effective financial management including setting-up and operating an accounting system consistent with GRZ and IFAD financial procedures; and ensuring timely flow of funds to MACO implementing national, and provincial offices as well as contracted Service Providers in accordance to agreed plan of work and budget. Ensuring timely procurement of all works, goods and services contracts by preparing tender documents, call for proposals, terms of reference and working in close consultation with MACO PSU, and ensure adequate contract management Organizing and ensuring timely preparation, coordination and reporting of the Annual Work Plan and Budget (AWPB); Setting up and implementing a participatory planning, and monitoring/evaluation system; Operating an efficient Management Information System (MIS); including financial/ management accounting software and undertake Programme M&E, with a contracts/ grants tracking module Ensuring the timely execution of key studies, Mid-Term Review and Programme Completion Report, and submit timely progress, M&E and audit reports Putting in place knowledge management and dissemination to strengthen policy making process, and replicating successful experience on productivity increases. 7. The PMU, located – like that of SAPP – within PPD, will be led by a Programme Manager who will report to the Director PPD. He/she will be responsible for overall programme delivery, and will lead the PMU (a detailed organogram of the PMU as well as terms of reference for each position are provided in Annex 5). A detailed organigramme of the PMU as well as terms of reference for each position are provided as Appendices to this Annex. All programme-financed positions will be recruited openly and competitively by MACO. Full time positions will be hired for an initial three year contract, with a 12 month probation period. Subject to satisfactory performance the contact will be extended on a two year rolling basis. 8. The management team will include the following posts: a Financial Management Specialist, a Procurement and Contracts Specialist, a Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation/Knowledge Management/ Communication Specialist; and a Local Agricultural Investments Manager, whose role will be to manage this sub-component. The team will be based in Lusaka, so as to facilitate close working relations with MACO, SAPP and other national stakeholders, though it will be expected to travel frequently to the programme provinces and it will have a budget to allow them to do so. It is expected that the Programme Manager, the M&E officer and the Financial Management Specialist will go once a month, and the procurement and contracts specialist will travel once a quarter. 9. The Technical team will include a Research for Development Specialist and an Extension Methodology Specialist, both of whom will be based in a Research Station either in Northern or Luapula Province; as well as one Facilitator in each of the three provinces targeted by the Programme, based in the office of the PACO. All these positions will report to the Programme Manager. The PMU will also manage a budget for hiring short term technical expertise which will be hired as required. Additional support to provincial and district level financial management may be one of the areas where such expertise will be required. The Research for Development Specialist and the Extension Methodology specialist will advise/support Research and Development (R&D) activities, 79 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report including preparing the Annual Work Plan and Budget (AWPB); providing methodological support for innovative and sustainable extension; supporting enhanced research extension linkages and coordination; supporting extension capacity strengthening/ building activities; and promoting gender, HIV/ AIDS and environment mainstreaming. They will provide backstopping to the Provincial Facilitators. 10. The Provincial facilitators will work closely and advise the PACO and his/her staff to ensure that Programme activities are included in the normal planning process at district and provincial level, will promote close coordination between activities various projects active in the province, will encourage a stronger link between research and extension. They will assist the PME and KM specialist to compile the Programme AWPB, and to report on implementation of activities and on outputs achieved, they will also provide a knowledge management function by keeping a record of Programme activities and achievements, sharing lessons learnt and best practice. They will also ensure that Programme funds are spent in line with what they were intended for, and will work closely with provincial accountants (PACO) and the Programme financial management specialist to ensure that Programme expenditures are tracked, particularly in the case of component 2.1 (Local Agricultural Investments). 11. The S3PU will also manage a budget for hiring short term technical expertise, which will be used as required. The financial management systems at provincial and district level is expected to be one specific area requiring support. 12. The PMU will draw on management procedures that will be documented in a Programme Implementation Manual (PIM). The PIM outline is presented in Annex 11; a complete draft PIM will be prepared prior to programme start-up; and the PIM will be finalised by the PMU during the first quarter of programme year one. Among other things, the PIM will include detailed operational guidelines and procedures for the Local Agricultural Investments; it will define the criteria for selecting the districts and camps to be covered under the programme (which are then reflected in the AWPBs); and it will also include a gender strategy, which defines the operational measures to be taken to promote gender mainstreaming and women’s empowerment under the programme. For example, programme staff composition and TORs, composition of the PSC, engagement of service providers, launching workshops, other forums and all capacity building programs will ensure gender-sensitive criteria and gender-equitable participation whenever possible. 13. The Ministry of Agriculture and Cooperatives (MACO) and in particular the Policy and Planning Department (PPD) is the lead Programme implementation agency. This is a role that involves: Recruiting the staff of the PMU Taking overall implementation responsibility Convening the Programme Steering Committee Managing changes in Programme direction Continuing to chair the Country Programme Management Team (established as the Programme Development Group during the design phase), to offer a platform for technical advice, guidance and knowledge management, and provide an opportunity for the PMU to engage with key ministries, representatives of farmers’ organizations and the private sector Ensuring coordination with other on-going GRZ/Development Partner support in the sector. 14. MACO Purchasing and Supplies Unit (PSU) will support the procurement of goods and services needed for the implementation of S3P, as well as providing guidelines for asset registry. MACO Financial Management Unit (FMU) will take responsibility for the management of the Designated Account, ensuring timely replenishment of the Operations Account once PMU has satisfied the requirements and after a withdrawal 80 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report application has been made and checked. This is further elaborated upon in Annex 7 on Financial Management issues. The FMU is staffed with Accounting personnel from the Ministry of Finance and National Planning. It will Reviews reports submitted by SAPPO and if satisfied reimburses the SAPPO operations account on a quarterly basis. The Operations account is managed exclusively by SAPPO. The Chief Accountant will be closely involved in the preparation of S3P financial statements and support in the preparation of financial progress reports for in-country reporting and monitoring. 15. MACO Department of Agriculture will provide designated contact persons for S3P in the selected provinces and districts (the PAO and SAO), and will facilitate the participatory planning process at national, provincial, district and sub-district levels. MACO National, Provincial and District Staff will play a key role in implementation, monitoring and supervision of Programme activities. 16. The Programme Development Group (PDG, also known as Technical Review Panel once the programme is operational) is an advisory panel, which is not part of the managerial chain of responsibility. The role of the PDG will be to provide advice and support to S3P implementation. Knowledge management is an important function of the PDG in pursuing the synthesis and dissemination of lessons learned during the course of implementation. The PDG will meet on an ad hoc basis as needed, and its composition may be varied according to the matters under review. The PDG will be chaired by the Policy and Planning Department. 17. Farmer Organizations and Cooperatives play a key role in representing the interests of small-scale producers. Participatory planning will be used to identify the specific needs of these organizations and these will be incorporated into the MACO work plans. The Programme will seek to strengthen the capacity of existing and new farmer groups which may have received support in the past, or may be currently supported by other initiatives. Coordination with other agencies and programs that deal with agricultural production aspects will be pursued in this regard. Farmer organisations and agribusinesses at higher levels (larger cooperative societies, cooperative unions, commodity associations, input/ output dealers, small manufacturers) will be supported depending on the role they can play in improving farmer-productivity within specific value chains. Coordination and partnerships 18. Local (district and sub-district) coordination committees such as the District and Camp Agricultural Committees (DACs, CACs) as well as the more general District Development Coordination Committee (DDCC) and Area Development Committee (ADC) at Ward level will play a key role of overseeing and prioritizing agricultural development activities at camp level. CACs will be encouraged to coordinate agricultural development activities with the endorsement of ADCs that are responsible for coordinating all development efforts at ward level. DACs oversee and prioritize agricultural development activities at district level. They will particularly play a key role in approving investment projects under the Local Agricultural Investments sub-component. DACs will be encouraged to coordinate more effectively with the DDCC that are responsible for coordinating all development efforts at district level, in particular regarding the intracommunity agricultural investments that will be financed under the sub-component, consisting of public infrastructure investments at district level. A figure is provided in Appendix 2 of this Annex. 19. S3P is designed to develop a wide range of partnerships to enhance productivity through collaboration with key players and service providers by actively forging linkages with other relevant projects and initiatives. In doing so, S3P will seek to learn from best practice, avoid overlap and ensure complementarities; create synergies; leverage investments already made; strengthen linkages between those initiatives and MACO; and establish a joint platform involving MACO and its cooperating partners for sharing lessons learnt and knowledge about productivity enhancement. 81 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 20. Provincial and District Offices of MACO will play an important role in participatory planning. The service-providers engaged to undertake tasks will work in partnership with Provincial and District staff, particularly the Principal (at Province level) and Senior (at district level) Agricultural Officer and relevant Subject Matter Specialists, but also relevant ZARI staff from Research Stations present in Programme intervention areas. District staff, in particular exstension staff, Block Extension Officer (BEO), and Camp Extension officers (CEO) will play valuable role in knowledge sharing through platforms that will be established to support research and extension linkages. Linkages with SAPP and IFAD portfolio 21. The S3P PMU will also draw on and learn from the managers of other IFADfinanced projects in Zambia. In particular, it is expected that S3P will coordinate closely with SAPP. This will be achieved by taking the following actions: There will be a Joint Programme Steering Committee for SAPP and S3P. The membership of the existing SAPP PSC will be slightly revised and is provided in detail below. All meetings of the PSC will therefore revise both programmes simultaneously. The two programmes will conduct joint planning and budgeting of their activities, through joint preparation of Annual Work Plan and Budgets, to ensure complementarity, coordination and sequencing of activities. Joint Decision Meetings, coinciding with annual IFAD supervision missions, meeting with the PSC, will take place at least once a year. These meetings will take decisions about the evolving programmatic nature of the S3P and SAPP, and will ensure that both Programmes evolve in parallel. Both programmes will be directly supervised by IFAD. Monthly meetings between Programme Managers and relevant members of their team will take place, and a constant flow of information between the two programmes will be maintained through regular contacts between M&E officers. These meetings will involve the participation of the IFAD Country Officer. Annual Information sharing and review workshop will be held with programme teams and various service providers and partners of SAPP and S3P, and will include the participation of the IFAD-financed Rural Finance Programme, as well as IFAD Country Officer. Both programmes will be housed under the Policy and Planning Department (PPD) and both managers will report to the Policy and Planning Director. 22. While SAPP activities are mostly contracted out to service providers, it is expected that a sizable part of S3P activities will be implemented through MACO structures at national, provincial, district and sub-district levels. While central-level staff will provide the overall policy guidance, provincial staff will monitor implementation of activities at district level and also coordinate annual platforms for review of the performance of S3P. District and sub-district staff will be actively involved in implementation of activities. MACO will designate the Principle Agricultural Officer (PAO) and the Senior Agricultural Officer (SAO), at provincial and district levels respectively as the official contact persons for S3P. Other activities will be contracted out to service providers. All service provider(s) will be responsible to MACO and their activities will be embedded within the Ministry, adopting a partnership and mentoring approach with Ministry staff at headquarters, Provincial, District and Sub-District levels. 23. Both S3P and SAPP should also coordinate closely with the Rural Finance Project (RFP), which aims to improve access to rural financial services. This includes innovative instruments to improve groups and individuals access to finance which is pursued through a collaboration with the National Savings and Credit Bank (Natsave) which offers normal banking and financial services and has a product which offers credit facilities for different agricultural equipment. Another component of RFP promotes community-based 82 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report institutions which work with groups to introduce them to group savings and credit schemes. Group members access loans from these schemes to enable them engage in activities which improve their livelihoods, and to purchase productive equipment and inputs. S3P will provide information to RFP so as to allow expansion of these services and components to targeted areas. Programme start-up 24. Key Start-Up Activities will include the following: Recruitment of a consultant/technical advisor to work with MACO to facilitate activities required for Programme start-up. Opening of the Designated Account and PMU operational bank account. Advertisement for and recruitment of key staff of PMU. Preparation of tender documents for critical start-up procurements. Facilitation of arrangements for MACO to temporarily provide logistic support (e.g. vehicles, office space etc) until the Programme acquires its own. Identification and renting of suitable PMU premises. Procurement of basic furniture and computer equipment with accessories for use by the PMU staff; Finalisation of Draft PIM based on the Programme Design Report, and initial draft completed by a local consultant prior to negotiations; design of the Financial Management Manual; Selection of the first 8 districts to be covered under the programme; Preparation of the Year 1 Annual Work Plan and Budget and Procurement Plan based on Programme design; Establish the Programme Steering Committee and ensure it has its first meeting within twelve months of programme effectiveness Conduct of start-up workshop with programme team and IFAD staff, as well as initial capacity assessment needs. Conduct Programme launch workshop. 25. These activities will be financed through an advance provided to the PMU by IFAD, which will be transferred following opening of dedicated and operational accounts. 26. A start-up workshop will be organized with project staff to reach a clear and common understanding of the Programme objectives, the main results that need to be achieved, the roles and responsibilities of each stakeholder, the implementation arrangements for the various subcomponents. This workshop will also be the opportunity for some team building and establishing working relationship between IFAD, the PMU, the PPD and other stakeholders. 27. The overall objective of the workshop is to ensure that programme team and partners have a common and shared vision regarding the strategy. Therefore the start up operations support will facilitate the involvement of teams and partners in conceptual discussions at a very early stage, co-creation of operational modes and ways and the rigorous nurturing of learning and knowledge management within the programme. 28. This will be initiated through a 3 day central-level workshop to be attended by all central level MACO staff involved in implementation, the PMU and the technical aand management teams. This will be followed by cascading provincial and district level startup workshops. The provincial and district level workshop will coincide with the first quarterly planning and review meetings. 29. The outputs of the start-up operations support are expected to be: 83 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Programme language and operational implications simplified for everyone`s understanding A common understanding right from the beginning created Changes and processes leading to results envisioned and described Team development strengthened to operationalise the programme and work on the challenges and solutions, favouring an working atmosphere in the team with low hierarchy and minimal communication blockages between level (e.g. field level versus PMU) The PMU team exposed to KM concept, approaches, impacts, methods and tools Procedures and organisational processes to foster learning and KM developed The programme implementation team operates as a team with 30. The workshop will focus specifically on: Creating clarity from all actors and detailed understanding of how to operationalise the programme– with a presentation and unpacking the programme document Discussion on the programme strategy and how to put it into practice, the lessons from the past and innovation required Working together: institutional arrangements, roles and mechanisms to make this work within the team and with partners, job descriptions and performance criteria, core values and principles how to operate Visualising the desired changes / results (hard and soft) and developing behavioural indicators through outcome visioning exercise (close the eyes and see people DOING things leading to results, outcome mapping exercise..) Knowledge Management and Learning (concepts and principles, KM framework, the pillars, tools.....) Organisational development learning process (team building) with the whole team from PMU to field officers Internal and external communication and feedback mechanisms Facilitation skills for meetings and stakeholder interaction Action planning for 2-3 months 84 Annex 5 – Appendix 1: Programme Organizational Chart Programme Steering Committee (PSC) S3P Programme Manager Management Based in Lusaka SAPP Programme Manager (p.m.) Technical Based in the field 85 Financial Management Specialist Research for Development Specialist Procurement and Contracts Specialist Extension Methodology Specialist Monitoring/Evaluation and Knowledge Management and Communications Specialist Local Agricultural Investments Manager Provincial Facilitators (one per province) Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Policy and Planning Department MACO Annex 5 – Appendix 2: Diagram of Decentralized Structures MACO/Ag sector devolution Administration Facilitation/support National Participative Agricultural planning Local Agricultural sector financing Participative local planning Local develop. financing Gender Focal points PACO Gender Commit. District District Devlop. Commitee ( DDC) District Agric. Committee (DAC) DACO 86 4 Subcommitees Block Camp Zone Village BES Ward level Camp Agric. Commitee CEO Zonal Ag. Com Zonal Ag. Com CAC Zonal Ag. Com District Council Other sectors Area Develop. Commitee (ADC) Other sectors Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Provincial MACO Decentralization Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 5 – Appendix 3: Draft Terms of Reference for Programme Management Unit staff 1. Programme Manager The Programme Manager will be responsible for all aspects of the management. All programme funded positions will report to the Programme Manager. The Programme Manager will be directly answerable to the Permanent Secretary of MACO, through eh Policy and Planning Director, as well as to the Programme Steering Committee (PSC). Specific duties: Acting as Secretary to the PSC and ensuring that its directives and guidelines are incorporated into all Programme activities. First class contractual management, with the support of the Procurement and Contracts Officer; ensuring contractors are meeting their obligations and are paid only for agreed deliverables. Liaison function for all aspects related to the Programme, especially the development and maintenance of partnerships with related programmes and projects and institutions engaged in smallholder agribusiness development and rural financial services. Direct responsibility - with such external professional assistance as required - for the initial arrangements for the operation of the Programme; and for the design, testing and introduction of the essential Programme management systems and procedures. Coordination and supervision of preparation of annual workplans and budgets by all implementing units and contractors; and amalgamation of these into the overall AWPB. Final accountability for operation of Programme bank accounts. Oversight of the work of the Programme team. Facilitation and/or supervision of the tender procedures for service contracting and coordination of work of contractors. Preparation of six-monthly and annual reports to the MACO, PSC, MFNP and IFAD. Providing leadership, guidance, enthusiasm and catalytic input to all levels of Programme participants and activities, whenever appropriate. Ensuring that the PMU, and all consultants and contractors engaged by it, comply with the Programme’s gender and targeting strategies. Qualifications and experience: A university degree in economics, social sciences or a natural resources discipline would be a marked advantage. At least 15 years experience in the planning, management, administration and implementation of agricultural or rural development Programmes in the public, private or NGO sectors and specific exposure to commercial/private sector practice in service contracting, performance monitoring and financing. Competencies: effective judgment and determination; a consistent track record of increasing responsibility and achievement; and a high level of inter-personal skills; Strong written and oral communication skills in English; Strong analytical skills Self motivated and creative thinker; Proven ability to work in teams, strong social skills and open-minded and 87 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 2. Ability to work independently and with limited supervision. Financial Management Specialist The Financial Controller will be the principal actor in routine financial management of Programme activities, responsible for the smooth flow and proper accounting of use of funds - and with the help of his/her Secretary/Accounts Assistant - personnel, equipment, supplies and external services. He/she will report directly to the Programme Manager and be a key member of the PMU, particularly in relation to liaison with the MACO, MFNP, IFAD, Bankers, private sector. Specific responsibilities: Ensuring that administrative and financing directives and guidelines of the Steering Committee are reflected in all Programme activity. Establishing the financial and administrative policies, systems, formats and procedures, including those for service contracting, budgeting and accounts and audit. The liaison function for all programme related activities, vis a vis financial management and control. Taking primary responsibility for the financial aspects of preparation of the Programme AWPBs. Operating the designated and operational accounts in accordance with IFAD procedures. Ensuring compliance by contractors of all financial management related aspects. Supervising the financial management of programme resources at provincial level, including through regular visits to the PACOs’ offices Preparation and submission of routine and ad-hoc financial reviews and reports as needed, including six-monthly reports to the Programme Manager. Ensuring the availability and smooth flow of Programme funds, resources and supplies. Assisting in facilitation and supervision of the tender, award and performance assessment procedures for service contracting. Preparation and application of procurement procedures in accordance with Government requirements. Arranging, participating in and monitoring the conduct of all audits and reviews, and preparing the necessary reports. Qualification and Experience University degree with full membership of the Zambian Institute of Chartered Accountants. At least 10 years experience in the financial and administrative management of Programmes or businesses with similar funding budgets and contractual complements similar to those under this Programme. Competencies Strong written and oral communication skills in English Strong analytical skills Self motivated and creative thinker Proven ability to work in teams, strong social skills and open-minded Ability to work independently and with limited supervision 88 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 3. Procurement and Contracts Specialist Since a large portion of the activities of the Programme will be contracted out to serviceproviders, the PMU will engage a Procurement and Contracts Specialist who will be responsible for ensuring that all goods and services procured by the Programme will be done in accordance with the approved procedures as set out in the PIM and the Letter to the Borrower. Specific responsibilities: preparation of a rolling 18 month procurement plan in the form specified in the financing agreement and suitable for incorporation in the AWPB; monitoring the progress of procurement and contracting activities against the targets specified in the AWPB; ensuring that the Programme’s gender and targeting strategies are operationalised through its procurement procedures; With assistance from other S3P staff, preparing terms of reference for consultancy services and technical specifications for hardware procurement, in conjunction with the relevant technical personnel in MACO; undertaking local shopping for goods and services where this falls within the procurement guidelines; preparing tender documents in the required format and advertising or inviting bids from qualified (or pre-qualified) suppliers; convening and supporting bid evaluation committees to undertake technical evaluation of bids or proposals for supply of goods and services; awarding contracts for supply of goods and services, negotiating contractual conditions and monitoring performance against contracts awarded; approving progressive payments to contractors against the agreed milestones or outputs; maintaining a register of approved suppliers for smaller items procured locally, and a register of contracts and payments against milestones or outputs; submitting quarterly and annual reports on all procurement and contractual activities undertaken by the Programme. Qualification and Experience Degree in economics, finance or law; or equivalent management qualification with Significant training and practical experience in procurement within Government programmes supported by international financial institutions. Sound understanding of GRZ procurement guidelines and the protocols and procedures applying to internationally financed projects in Zambia. At least seven years experience in procurement and contracting preferably including the operation of decentralised co-financing schemes. Competencies Strong written and oral communication skills in English Strong analytical skills Self motivated and creative thinker Proven ability to work in teams, strong social skills and open-minded Ability to work independently and with limited supervision 89 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 4. Planning Monitoring & Evaluation/KM Specialist The Planning, Monitoring & Evaluation/Knowledge Management & Communication Specialist will have overall responsibility for coordinating and facilitating the planning, M&E and KMC activities related to S3P implementation. The Specialist will ensure that robust systems for PME and KM are not only established, but also fully linked, to enable the Programme to be flexible and responsive to changing circumstances. The Specialist will also assess needs and capacity for PME and KM at provincial, district and lower levels and accordingly design and implement capacity building programmes. The Specialist will engage and closely supervise service providers who will work on M&E and KM with relevant Government staff at Provincial and District levels. Specific PME duties The PME/KM Specialist will provide overall leadership, coordination and facilitation to: Establish a Monitoring and Evaluation System taking into account the Government monitoring frameworks, IFAD RIMs and project objectives Develop a Management Information System (MIS) for managing data and information for overall monitoring. Fine-tune the programme’s dynamic Logframe in keeping with IFAD-RIMS; Define and establish the programme’s monitoring formats, and impact indicators; Organize and supervise a focused baseline survey at the beginning of the programme to be undertaken by a contracted institution; Establish implementation targets, monitor implementation performance, and assess outputs and outcomes; Facilitate programme’s annual review workshops, impact assessment studies, Mid Term Review and completion review; Collect essential data to be included in quarterly, semi-annual and annual reports; Monitor financial and physical progress as well as reporting back to stakeholders to create a better learning environment; Organize training for the MACO and other partners implementing in MIS, PIMA system and basic reporting requirements; Improve programme performance by providing relevant and well researched information to the PMU on a timely basis; Ensure capture of intended impact as well as successes and failures; processes and Specific duties Develop a Knowledge Management & Communication Strategy systematic, continuous learning, improvement and knowledge sharing; Develop annual workplans and budgets to operationalize the KMC strategy and make sure it is internalized by key programme implementers; Develop and implement processes to ensure that lessons learned and good practice are captured systematically, shared, and used to improve programme implementation; Support advocacy efforts through providing evidence of impact gathered through the M&E system, closely linked to knowledge management activities; Coordinate the development and implementation of training programmes to build capacity and develop knowledge management skills and competencies of MACO staff at all levels, as well as private and public service providers Provide technical backstopping and guidance to MACO staff at Provincial and District level responsible for PME and KMC . 90 to ensure Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Develop or adapt relevant tools and processes for implementing staff to collect, process/analyse, store and share information and knowledge, and ensure relevant staff have the capacity to use them; Ensure that innovative experiences, learning and good practices are captured, synthesized, documented and shared continuously within the Programme, within the MACO, with the IFAD Country Programme Team (CPT) and with in-country partners, IFAD and other regional and international partners; Ensure that lessons and good practice emerging from the Programme support knowledge based decision making and policy dialogue; Provide communication support to awareness raising and sensitisation of Programme participants, including building understanding of the Programme’s objectives, benefits; Assess and establish appropriate communication channels to be used for different stakeholders. Foster partnerships for broader knowledge-sharing and learning; Ensure monitoring and evaluation of performance of the programme’s KMC strategy. Commission short-term technical assistance and undertake any other duties that may be assigned to him/her by the PM; Qualifications Higher-level degree in agricultural economics, rural development or other relevant field University-level studies in a field related to communication, management or a related field would be an advantage Proficient in the use of databases and spreadsheets; demonstrated skills in quantitative and qualitative analysis and data management; proficient with statistical and other software packages for both quantitative and qualitative analysis Experience in analyzing complex programmes or policies. knowledge Experience: Minimum of 10 years relevant experience. Significant experience working in in M&E and/or programme management, plus KM and/or communication for development projects. Experience in facilitation, in particular of learning processes. Proven experience in designing and implementing successful communication and knowledge management strategies for sustainable development, or in planning and implementing strategies at management level. Past experience of working on a donor-funded project would be an advantage. Experience in process documentation an advantage. Good understanding of use of modern information and communication technology (ICT) in development. Competencies Strong written and oral communication skills in English Strong analytical skills Self motivated and creative thinker Proven ability to work in teams, strong social skills and open-minded Ability to work independently and with limited supervision 91 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 5. Local Agricultural Investments Manager The Manager will ensure not only that procedures for the Local Agricultural Investments sub-component are established, but also that they function with active involvement of the community through dialogue, community participation and decision making in the planning, implementation and monitoring of the programme. The Manager will work to perform as an adjunct to the Programme Coordinator to ensure all modalities for the implementation of sub-component are put in place and for supervising (intra) community agricultural investments activities. Key Duties The Manager will provide overall leadership, coordination and facilitation to: Establish the modalities of operationalizing a co-financing facility taking into account the Government procurement procedures issued in accordance with the Public Procurement Act 2008, the IFAD 2010 Procurement guidelines, environmental, and gender issues. Provide support to communities and local MACO structures to ensure the proposals are identified, prepared, reviewed and approved, and financed; Monitor the use and impact of the sub-projects financed, and ensure that the M&E activities of the Local Agricultural Investment sub-component are incorporated in the Knowledge Management & Communication Strategy, to ensure systematic and continuous learning, improvement and knowledge sharing; Modify the operational procedures as necessary, in the light of implementation experience Commission short-term technical assistance and undertake any other duties that may be assigned to him/her by the PM; Specific duties The Manager will, in collaboration with the relevant MACO technical staff and District Council staff: Design various documents which will be necessary for the smooth and effective implementation of the infrastructure activities under the community-based agricultural investment. These may include but not limited to an infrastructure application form, a technical field appraisal (TFA) form, a social-cost Benefit Analysis sheet, Monthly brief form, Community partnership agreement form, partnership/contractor agreement form, invitation to tender document, guidelines for participation in the bidding process which should conform to IFAD procurement guidelines and the Zambia tendering procedures, tender evaluation form, tender evaluation summary sheet, agenda for tender evaluation and awarding session, activity and payment schedule, programme monitoring form, programme completion report format, maintenance guidelines, and programme committee training checklist. Participate in building the capacity of provincial and district staff to enable them to effectively undertake technical field and appraisal visits to undertake the social, economic, environmental and technical feasibility assessment. Participate in the design of the Programme’s Environmental Policy and Environmental Guidelines which will be applied to all projects funded by the Programme. Participate in supervising and monitoring of Contractor’s implementation or construction works after every major activity in the Activity Schedule together with Clerk of Works (District Council, MACO technical staff and FTL. The EC will submit monthly project monitoring reports to the FTL and S3P M&E specialist. Monitor the status of sub-projects financed through the three windows, and where possible assess their impact. 92 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Prepare and submit a programme completion report to the S3P TL at the end of each assignment. Qualifications and experience Civil engineering or Rural engineering Degree 10 years experience in similar rural engineering consultancy works Experience of working with community-based construction projects Knowledge of financial management will be an added advantage Able to develop Bill of Quantities Able to provide training to contractors and other stakeholders 6. Research for Development Specialist The Research for Development Specialist together with the Extension specialist will work in close collaboration to advise/support MACO in the implementation of Components 1.2 and 1.3. The Research and Development (R&D) specialist will work specifically with ZARI staff located in Kasama (Northern Province) and Mansa (Luapula Province) research stations. His/her approach will be that of contribute to build ZARI’s capacity to manage research activities more efficiently and effectively and establish sustainable linkages between research and extension in order to be better able to respond to priority needs of smallholder farmers. The R&D specialist will assist ZARI in the planning and implementation of the activities foreseen in the AR4D sub-component of the project. The R&D specialist will be based in Kasama or in Mansa. Specific duties: The specific responsibilities of the Research and development specialist will include the following: Assist in the preparation of the Annual Work Plan and Budget (AWPB); Provide methodological support for planning research trials and programmes; Assist in the preliminary participatory diagnostic study of the cassava-mixed beans based farming system to identify the major potential and constraints faced by smallholder farmers; Compile, in collaboration with ZARI staff, a baseline report on the research activities undertaken by Mansa and Kasama research stations in the last five years highlighting constraints and options for the future; Assist in the identification of partners for research and technical assistance from international research centers, establish contacts and estimate potential for collaboration; Support ZARI staff in activities related to enhancing research extension linkages and coordination; Participate in the coordination workshops and meetings both at PACO and DACO levels; Assist ZARI staff in improving their capacity of information and knowledge sharing and documentation; Organize and deliver training to ZARI staff as well as extension staff; Deliver on-the-job training to counterpart ZARI staff as required; Establish and maintain linkage with other partners (NGOs, private sector, universities etc) undertaking research on the commodities targeted by the project and ensure regular exchange of information; Promote gender, HIV/ AIDS and environment mainstreaming in research options; 93 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Monitor implementation of project activities related to AR4D Prepare contribution to progress reports Qualifications and experience PhD in agriculture, soil science or other relevant field At least 8 years experience in adaptive research on soil fertility management in agro-ecological zone similar to the project are and/or varietal screening of one or more of the commodities targeted by the project (cassava, mixed beans, rice, groundnuts); Some experience in capacity development and training; Experience in facilitation, in particular of learning processes. Previous experience as technical assistant in development projects will be considered favourably; Good knowledge of the African research institutions as well as the International research institutions; Competencies Strong written and oral communication skills in English Strong analytical skills Self motivated and creative thinker Proven ability to work in teams, strong social skills and open-minded Ability to work independently and with limited supervision 7. Participatory Extension (PE) Specialist The Participatory extension specialist will work in close collaboration with the Research for Development specialist to advise/support MACO in the implementation of Components 1.2 and 1.3. The PE specialist will work with the decentralized structures of MACO (PACO and DACOs) in Luapula and Northern provinces to start with, and later in a third province still to be selected. His/her approach will be that of contributing to build MACO’s capacity to deliver better quality advisory services to farmers and do so more efficiently and effectively. The PE specialist will assist MACO in the planning and implementation of the activities foreseen in the sub-component 1.2 of the project. He/she will be based in Kasama or in Mansa. Specific duties: Assist in the preparation of the Annual Work Plan and Budget (AWPB); Provide methodological support for the harmonization of the various existing participatory extension approaches being used in the project area; Support the implementation of a preliminary participatory study of the different methodologies to identify the major potential and constraints of each and analyze issues of sustainability; Facilitate the establishment of contacts with partners implementing different extension methodologies and identify ways of information sharing and concrete collaboration; Support MACO staff in activities related to enhancing research extension linkages and coordination; Participate in the coordination workshops and meetings both at PACO and DACO levels; 94 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Assist MACO staff in improving their capacity of information and knowledge sharing and documentation; Organize and deliver training to PACO, DACO staff including CEO’s; Promote gender, HIV/ AIDS and approaches; Monitor implementation of project activities related to extension; Assist PACO in the organization of the Master training courses at Provincial level, in particular in the identification of the trainers from neighbouring countries; Support master trainers at provincial level in the organization of the Training of trainers (ToT) at the District level; Provide guidance and technical assistance in the development of a good documentation, information and knowledge sharing strategy, with clear outputs and products; Deliver on-the-job training to counterpart MACO staff as required; Prepare contribution to progress reports environment mainstreaming in extension Qualifications and experience Higher-level degree in agriculture, agricultural economics or closely related fields; At least 8 years experience in adaptive participatory extension approaches, Exposure and/or experience with the Farmer Field Schools methodology; Some direct experience in capacity development and training; Experience in facilitation, in particular of learning processes. Previous experience as technical assistant in development projects will be considered favourably. Competencies Strong written and oral communication skills in English Strong analytical skills Self motivated and creative thinker Proven ability to work in teams, strong social skills and open-minded Ability to work independently and with limited supervision 8. Provincial Facilitator The Provincial Facilitator will be posted within the PACO office in provinces where S3P is being implemented and will assist the PACO with the planning, coordination, management of the various project-financed activities, but also provide support to general planning, coordination and management function of the PACO. Specific responsibilities: Advise the PACO and his/her staff to ensure that programme activities are included in the normal planning process at district and provincial level, 95 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Promote close coordination between activities various programmes and stakeholders active in the province, through the organization of regular meetings to plan, share lessons learnt and ensure harmonization of approaches to extension Promote a stronger link between research and extension by supporting Agricultural Research for Development Platform, encouraging an integrated research and extension information platform Promote linkages between various sub-components of the programme Assist the PME specialist to compile the programme AWPB, and to report on implementation of activities and on outputs achieved, \ Provide a Knowledge Management Function by keeping a record of programme activities and achievements, sharing lessons learnt and best practice. Assist the Financial Management Specialist in ensuring that programme funds are spent in line with what they were intended for, and will work closely with provincial accountants (PACO) to ensure that programme expenditures are tracked. Qualifications and experience Advanced degree in agriculture/agronomy or related discipline; At least 10 years experience in public and private sector. Some direct experience in capacity development and training; Experience in facilitation, in particular of learning processes. Competencies Strong written and oral communication skills in English Strong analytical skills Self motivated and creative thinker Proven ability to work in teams, strong social skills and open-minded Ability to work independently and with limited supervision 96 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 6. Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation and Knowledge Introduction 1. Planning, Monitoring and Evaluation (PM&E) systems will be established to meet the needs of Programme management, GRZ, IFAD and other stakeholders. The S3P PME system will be guided by the following principles: (i) the establishment of a sound planning and monitoring framework (logical framework) with a limited number of indicators; (ii) the use of the annual work plan and budget (AWPB) as the key instrument for defining and guiding programme activities and expenditures; (iii) the use of simple M&E processes, structures and instruments, including M&E software which can be adjusted to make M&E information accessible to key stakeholders in a timely manner; (iv) alignment with existing M&E frameworks at national and district level, to strengthen the M&E system of MACO and reduce the workload of the district and camp staff, and in particular use of MACO participatory planning process at camp, district, provincial and national level; (v) timely collection of baseline data for key indicators in the logframe as specified in the M&E Plan; (vi) integration of communication and Knowledge Management (KM) in all aspects of programme planning and M&E to encourage feedback and reflection on results for effective adaptive management; and (vii) provision of adequate resources for capacity building of stakeholders involved in PME activities at all levels, with a focus on participatory PME approaches. Annual Work Plan and Budget (AWPB) 2. The AWPB will be the key instrument for implementation and operational control, in that its approval by the PSC and IFAD will be the authority for the PMU to conduct activities and incur expenditure. It also facilitates operational flexibility, as it allows for regular adjustments to be made to the programme approach, activities and expenditures to reflect the implementation experience gained and changing circumstances. Particular attention will therefore be given to the process for its preparation, which should be inclusive, participatory and demand driven; involve all relevant stakeholders from within and beyond government; and after the first year, build on the annual implementation review. Timely preparation and submission of AWPB will require adherence to a schedule of preparation, which also needs to be linked to the GRZ budgetary approval process. 3. The following AWPB preparation schedule is provided for guidance. It should be reviewed and modified as may be necessary as part of the SAPP start-up activities. AWPB preparation schedule Activity Briefing on preparation of AWPB provision of guidelines and format to key implementing agencies. Call letter from PMU for the preparation of AWPB to PPD, other MACO staff, Service Providers, etc Preparation of AWPB by participating institutions/ service providers. Submission of AWPB proposals to SAPPO. Preparation of consolidated AWPB Review/agreement on draft AWPB by participating institutions and service providers Preparation of 2nd Draft AWPB incorporating comments of participating institutions/service providers and clearance by Programme Manager Review by PSC Schedule End April Early May. May/June. Mid July Mid July – end July Responsibility M&E Specialist supported by Financial Management Specialist Letter drafted by M&E Officer and sent under the signature of Programme Manager Each service provider to have a focal person. SAPPO: M&E specialist, Financial management specialist Early August Meeting called by Programme Manager Mid August M&E Specialist Last week August. PSC 97 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Finalisation by PMU Submission to MACO for incorporation into MACO budget Submission of draft AWPB to IFAD Comments from IFAD Finalisation of AWPB/distribution to implementing institutions/service Providers First week September Mid September Mid October Mid November End December PMU Programme Manager Permanent Secretary - MACO IFAD CPM S3P Programme Manager 4. In a programme such as S3P, in which the geographical area of intervention is defined in only broad terms, the AWPB for PY1, PY2 and PY3 will assume particular importance, in that they will define the specific districts (and within them camps) in which the programme will be implemented. These AWBPs will therefore indicate the districts and camps to be covered during the year to come, selected on the basis of clear and transparent criteria (already defined in the PIM). 5. The S3P M&E specialist will be responsible for coordinating the preparation of AWPB, its consolidation, presentation to PSC, finalisation and submission to IFAD. He/she will receive support from: (i) the Financial Management Specialist to ensure proper costing, incorporation of the financing plan and disbursement arrangement; (ii) the Procurement and Contracts Specialist who will prepare the procurement plan; and (iii) the Technical Team will provide technical support in preparing the work plans. The Programme Manager will oversee the whole process and ensure that the Director of PPD and his team are fully involved in the process. 6. In General the AWPB should cover the following areas: a) Summary of progress and performance since effectiveness including: Physical progress made in the previous year, including quantitative data. Financial progress in the previous year including cost overruns and savings and analysis of flow of funds from financiers. Procurement performance. Constraints and problems from previous year, and recommendations to resolve them. Lessons learned and rationale for activities proposed. b) Description of work plan of current year including: Objectives (why?) Activities (how?) Programme area (where?) Deliverables and outputs (what?) Required inputs Implementation arrangements (when?) Institutional responsibilities (who?) Key M&E indicators, etc c) M&E activities; impact oriented data, expected outputs etc. d) Quantitative data of planned inputs in table format showing detailed physical and financial targets, sources of funding and budget summary tables. e) Monthly activity schedules and timelines (implementation schedule). f) 18-month procurement Plan. Monitoring and evaluation approach 7. Programme results are expected at three different levels (development objective, outcomes, outputs), reflected in the Logical Framework. At development objective level, results are aggregated long-term impact on the beneficiaries. The outcomes are the 98 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report short- and medium-term effects of the programme resulting from beneficiaries access to, use of and satisfaction with outputs of the programme, while the outputs result from the implementation of programme activities and are products and services directly delivered by the programme. At each level a set of indicators has been developed taking into account IFAD’s Results and Impact Management System (RIMS) framework, but also Government strategy and programming documents such as the Sixth National Development Programme (SNDP). These indicators will be reviewed and finalised during programme start-up. Gender-sensitive indicators will be included whenever possible. Since some of the actual implementation will be contracted out to service providers, monitoring requirements will be included as part of their contractual obligations. 8. Programme Management, supported by technical assistance, will be responsible for setting up an effective PME system during the first six months of programme implementation which includes fine-tuning the M&E Plan in consultation with the main programme stakeholders and reviewed during project launch workshop. The logframe and M&E Plan may also be revised at a later stage if required. 9. Programme planning M&E will be coordinated by the M&E specialist whose role will be to facilitate the PM&E function by developing appropriate tools and procedures; by strengthening the capacity of implementing partners to carry out their monitoring tasks; by recruiting specialists for impact assessment and other specialized studies; and by consolidating and analyzing the data. The findings of monitoring and evaluation will be summarized in quarterly and annual progress reports. The S3P M&E specialist will work closely with the Policy and Planning Department in MACO and with other technical departments. The programme will purchase a Management Information Software that will be used to collect data from various levels. Service providers will be required to use this software when reporting on their achievements. 10. The MIS database will be aligned with the MACO M&E system being developed under the “Support to the Agricultural Sector Performance Enhancement Programme (PEP)”. Data collection by Camp officers will be integrated into the Agriculture Diary for Extension Officers. Reporting will be aligned or will be based on the Camp, Block, District and Provincial format of MACO. Data collection methods 11. A baseline survey will be undertaken during the first semester, to establish benchmarks against which the outcomes and impact on the beneficiaries would be assessed. In each programme district, a survey will be carried out during the first quarter of programme implementation in order to obtain an overview of the current production practices and production levels of the cassava based farming systems, identify constraints and potentials, as well as needs for capacity building for different stakeholders. 12. Annual implementation reviews will be done, involving implementers at all levels and key stakeholders to analyse and review lessons and challenges. The reviews will be linked with the AWPB planning processes to ensure that lessons lead to improved implementation. Qualitative analysis will be conducted from the end of the second year to assess whether activities are likely to lead to the desired higher-level results. This will include analysis of the extent to which smaller and poorer producers have increased productivity, and will consider the benefits that have been delivered to women and the youth from a quantitative point of view, by using gender-disaggregated indicators; and from a qualitative view, by case studies on how women producers are better off as a result of Programme interventions. Process monitoring will also be carried out during these reviews, by assessing the degree of beneficiaries’ participation in project activities, quantifying the numbers of households reached through the different components, and confirming the level of participation by women and youth. 13. Specialised studies to evaluate the extent to which the Programme purpose and overall goal are being achieved will be contracted out. Indicators selected from 99 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report IFAD’s Results and Impact Monitoring System (RIMS) as well as general and sectorspecific indicators from SNDP have been integrated in the logical framework. The Programme will mainly rely on secondary sources for baseline data, including the Living Conditions Monitoring Survey (Central Statistical Office, CSO), the Crop Forecast and Post-Harvest Surveys conducted by MACO and CSO, progress reports on the Millennium Development Goals and selected country reports. An assessment of quantitative targets included at all levels in the logical framework will be carried out before the Mid-Term Review. 14. A midterm review will be undertaken, during the first semester of the fourth year to assess programme achievements, interim programme impact, efficiency and effectiveness of programme management, and validity of programme design. On the basis of its findings, the MTR mission will revise the programme document for the remaining programme life and suggest any changes to the PIM, if required. 15. At the end of the programme, an End of Project survey will be carried out to measure changes at beneficiary level, comparing with the baseline situation. Baseline and terminal surveys will be contracted out to service providers under the supervision of the PMU. The PMU will also prepare an internal Programme Completion Report (PCR), which will include an assessment of the achieved versus the planned impact, to be submitted to GRZ and IFAD within three months after programme completion. M&E Linkages to the Performance Enhancement Programme (PEP) 16. MACO’s M&E system is currently characterized by: (a) Activity-Based Budgeting and reporting; (b) parallel reporting processes (where departments at central level are mirrored at provincial and district level and report to their department as well as to the DACO and/or PACO), leading to a variety of formats and type of information being requested; (c) limited possibilities of aggregation of results (since there are no standard indicators and formats used by all departments; (d) a reporting system focusing on activities and production figures of the sector, and little or no information on products and services delivered by MACO (output level), nor on beneficiaries (smallholders) access to, use of, or satisfaction with these services (outcome level). 17. In 2009 the Cabinet took the decision to split agriculture and livestock, and create a Ministry of Livestock and Fisheries Development (MLFD) out of MACO. The Policy and Planning Department (PPD) is being split between the two Ministries at National and Provincial levels, putting an additional strain in terms of staff dedicated to M&E in both Ministries, since there are few dedicated M&E staff at provincial level, and none at district level. To compound this many M&E posts are vacant. 18. PACO and DACO have a coordination role at local level, but this role is not presently exercised fully. Many projects (usually implemented by NGOs, financed with their own funding or with donor funding) start activities without proper consultation with local authorities, and in absence of a coordinated approach. In practice DACOs are aware of projects when these approach them for collaboration, but PACOs are often informed of on-going projects when there is a problem that requires their attention. Poor planning and monitoring of these various initiatives can lead to conflicting implementation methodologies and overlaps, or gaps that could be better addressed if there was a more proactive coordination role by PACOs and DACOs. Limited information sharing means that DACO and PACO usually list the projects operating in their area (the ones they are aware of), but fail to indicate basic information (how many smallholders are targeted, where) and main results achieved by these projects. 19. The objective of the PEP is that the capacities of MACO and MLF are strengthened in an effective and sustainable way. PEP will provide them with resources, staff to take up their new roles, favouring partnerships with private sector. A Change Management Team (CMT) will guide and facilitate implementation and give support to institutional strengthening and capacity building in MACO and MLF for them to fulfil their mandates. It is proposed that the CMT will include 11 members, of which 2 from MACO 100 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report and 2 from MLF, and one representative each from MFNP, Cabinet, Ministry of Commerce, donors, NGO, private sector, training institutions. 20. Results to be achieved are grouped around four broad areas which are: (a) change management and improved services (including setting up CMT); (b) sector policy planning and financial management (including link to MTEF and IFMIS); (c) human resources management training and ICT (including payroll and personnel databases, job description, human resources strategies, training strategies both internal and external); (d) monitoring and evaluation. Total budget is 7.5 million EUR over three and half years. 21. Support to the M&E system has been identified as a priority area of intervention, especially focusing on the review and design of and M&E system with MTEF indicators. The EC has limited its support to an envelope of EUR 340,000, aimed at providing two TA (to develop methodologies for social accountability (3 months), and a assist with identification of indicators and strengthening of the current reporting system, (12 months), and to finance a user survey, implemented by a national institution. It is foreseen that this support would target the first 24 months of the PEP. However there are substantial additional resources to strengthen the Management Information System (MIS) and the IT requirements to set-up and roll-out such a system. 22. IFAD and Finland are also co-financing the PEP with approximately 1.9 million USD of grant resources aimed at strengthening and supporting M&E and Early Warning system in MACO, in particular providing training to MACO staff at all levels. The objectives of this grant is for MACO to better be able to perform its sector coordination function at local level, to provide timely and quality food security information, and to monitor its performance and that of the sector (other stakeholders) more effectively, through the production of data that contributes to evidence based decision making, either through administrative reporting systems or through surveys. A MACO M&E working group is being set-up, chaired by PPD, and with M&E staff from the various departments, and various donor financed and MACO implemented projects. 23. In this regard, MACO has requested that S3P provides technical assistance to PPD in the form of a Programme planning and monitoring specialist who will be based in PPD and who will report to the Director PPD, for a period of 3 years, and who will: (i) assist with the review of the current M&E system in MACO, including reviewing current M&E indicators, reporting formats, frequency and information flow; (ii) facilitate internal discussion within the PPD M&E Unit, the M&E Working Group and progressively to larger audiences regarding the selection of key indicators, reporting formats, frequency and information flow; (iii) facilitate discussion during workshops at central and provincial level; and (iv) advise PPD regarding IT requirements for a Management Information System. This person will also build capacity and assist in: (a) the coordination and harmonization of the different initiatives, projects and programmes in relation to the SNDP, the National Agricultural Policy and the Zambia CAADP; and (b) the management of information and communication flows related to these. Knowledge management and learning processes 24. In S3P, knowledge management and learning (KM&L) will be a means to make the programme more effective and efficient, enable it to simplify processes, adapt much faster to the emerging realities and lessons, and achieve greater impact. The main purpose of KM processes within S3P is to ensure that knowledge generated is systematically identified, analysed, documented, used to improve programme performance and shared. KM&L will be fully linked to the S3P PME system, to enable a continuous improvement process, based on feedback loops from data collection to analysis and interpretation. This will enable S3P to be flexible and responsive to changing circumstances. Emerging lessons and experience will also be used to support capacity building and institution strengthening activities of a range of stakeholders, especially MACO at provincial, district and camp level, as well as other GRZ departments, service providers, farmer organizations and others. Systematic KM&L will also support evidence-based decision-making and policy development. 101 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 25. The S3P KM&L system will be developed in consultation with the “Smallholder Agribusiness Promotion Programme” (SAPP) and the “Support to the Agricultural sector Performance Enhancement Programme (PEP) which has just started programme activities. This is expected to facilitate “scaling up” of innovations and lessons into MACO and its institutions. 26. The objective of the KM&L system of S3P is to integrate Knowledge Management and Communication (KMC) in all aspects of project management (including design, implementation, M&E, financial management, supervision and reporting) to improve project management processes and delivery of the programme objectives. The KMC system will be guided by the following key concepts and principles: institutionalization; knowledge value chain approach; action learning; communities of practice; and networking and partnerships. 27. In developing the S3P KM system, the following steps will be considered: (a) design of an appropriate monitoring and documentation system; (b) development of appropriate institutional arrangements; (c) monitoring, evaluation and documentation; (d) information management; (e) communication; and (f) knowledge based project support, decision making and policy dialogue. 28. The objectives, activities, responsibilities and methods for each of these steps will be elaborated with stakeholders as part of start-up support process. A PME/KMC specialist will be included in the PMU. The KM capacity at provincial and district level will be strengthened so that each province and district can analyze its implementation experience and incorporate this for enhanced programme results and sharing. The annual S3P supervision and implementation support mission will not only be for assessing fiduciary issues, but also to assess knowledge and capacity gaps and how these are managed. The programme’s PME/KM system will also provide key learning opportunities for understanding and assessing progress towards meeting GRZ development targets. Awareness will be created within the private sector and among other stakeholders as to opportunities for participation in service provision in the rural areas, and opportunities will be created for new actors to enter the market for services. 29. Although some costs of implementing the KM system are integrated within project implementation, other costs related to building and managing the KM system, and upgrading KM competencies were identified, including: national PME/KM specialists; field back stopping support by PME/KMC; KM capacity building, coaching and mentoring; information communication technology (ICT) comprising equipment, maintenance and training; documentation equipment; production of documented outputs; review and planning workshops; participation in networking and knowledge sharing workshops. 30. KM&L in S3P will support the policy and institutional framework in two major ways: (a) support the integration of KM&L in MACO; and (b) develop mechanisms for continuous policy dialogue and improvement based on lessons from practice and evidence gathered. This will include the following strategies: Utilisation of the knowledge and lessons and evidence in project implementation for a strategic policy dialogue e.g. extension assessment to inform the need of an extension policy Involvement of policy and decision makers in lesson learning and KM activities Studies to assess the level of learning at policy level Establishment of institutionalised mechanisms for feedback from practice into policy arena 31. Specific KM&L activities will include: Awareness sessions/meetings with policy makers on lessons learnt and policy implications – towards improvement 102 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Bring policy makers to specific learning events in projects to become part of the lessons learning Produce adequate policy influence materials targeting specific policy arenas Informal communication and engagement with policy and decision makers by project coordinator and staff Make lessons and implication learning a part of an agenda where policy makers meet and discuss (annual review meetings of ministries etc , Country assistance strategy papers, etc ) 103 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 7. Financial Management and Disbursement Arrangements Introduction 1. Both GRZ and IFAD require that the Programme be well managed and supervised to ensure that loan proceeds are used only for intended purposes with due regard to efficiency, effectiveness and sustainable achievement of the Programme’s development objectives. In order for the implementing agencies and all those involved in the Programme’s financial management (e.g. external auditors) to have a common understanding of and approach to the various aspects of financial management and disbursement arrangements, these are described in the next paragraphs. 2. Both Finland and Sweden have recently made their own assessment of MACO’s financial management systems and capacity1. Some of the main findings are that while MACO staff are well trained and able to apply sound financial management, internal audit and procurement systems, the areas of bank reconciliation, accounting and reporting (no double entry accounting system), and audit committee function are all considered as weak. At provincial level the main constraints include: a) shortage of district accountants and absence of internal audit post at provincial level, b) weak bank reconciliation procedures c) budget reallocation according to needs (fungibility risk), d) poor procurement control and limited procurement skills, and e) the absence of a systemic asset management system. 3. At present the level of fiduciary risk in the Ministry as a whole is therefore considered to be substantial, though it is expected that the roll-out of the Integrated Financial Management Information System (IFMIS), foreseen in 2012, will help address many of the constraints that were identified. However, the proposed arrangements for financial management under S3P recognise and respond to the current weaknesses, building in a number of safeguards and risk mitigation measures. Financing 4. The programme will be co-financed by IFAD (loan of USD 24.8 million), the Government of Finland (grant of USD 7.1 million), the Government of the Republic of Zambia (estimated USD 6.1 million), districts (US$ 0.4 million); and by programme beneficiaries (USD 1.5 million). 5. Finland’s contribution will be channelled via IFAD and blended with the IFAD loan in a fixed ratio (pari passu) of approximately 22 per cent (Finland): 78 per cent (IFAD). This arrangement will be formalised in the financing agreement between GRZ and IFAD, in which Finland’s contribution will appear, as well as agreements between IFAD and Finland, and between the Governments of Finland and Zambia. The GRZ contribution will come from foregone taxes and duties; while the contribution of both the districts, which will be mainly in-kind (staff time), and the beneficiaries’, with will be both cash and inkind (labour and local materials), will be limited to sub-component 2.1 (Local Agricultural Investments). Disbursement Procedures and Withdrawal of Funds 6. Negotiations for the loan will include agreeing on Loan Administration arrangements, which will be contained in a Letter to the Borrower sent from IFAD to MFNP. Programme expenditures will be broken down by expenditure category, as well as by financier. 7. The Letter to the Borrower will provide for four alternative disbursement procedures, as follows: (i) via Designated Account; (ii) Direct Payment; (iii) Special Commitment; and (iv) Reimbursement of expenditures incurred. It is foreseen that the 1 Assessment of the Financial Management Capacity of the Ministry of Agricultuere and Cooperative and the Ministry of Livestock and Fisheries, (2010) Finnish Consulting Group; Pre-Award Assessment Ministry of Agriculture and Cooperatives (2009), Moore Stephens LLP (Upon request of the Embassy of Sweden) 104 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report bulk of programme funds will be disbursed through the first procedure via the designated account. Direct Payment procedure will be used only for payments on goods and services procured internationally. 8. To initiate the process of accessing IFAD funding, MACO/PPD with assistance of MFNP will submit the request for an initial advance which will be processed by IFAD if the following requirements are fulfilled: a) Disbursement conditions as defined in the loan agreement will have been met b) Letter on authorised signatories will have been submitted to IFAD. c) A procurement plan has been prepared. d) The Withdrawal Application will have been found in order following the guidelines to be contained in the Letter to the Borrower. 9. This advance will cover a list of expenditure for programme start-up (detailed in Annex 5: Implementation arrangements), which are necessary before the first Annual Work Plan and Budget can be prepared and approved by the Project Steering Committee. 10. Subsequent withdrawal applications will be submitted based on forms to be prescribed in the Letter to the Borrower and must be signed by the authorised persons designated by GRZ who will be the Programme Manager, Financial Management Specialist, MACO‘s Chief Accountant (representing MFNP) and the Director of PPD at MACO. A withdrawal application is a legal instrument for withdrawal of loan proceeds. Flow of Funds and Financial Management 11. Funds flow arrangements have been kept simple (see chart in Appendix 1). IFAD/Finland funds will pass into a Designated Account (DA) denominated in US Dollars and held at the Zambia Reserve Bank (ZRB). This account will be managed by MACO/PPD and will require one signature each from both Category 1 (Director PPD, Chief Accountant or Principal Accountant) and Category 2 (PMU Programme Manager or Financial Management Specialist). The designated account will be used to feed the Kwacha-denominated Operations Account (OA), which will be held in a commercial bank in Lusaka and will be managed exclusively by the PMU. It will be replenished from the DA, based on progress reports and in compliance with IFAD disbursement procedures. Any involvement of public/ private institutions in the delivery of programme activities will be treated as service provision, and will be translated into output-based contracts/MOUs with payments treated as reimbursable to the service provider. 12. For activities implemented by MACO at decentralised level, funds will be made available to an Operations sub-account, or provincial project account, held in ZK in a commercial bank branch in each of the Provincial capitals where the project is working. It will operate on the basis of an imprest account: the PMU will provide an advance that will need to be justified before subsequent releases. This account will finance activities implemented by MACO, and will consist of paying DSA, fuel, training facility, equipment, etc… 13. Financial management at the provincial level can be problematic; there are frequently pressures on the provincial accountant to use project resources for nonproject purposes. To strengthen the S3P financial management arrangements at this level and prevent any possibility of leakage of funds, a series of measures are proposed: The amount of the advance will initially be kept low (one month operations) and gradually increased as capacities are improved and the provincial accountant is able to provide complete and accurate financial reports. The Financial Management Specialist in the PMU will be expected to travel to the provinces monthly to review and verify the provincial programme accounts. He/she will be provided with an adequate travel budget to make this possible. 105 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report All transfers of funds from the operations account in Lusaka to the provincial programme account will be accompanied by a note to the Provincial PS, indicating the expected use of the funds. Using an internet banking facility, the FMS will be able to review the provincial operations accounts in real time. He/she will also be authorised to block the account in the event of unjustified expenditures. All proposed expenditures from the account will be: (a) subject to ex-ante audit; (b) cleared (by email) by the FMS; and (c) approved by the PS of the Province In addition, orientation and related training on financial management and procurement procedures (both GRZ and IFAD) will be provided for all relevant staff at provincial level: the provincial accountant, PACO, internal auditor, PS. These should also be involved in the preparation of the AWPB, to increase their awareness of the proposed project activities. Support for the Provincial Accountants’ mobility, to enable them to visit the districts, will also be provided. The Summary of Funds flow arrangements by sub-component is shown below: Sub-component 1.1 Strengthening Farmers Organizations and their federation Possible Payment Arrangements Essentially a Service Provider requiring a contract, and payments linked to agreed outputs These payments will be made directly by the PMU Funds will be channelled to provincial accounts, managed by MACO under supervision of Financial Management Specialist, and after adequate training. Payment will cover DSA, fuel, training facility, equipment Partnerships with other organizations will be formalized under a MoU which will specify payment conditions. These payments will be made directly by the PMU, as for any service providers Funds will be channelled to provincial accounts, managed by MACO under supervision of Financial Management Specialist, and after adequate training. Partnerships with other organizations will be formalized under a MoU which will specify payment conditions. These payments will be made directly by the PMU, as for any service providers Funds will be disbursed to the Project Provincial Account to be managed by the Provincial Accountant, with the support of the Provincial Facilitator from the PMU. Contractors and agro-dealers will be paid directly from this subaccount, following detailed disbursement modalities. Groups will be required to open their own bank account to mobilize their contribution, but no project monies will be transferred there. Disbursements will be eligible for IFAD replenishment at the point of making the disbursements, as opposed to waiting for the grantee to spend the last Kwacha of the Grant; but through accounting/ grants management software the follow-up of the grant utilisation will be assured. 2.2 Support to Policy and Institutional Framework The payments will al be done from the Operations Account, managed by PMU. Payments for the Internationally recruited TA will be done by IFAD through Direct Payment procedure. 2.3 Programme Management, Monitoring and Evaluation All activities to be managed by PMU. The payments will al be done from the Operations Account, managed by PMU. 1.2 Pluralistic participatory extension services 1.3 Agricultural Research for Development 2.1 Local Agricultural Investments 14. The operation of the Designated Account and Operational Programme Account will be in accordance with IFAD procedures. The DA will be replenished on the basis of regular withdrawal applications with the appropriate supporting documentation, known as Statement of Expenditures (SoE). Disbursement of funds from the DA will be made for all eligible expenditures – excluding taxes and duties – against submission of full standard supporting documentation. SoEs will not be required for contracts and/or payments valued at less than US$ 30,000, or its equivalent in local currency, for all 106 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report goods, works or services. In such cases all underlying documentation related to such cases will be retained at the PMU, and made available for sample post-review by IFAD Supervision Missions and examined by auditors as required. 15. The Designated Account will have a ceiling equivalent to approximately six months of programme expenditure (between 12-15 per cent of total loan amount). Fiduciary Risk and Mitigation Measures Several fiduciary risks have been identified and will be mitigated by the project: Fungibility risk Delays in production of supporting documentation Limited financial management skills Delays in counterpart funds Only limited funds will be sent to the provincial project imprest account, according to needs, and corresponding to no more than 3 months of the AWPB. Initially amounts will cover one month of expenditure Close supervision from Fin. Management Specialist in PMU All proposed expenditures to be cleared and approved Annual audits IFAD supervision missions Reporting will be done by the Provincial accountant under supervision from S3P financial management specialist, who will visit once a month to reconcile bank account and financial reports The project will finance financial management and procurement training to provincial and district financial management and procurement staff in all provinces where the project will be operating National technical assistance support will be provided during the first 12 months to assist them with financial reporting, and book keeping Taxes and duties are now considered eligible expenditures (section 11.01(c) of the new IFAD general conditions of financing Accounting System 16. According to GRZ procedures, S3P Financial Statements will be prepared in compliance with International Public Sector Accounting Standards (IPSAS) Cash basis. Guidance on compliance will be offered by the MACO Chief Accountant who is an officer of the MFNP - Accountant General’s Office. IFAD financed S3P transactions will initially be accounted for and reported on using the SAPPO accounting package. Approximately 60 percent of IFAD projects in the region use TomPro accounting software with good results. This software can also be programmed to generate automatically withdrawal statements. S3P will adopt the last version of TOMPRO with the multi-sites option to allow recording of data at the provincial level and consolidation of accounting data at the central level 17. The accounting system will be configured to be able to generate financial information in the following dimensions: expenditure trends by components by financier; expenditure trends by categories by financier; contractors statements of account with sufficient audit trail; investment fund Module able to handle such anticipated magnitude of grants; outstanding advances to contractors and others, aged to facilitate follow-up; commitments; receivables in the form of replenishment applications in transit and any refunds that may be due from Government. 18. Performance-based invoices will be the basis for payments to contractors. For a contractor to be paid, an invoice will be submitted with evidence that a related milestone to justify a payment has been achieved. However reimbursable costs will have to be fully justified. It will be the responsibility of the service providers to collate documentation to support their reimbursement cost claims. 107 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 19. Provinces will have formal accounting obligation and provincial accountants will be provided with training on financial management and procurement procedures (both GRZ and IFAD procedures). A national Technical Assistance will be provided to them at the beginning of the project to assist them with preparation of financial statements, reports and book-keeping. The accounting software will need to have a grants (or subprojects) module to keep track of commitments and disbursements. Financial Reporting and Programme Financial Statements 20. According to GRZ procedures, S3P Financial Statements will be prepared in compliance with International Public Sector Accounting Standards (IPSAS) Cash basis and give a true and fair view of the financial position of the Programme and of the resources and expenditures for the audited period. The PFS should include: A statement of funds received and of expenditures incurred disclosing separately IFAD’s funds, counterpart funds (government), and beneficiaries’ funds. Expenditure trends component-wise; category-wise each analysed by financier with a budget versus actual variance analysis. A summary of the activities of the Designated Account. A Balance Sheet showing accumulated funds of the Programme, bank balances, as limited under IPSAS cash basis. A schedule listing individual Withdrawal Applications. A summary of the accounting policies and other explanatory notes. A list of assets acquired or procured to date with Programme funds. 21. Guidance on compliance will be offered by the MACO Chief Accountant who is an officer of the MFNP - Accountant General’s Office. 22. Provincial accountants will prepare financial statements based on models developed by the PMU’s Financial management specialist. 23. The MACO Chief Accountant will be closely involved in the preparation of Final Accounts. Progress reports are a formal requirement. Sufficient information must be made available about what money is spent on, how much is spent on what, and what the results are. The main functions of progress reports include: 24. review current progress compared to budget; provide overall status information on the Programme since it started, in terms of physical progress and total expenditure; identify problems during the reporting period and steps to solve these problems; analyse strengths and weaknesses, opportunities and threats; discuss quantitative objectives; and provide strategic direction for the next planning cycle. and compared qualitative to planned progress activities made in and expenditure achieving overall 25. Monthly management accounts will be prepared based on the accounting system to aid management decision and control. The monthly management accounts will include the following. Budget Execution Report. A budget/actual comparison of the expenditures incurred component-wise and category-wise. It includes a list of commitments entered into and still to be paid (including awarded grants not yet settled); analysed component-wise and category-wise. A commitment is a signed contract or issued a Purchase Order, or grant agreement. 108 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Statement of financial position (financial assets and liabilities). Statement of commitments (off-balance sheet) - the contracts and grants register. Bank reconciliation statement. 26. Half yearly reports should be submitted to IFAD no later than three months after the end of each six month period. Annual financial reports will also need to be prepared and submitted not later than three months following the end of the year. 27. The nature of annual reports is different from that of half-year reports. In addition to a simple review of implementation progress, this requires analysis by Programme management. A full picture of Programme resources, achievements of the past year and since the beginning of the Programme, as well as annual and cumulative expenditure needs to be presented. Analysis is required of successful approaches and outputs, failures and constraints, performance of implementing partners, and whether progress is being made towards achieving objectives. Such analysis should lead to conclusions about the effectiveness of Programme strategies, the need for modification of the logical framework, and planning for the following year. Audit 28. MACO internal auditors will include S3P in their annual internal audit plans – and will thus cover it during the audits in accordance with GRZ procedures. MACO internal auditors will have a right to report directly to the PSC should there be a need. There should be at least one internal audit report covering SAPP in each quarter. 29. Each year GRZ’s Auditor General or a firm acceptable to him/her will do an external audit of the Programme’s Financial Statements. The audit will be carried out in accordance with International Standards on Auditing. Normal GRZ procedures will be followed in selection and appointment of auditors, which need to be hired by the Auditor general. The PMU will prepare a list of firms to be invited to tender, after consulting with the Auditor General. IFAD will need to provide its no objection to this list before the tender is issued. The tender evaluation report will also need to be cleared by IFAD before it can be sent to the Auditor general for issuing the contract to the external audit firm. 30. The audit report will be circulated to the PSC, IFAD, MACO and other interested stakeholders. A certified copy of the Audit Report must be submitted to IFAD no later than 6 months after the end of the Fiscal Year. Failure to do so will result in an automatic and mandatory suspension of disbursements. Appendix 2 provides sample terms of reference for the external auditors. 31. The auditors should verify that the Programme PFSs have been prepared in accordance with the International Public Sector Accounting Standards (IPSAS) - Cash Basis and give a true and fair view of the financial position of the Programme and of the resources and expenditures for the audited period. The Auditors’ opinion should confirm that the financial statements comply with the official books of accounts, based on the accounting software in operation. As an annex to the PFSs, the auditors should prepare a reconciliation of the amounts shown as received by S3P and those shown as disbursed by IFAD. The auditors are to comment on the accounting principles used for the preparation of the financial statements and on if they were consistently applied. Special attention will be given to determine whether: IFAD and counterpart funds, have been used in accordance with the financing agreement, with due attention to economy, efficiency, and only for the purposes for which financing was provided. Goods and services have been procured in accordance with the financing agreement. All supporting documentation, records and accounts have been maintained in respect of all Programme activities, (including the expenditures by SOEs). 109 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report The Designated Account has been used and maintained in conformity with the financing agreement. Assets procured from Programme funds exist, are properly safeguarded and there is a verifiable ownership by the implementing agency or beneficiaries in line with the financing agreement. National laws have been complied with and that the financial and accounting procedures approved for the Programme (i.e. PIM) were followed and used. 32. In addition to the audit of the PFSs, the auditors will include a review of SOEs used as a basis for submission of withdrawal applications to IFAD. The auditors will carry such tests and reviews as considered necessary under the circumstances in order to verify that SOEs issued during the period were prepared in conformity with the financing agreement, were eligible for financing and were in agreement with the accounting books. Annexed to the PFS, should be a schedule listing individual withdrawal applications providing details relative to amounts submitted for reimbursement and amount reimbursed and by disbursement method (SOEs, direct payment, special commitment, reimbursement to the Designated Account, reimbursement of pre-financed expenditures). Where ineligible expenditures are identified, as having been included in withdrawal applications, these should be separately noted in the audit report. Additionally the auditors should verify reimbursement of ineligible expenditures (if any) to the Designated Account. 33. The total withdrawals under the SOE procedure should be part of the overall reconciliation with IFAD records indicated. The auditors will issue a separate audit opinion on the SOEs indicating the extent to which the SOE procedure can be relied upon as basis for loan disbursements under the Programme. 34. 35. Finally the auditors will provide a management letter in which they will: Give comments and observations on the accounting records, systems and controls that were examined during the course of the audit. Identify specific deficiencies or areas of weakness in systems and controls, and make recommendations for their improvement. Check that transactions are well authorised; first through their inclusion in the AWPB that reflects IFAD’s prior authorisation, and second through approvals as required. Report on the degree of compliance of each of the financial covenants in the financing agreement and give comments, if any, on internal and external matters affecting such compliance. Communicate matters that have come to their attention during the audit which might have a significant impact on the implementation of the Programme. Give comments on previous audit recommendations that have not been satisfactorily implemented. Comment on the economy, efficiency and effectiveness in the use of resources. Bring attention to any other matter that the auditors consider pertinent, including ineligible expenditures. The management letter should also include responses from S3P and MACO’s PPD. 110 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 7 – Appendix 1: Funds Flow Chart IFAD 2 Designated a/c (US$) @ RBZ 1 3 Operations a/c @ commercial bank (ZK) 4 5 Provincial programme a/c @ commercial bank (ZK) 6 Contractors, service providers, suppliers, PPP, consultants, agri-dealers Line 1: Direct payments from IFAD to suppliers, etc for disbursements related to goods and services that have been procured internationally Line 2: Initial allocation into the Designated Account (advance) and subsequent replenishments. The Designated account will be initiated with an advance based on projected cumulative average expenditure for six months of the Programme. This advance will be replenished until towards programme closure when recovery of the advance starts to take place. Line 3: Transfer of IFAD funds from the designated account to SAPP Operational Accounts for covering eligible local costs in Kwacha. Line 4: Payments of IFAD and GRZ portion of local costs in Kwacha directly to service providers Line 5: Payments of IFAD and GRZ portion of local costs in Kwacha to the operationssub-account, managed by MACO province accountant for expenditure that will be executed by MACO. Line 6: Payments from the operations-sub-account, managed by MACO province accountant to local contractors and agro-dealers, for the District Agricultural Investment Fund. 111 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 7 – Appendix 2: Sample Terms of Reference for Auditors Introduction An audit is an ex-post review of the books of accounts, records of transactions and financial and other systems maintained by an entity, and of its financial statements. An external audit is carried out by independent professional auditors completely independent of the entity whose accounts are being audited, and aims to: Provide assurance of accountability. Give credibility to the financial statements and other management reports. Identify weaknesses in internal controls and financial systems and make recommendation thereon. This is considered an essential tool when reporting financial data; many users require financial information to be certified by a certified public accountant and/ or the State auditor, and this has become best market practice. The external auditor is guided by auditing standards, such as the International Standards of Auditing (ISA). An audit report on the financial statements, with a separate opinion on the use of the Designated Account and Statement of Expenditures, is required each year from the External Auditor, normally within 6 months of the year end. Non receipt within 180 days from the original due date may trigger suspension of further disbursements. Expected outputs Annual audits will be performed in accordance with International Standards of Auditing and will include a separate audit opinion on: the financial statements the certified statements of expenditure the operation of the Designated Account The Audit Report should include confirmation that goods, works and services have been procured in accordance with underlying loan covenants and GoM financial regulations and verification of whether the expenditures have been incurred in accordance with the loan covenants, approved AWPBs, and with due care to economy, efficiency and value for money. The auditors should also prepare a management letter, addressing the adequacy of the accounting and internal control systems, including management reply and action plan. Auditors will also make observations on other matters that may have a negative impact on project implementation. Comments should be accompanied with practical recommendations for dealing with the issues raised. Timeframe The Audit report will be submitted in original hard copy to the IFAD CPM within six months of the close of the financial year, corresponding to the audited period. IFAD will respond within one month of receipt of the audit report. Management response to the audit report and in particular to the observations raised in the management letter is required within 30 days and must be copied to the IFAD CPM. It is vital that follow up is made on audit recommendations especially in cases where the audit opinion is qualified. If the audit requirements are not complied with or are not satisfactory to IFAD, sanctions may be applied, including suspension of further disbursements. 112 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 8. Procurement Introduction 1. IFAD has recently approved a revised Project Procurement Guidelines (September 2010), and associated Procurement Handbook, which adopt a new approach to procurement that is financed by IFAD loans and grant. These guidelines state that all procurement shall be carried out in accordance with national procurement regulations, to the extent that they are consistent with IFAD Procurement Guidelines. In cases where IFAD deems that the borrower’s system for procurement is either in whole or in part not in line with the revised guidelines, then an alternative provision will apply (IFAD rules), in whole or in part. 2. The Government of Zambia passed a Public Procurement Act in 2008, which transforms the Zambia National Tender Board into the Zambia Public Procurement Agency (ZPPA), with oversight and regulatory role, while Ministries and Public Spending Agencies (MPSA) are being empowered to be fully responsible for the complete procurement cycle. (A specific provision of the 2008 Act is that all contracts need to be subject to a legal review by the Office of the Attorney General; the practicality of this measure, and the capacity of the Attorney General office to follow-up on this provision has yet to be ascertained.) 3. A transition period during which ZPPA retained its review and approval role was supposed to have phased out in December 2010. During this phase the procurement regulations should have been finalized, including revised standard bidding documents. In fact, it appears that the ZPPA has yet to be transformed into a full oversight and regulatory body. The procurement regulation and standard bidding documents based on the 2008 Act have not yet been released. Moreover MFNP has recently sent a circular requesting all MPSAs (including local governments, parastatals, etc) to send procurement requests above ZK 50 million (approximately equivalent to US$ 10,000), to ZPPA for prior review. Assessment of existing procurement procedures At country level 4. The latest international assessment of GRZ procurement procedures was conducted by OECD/DAC in 2007, and was based on the 1994 Zambia National Tenders Board Act. It followed the methodology developed for the Assessment of National procurement Systems (version4). Its main conclusions were that while the system is well documented with clear responsibilities and procedures, some major weaknesses remained, particularly regarding the fact that: a) open competitive bidding is not stated as the default procurement method, many tenders are in fact restricted or not adequately advertised; b) the complaints system works poorly and the appeals mechanism is inadequate; c) there are no standard bidding documents for the procurement of goods, services and works; d) there is a conflict of interest for ZPPA to be a regulator, and participate at the same time in the procurement decision process; e) records management is very poor; and finally f) risk assessment and management is not undertaken. 5. IFAD’s recent project experience suggests there have been improvements in a number of these areas. For example, standard bidding documents are now used; and the complaints/appeals system appears to be functioning. Under SAPP, a complaint submitted by a bidding consultancy company resulted in ZPPA requiring MACO to conduct a re-evaluation of the financial proposals submitted by the short-listed firms. A new OECD/DAC assessment would therefore seem to be needed to review the changes that have occurred since the new law was enacted and following the 24+ months transition period. 113 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 6. The World Bank has found that some provisions of the new Procurement Act are not admissible for its projects. These relate to the eligibility of foreign bidders in national bidding or consultant selection processes, as well as the obligation for foreign bidders or consultants to partner with local bidders or consultants to participate in international competitive bidding or international selection of consultants. The Bank has requested that these provision not apply to WB-financed contracts, and that this be reflected in the legal agreement, stating that foreign bidders shall be allowed to participate in national bidding processes and, for ICB, that foreign bidders shall not be obliged to partner with nationals. 7. Zambia procurement system is classified as being generally in accordance with the requirements laid out in IFAD’s revised Public Procurement Guidelines, and suitable for use for project procurement, subject to some modifications (in line with those of the World Bank). These will be specified in the Financing Agreement and the Letter to the Borrower. The Procurement and Supplies unit of MACO has been rated by ZPPA as falling in category C of procurement units (the highest rating possible). At institutional level 8. While S3P procurement will comply with the Zambia procedures issued in accordance with the Public Procurement Act, 2008, several procurement risks have been identified, and the programme will implement risk mitigation and management measures. Procurement risks and mitigation measures Risk Fungibility risk Bank reconciliation risk Limited procurement skills Procurement control Asset Management Office Attorney general review of all contracts resulting in delayed contract signature Management/Mitigation measure Only limited amounts of funds will be sent to the provincial project imprest account, according to needs, and corresponding to no more than 3 months AWPB Done by the Provincial accountant under supervision from S3P procurement and contracts specialist, who will visit once a month to reconcile bank account and financial reports The project will finance training to provincial and district financial management and procurement staff in all provinces where the project will be operating Prior review by ZPPA and IFAD. IFAD shall conduct post review of procurement documentation. All documentation relating to bid submissions will be subject to independent audit The S3P procurement specialist will ensure that an asset management registry is incorporated to the financial management software (such as Tompro) to keep track of goods procured There is not much project can do about this except bring up in regular dialogue with Ministry of Finance on a case by case basis Procurement Thresholds 9. Different procurement methods (ranging from International Competitive Bidding to Direct Contracting) will be used for the different categories of procurement depending on nature, amount and other criteria the guiding principal being economy and efficiency. These methods will be specified in the procurement plans that will be part of each year’s AWPB. An initial 18-months plan is provided in Appendix 1 to this Annex. The following threshold set up by ZPPA apply in Zambia Threshold Up to ZK 5 million (USD 1000) Above ZK 5 million to ZK 10 million (USD 2000) Above ZK 10 million up to ZK 50 million (USD 10,000) Above ZMK 50 million (USD 10,000) 1 Authorising Office Senior Officer (PACO, DACO, Deputy Director) Head of Department, PACO Controlling Officer (Permanent Secretary or S3P Programme Manager) MACO or Provincial Tender Committee1, following review by ZPPA of tender documents, and followed by ZPPA approval of tender evaluation report and award proposal MACO has a tender committee that is chaired by the PS and composed of various MACO department representatives. The Procurement and Supplies unit of MACO provides secretariat. This committee meets once a week. 114 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 10. The Zambia Procurement guidelines include the following thresholds. a) Simplified Bidding procedure, which means local shopping is allowed only up to ZMK 500 million (US$ 100,000). This means simplified solicitation document. However there is a need to send both the solicitation documents and quotations to ZPPA for clearance. b) Above ZMK 500 million (US$ 100,000) open bidding has to be followed. This means preparing a request for Proposal or Expression of interest if a prequalification procedure is being followed. Here again ZPPA has to give its approval to tender documents and shortlist before the tender is launched, and also approve the tender evaluation committee report. c) There are no thresholds to define when the open bidding should be National Competitive Bidding (NCB) or International Competitive Bidding (ICB). Following IFAD regulations, it is suggested that any procurement over US$ 150,000 should follow the ICB procedure, with Expression of Interest, short list of qualified providers, and request for tenders. 11. IFAD will define its prior review threshold, above which IFAD clearance will be needed at critical stages of the procurement process. Normally these thresholds are as follow: a) US$ 50,000 for Goods/Civil works and b) US$ 25,000 for Consulting Services. 12. The Procurement Procedures that will be followed by S3P under the various subcomponents are as follows: The PMU will do local or international shopping for contracts not exceeding US$ 10,000. The MACO Procurement and Supplies Unit will procure for contracts above US$ 10,000, following GRZ procedure, including prior review by ZPPA and prior review by IFAD in cases where it applies, and going through the MACO tender evaluation committee, whose decisions will be subject to ZPPA and IFAD final clearance, as foreseen in GRZ and IFAD procedures. 13. These thresholds will be confirmed in the Letter to the Borrower. The clearance of ToRs for all Consulting Services will require a “No Objection” from IFAD irrespective of this threshold. This is provided by the Procurement advisor based in Nairobi, as well as the CPM at HQ. If the procurement process is within this threshold, the project can carry out the process and report, IFAD will conduct ex-post verification based on a sample. Procurement Implementation Arrangements 14. S3P procurement activities will be coordinated by a procurement and contracts specialist who will be responsible for undertaking procurement activities within the S3P threshold and prepare procurement documents for processes. This specialist will have the necessary experience and sound understanding of GRZ procurement guidelines and the procedures applying to internationally financed projects. MACO Procurement and Supplies Unit through the Ministerial Tender Committee will undertake procurement activities above the limit of the S3P. 15. The S3P procurement specialist will facilitate procurement for S3P following guidelines to be specified in the S3P Project Implementation Manual (PIM), including procurement procedures for goods, works and services; community based procurement procedures, internal control, reconciliation and dispute resolution, risk management; post procurement, audit and monitoring; etc. 115 Annex 8 – Appendix 1: 24 Month Procurement Plan S.C. Activity 1. WORKS 1.2. A. Strengthening MACOcapacities in the field 2.1. B. District Agricultural Investment Fund (DAIF) 2.1. B. District Agricultural Investment Fund (DAIF) Expenditure category Expense 5. Upgrading of relevant camp facilities Housing rehabilitation 1. District-level agricultural investments 2. Community-level agricultural investments Unit unit lumpsum lumpsum Quantities subject to the tender Base Unit Cost Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total (ZMK'000) (USD) 12 12 24 48.000 10.000,00 Y1 Available financial envelop (including contingencies) (USD'000) Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total 120.0 521.0 625.0 120.3 116 * Note on process: Single (S): one single tender for all quantities indicated Multiple (M): separate tenders and contracts for each year Single extendable upon performance(E): one single tender for all quantities indicated leading to a contractual framework agreement. Firmorder (and implementation) for 2 years and extension of service upon quality and performance reviews. ** In the case of multiple tender, only indicated for the first round 240.3 521.0 625.0 Launch of tender process** Proc. Method Process* Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB S M M Start of implementation / Delivery** Quarter after project start-up 4.5 4.5 4.5 6 6 6 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Procurement Plan - 24 Months 24 Month Procurement Plan S.C. 1.2. 1.2. 1.2. 117 1.2. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. 1.3. Activity 2. EQUIPMENT A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field B. Harmonization and up-scaled application of participatory extension approaches (PEA) B. Harmonization and up-scaled application of participatory extension approaches (PEA) B. Harmonization and up-scaled application of participatory extension approaches (PEA) B. Harmonization and up-scaled application of participatory extension approaches (PEA) A. Research specialist A. Research specialist A. Research specialist A. Research specialist B. Agricultural research for development B. Agricultural research for development B. Agricultural research for development B. Agricultural research for development B. Agricultural research for development B. Agricultural research for development B. Agricultural research for development B. Agricultural research for development 1.3. B. Agricultural research for development 1.3. B. Agricultural research for development 1.3. 2.1. 2.1. 2.1. 2.1. 2.2. 2.2. 2.2. 2.3. 2.3. 2.3. 2.3. 2.3. 2.3. 2.3. 2.3. B. Agricultural research for development Local Agricultural Investment Local Agricultural Investment Local Agricultural Investment Local Agricultural Investment A. Programme planning and monitoring specialist in PPD A. Programme planning and monitoring specialist in PPD A. Programme planning and monitoring specialist in PPD A. PMU operations A. PMU operations A. PMU operations A. PMU operations A. PMU operations A. PMU operations A. PMU operations A. PMU operations Expenditure category Expense 1. Facilitators at PACO 1. Facilitators at PACO 1. Facilitators at PACO 1. Facilitators at PACO 5. Upgrading of relevant camp facilities 5. Upgrading of relevant camp facilities 4WD vehicles Computer Sets/a (Laptops) Office Electronic Equipments /b Personal offices' furniture of solar Installation panels Motorbikes Vehicle Set lumpsum set unit unit 2 2 2 2 30 1. Extension specialist 4WD vehicles Pick-up Computer Sets (Laptops) Electronic Office Equipments /i Personal offices' furniture Vehicle 1 1. Extension specialist Unit 30 24 30 24 30 24 Total Base Unit Cost (ZMK '000) (USD) Available financial envelop (including contingencies) (USD '000) Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total 2 2 2 2 120 72 200.000 13.000 700 8.000 3.600 21.600 41.666,67 2.708,33 145,83 1.666,67 750,00 4.500,00 83.3 5.4 0.3 3.3 22.5 - 1 200.000 41.666,67 41.7 22.5 108.0 22.6 108.3 22.7 108.8 Launch of tender process** Start of implementation / Delivery** Quarter after project start-up Proc. Method Process* 83.3 5.4 0.3 3.3 90.2 325.1 Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB S S S S S S -1 -1 -1 -1 2.5 2.5 3 3 3 3 4 4 41.7 Cost based NCB S 1 3 S Set 1 1 13.000 2.708,33 2.7 2.7 Cost based NCB -1 1 lumpsum 1 1 700 145,83 0.1 0.1 Cost based NCB S -1 1 set Vehicle Set lumpsum set unit unit unit unit unit unit unit unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 3 1 1 3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 3 1 1 3 3 1 8.000 200.000 13.000 700 8.000 197.000 21.600 7.200 3.840 197.000 21.600 7.200 3.840 1.666,67 41.666,67 2.708,33 145,83 1.666,67 41.041,67 4.500,00 1.500,00 800,00 41.041,67 4.500,00 1.500,00 800,00 1.7 41.7 2.7 0.1 1.7 41.0 13.5 4.5 0.8 41.0 13.5 4.5 0.8 1.7 41.7 2.7 0.1 1.7 41.0 13.5 4.5 0.8 41.0 13.5 4.5 0.8 Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB S S S S S S S S S S S S S -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 2.5 -1 -1 -1 2.5 -1 -1 1 1 1 1 1 3 4 3 3 3 4 3 3 ls 1 1 2 240.000 50.000,00 50.0 50.0 Cost based NCB M 2.5 4 ls 1 1 2 48.000 10.000,00 10.0 10.0 Cost based NCB M 2.5 4 ls Set lumpsum set lumpsum 5 1 1 1 5 20 1 1 1 36.000 13.000 700 8.000 7.500,00 2.708,33 145,83 1.666,67 37.5 2.7 0.1 1.7 112.5 2.7 0.1 1.7 229.0 Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB M S S S S 2.5 -1 -1 -1 5.5 4 1 1 1 7 set 1 1 7.000 1.458,33 1.5 1.5 Cost based NCB S -1 1 Electronic Office Equipments /a lumpsum 1 1 700 145,83 0.1 0.1 Cost based NCB S -1 1 Personal offices' furniture 1. Vehicles and office equipment 1. Vehicles and office equipment 1. Vehicles and office equipment 1. Vehicles and office equipment 1. Vehicles and office equipment 1. Vehicles and office equipment 1. Vehicles and office equipment 1. Vehicles and office equipment set Vehicle Vehicle Set Set lumpsum lumpsum set set 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 5 1 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 5 1 8.000 200.000.000 155.000.000 13.000.000 7.000.000 50.000.000 144.000.000 16.800.000 33.600.000 1.666,67 41.667 32.292 2.708 1.458 10.417 30.000 3.500 7.000 1.7 41.7 32.3 10.8 1.5 10.4 30.0 17.5 7.0 1.7 41.7 32.3 10.8 1.5 10.4 30.0 17.5 7.0 Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB Cost based NCB S S S S S S S S S -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 -1 1 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1. Extension specialist 1. Extension specialist 4WD vehicles Pick-up Computer Sets (Laptops) Electronic Office Equipments /a Personal offices' furniture 1. Adaptive research 1. Adaptive research 1. Adaptive research 1. Adaptive research 1. Adaptive research 1. Adaptive research 1. Adaptive research 1. Adaptive research 3. Identification and scaling-up of adapted postharvest technologies 3. Identification and scaling-up of adapted postharvest technologies 3. Identification and scaling-up of adapted postharvest technologies Investment manager Investment manager Investment manager 3. Group-based agricultural investments /f Mansa - Equipment: 4X4 CAR Mansa - Equipment: Motorbike Mansa - Equipment: laptops- Equipment: Mansa laser printer Kasama - Equipment: 4X4 CAR Kasama - Equipment: Motorbike Kasama - Equipment: laptops - Equipment: Kasama laser printer Tools / post-harvest equipment Mansa Tools / post-harvest equipment Kasama Post-harvest equipment for Farm training institute/FTC/DACO Computer Sets (Laptops) Office Electronic Equipments /i Personal offices' furniture Computer Sets (Desktop) 4WD vehicles Pick-up City car Sets Computer (Laptops) Sets Computer (Desktops) and other Accounting MIS software Electronic Office Equipments /a Personal offices' furniture room's and airfurniture Meeting and air condition 10 75.0 229.0 * Note on process: Single (S): one single tender for all quantities indicated Multiple (M): separate tenders and contracts for each year Single extendable upon performance(E): one single tender for all quantities indicated leading to a contractual framework agreement. Firm order (and implementation) for 2 years and extension of service upon quality and performance reviews. ** In the case of multiple tender, only indicated for the first round Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 1.2. 1.2. 1.2. 1.2. 1.2. 1.2. Quantities subject to the tender Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Activity S.C. Expenditure category Expense Unit Y1 Quantities subject to the tender Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Base Unit Cost (ZMK '000) (USD) Y1 Available financial envelop (including contingencies) (USD '000) Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Proc. Method Process* Launch of tender process** Start of implementation / Delivery** Quarter after project start-up 3. SERVICES 1.1. A. Service provider lumpsum 1. Facilitators at PACO Provincial facilitator 1.2. A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field 3. Capacity building in proc. & fin. mgt. 3. Capacity building in procurement and financial management /e 1. Extension specialist 1.2. A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field B. Harmonization and up-scaled application of 1.2. participatory extension approaches (PEA) C. Establish partnerships and strengthen existing 1.2. organizations providing advisory services C. Establish partnerships and strengthen existing 1.2. organizations providing advisory services 1.3. A. Research specialist pers.-month 12 24 30 36 Technical support pers.day 50 50 25 25 Technical support /g pers.-day 50 50 25 Extension specialist pers.-month 12 12 12 1. Piloting of partnerships for advisory services lumpsum 2. Studies and reviews lumpsum Research specialist 12 36 36 36 25 208.3 416.7 626.6 524.7 421.9 212.0 106.5 2 516.7 109.4 109.9 110.5 636.7 210 14.400 3.000,00 36.0 72.0 90.2 108.8 150 3000 625 31.0 31.0 16.0 16.0 150 3.000 625,00 31.3 31.3 15.7 48 17.520 3.650,00 43.8 43.9 44.1 400.0 401.0 403.0 43.8 - pm 1 1 1 pm 1 1 1 ls 0.5 1 1 1 1 pm 2 2 2 2 pm 2 2 2 pm 7 7 7 43.8 407.0 409.0 2 425.0 101.0 2.1. A. Preparation, facilitation, training, M&E 2. Preparation and M&E by District staff lumpsum 31.3 61.6 61.9 62.2 31.8 248.8 2.1. A. Preparation, facilitation, training, M&E 2. Engineering for preparation and supervision lumpsum 104.0 209.0 210.0 211.0 106.0 840.0 lumpsum 245.8 246.4 247.7 253.1 127.2 1 120.3 43.9 118 3. Training and facilitation 2.1. A. Preparation, facilitation, training, M&E A. Programme planning and monitoring specialist in PPMS in PPD 2.2. PPD pers.-month 12 12 2.2. B. Policy framework support 1. International technical assistance person-day 20 2.2. B. Policy framework support 2. Studies study 2.3. A. PMU operations 2. Personnel /b 2.3. A. PMU operations 2. Personnel /b 2.3. A. PMU operations 2. Personnel /b Programme manager Finances and administration manager Procurement and contracts specialist /c 2.3. A. PMU operations 2. Personnel /b 2.3. A. PMU operations 2. Personnel /b 2.3. A. PMU operations 2. Personnel /b 1. Project Preparation, Reporting, Monitoring and Evaluation 1. Project Preparation, Reporting, Monitoring and Evaluation 1. Project Preparation, Reporting, Monitoring and Evaluation 1. Project Preparation, Reporting, Monitoring and Evaluation 1. Project Preparation, Reporting, Monitoring and Evaluation 1. Project Preparation, Reporting, Monitoring and Evaluation 2.3. B. Surveys, Studies and Reports 2.3. B. Surveys, Studies and Reports 2.3. B. Surveys, Studies and Reports 2.3. B. Surveys, Studies and Reports 2.3. B. Surveys, Studies and Reports 2.3. B. Surveys, Studies and Reports 12 12 405.0 1. District Ag. Investment Manager 1.3. B. Agricultural research for development 12 175.6 2.1. A. Preparation, facilitation, training, M&E 1.3. B. Agricultural research for development 12 94.1 1.3. B. Agricultural research for development 1.3. B. Agricultural research for development 12 100.0 15.8 Mansa - Training and technical support: 1. Adaptive research Cassava -: Training TS Kasama and technical support: Beans 1. Adaptive research : TS international Partnership CA 2. Development of CA practices adapted to high Research contracts rainfall based farming systems managed by nat. or TA - International 2. Development of CA practices adapted to high technical assistance in rainfall based farming systems CA - Support from TA 2. Development of CA practices adapted to high agroforestry institute rainfall based farming systems ICRAF 1.3. B. Agricultural research for development pers.-month 100.0 94.0 48 17.520 3.650,00 43.8 0.5 4 125.000 26.041,67 26.0 26.1 26.4 13.3 91.8 0.5 4 125.000 26.041,67 26.0 26.1 26.4 13.3 91.8 1 1 7 208 333 104.0 208.0 209.0 210.0 211.0 212.0 213.0 1 367.0 2 2 1 13 120.000 25.000,00 50.0 50.0 50.1 50.4 50.6 50.9 25.6 327.6 2 2 2 1 13 120.000 25.000,00 50.0 50.0 50.1 50.4 50.6 50.9 25.6 327.6 7 7 7 7 49 17.520.000 3 650 43.8 43.8 43.9 44.1 44.3 44.6 44.8 309.4 - - - - 1 000 000 43.9 44.1 175.6 36 17.520 3.650,00 43.8 43.8 131.5 15 35 4.800 1.000,00 20.0 15.0 35.0 2 2 4 100.000 20.833,33 41.7 41.7 83.3 Pers.months 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 84 26.160.000 5.450 65.4 65.4 65.6 65.9 66.2 66.6 66.9 461.9 Pers.months 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 84 20.160.000 4.200 50.4 50.4 50.5 50.8 51.0 51.3 51.5 356.0 Pers.months 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 84 17.520.000 3.650 43.8 43.8 43.9 44.1 44.3 44.6 44.8 309.4 M&E specialist Pers.months 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 84 17.520.000 3.650 43.8 43.8 43.9 44.1 44.3 44.6 44.8 309.4 Secretary Driver / messenger / office assistant Preparation of gender strategy Preparation of communication strategy International TA for PM&E development Baseline and Impact Evaluation /e Pers.months 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 84 7.200.000 1.500 18.0 18.0 18.0 18.1 18.2 18.3 18.4 127.1 Pers.months 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 84 4.800.000 1.000 12.0 12.0 12.0 12.1 12.2 12.2 12.3 84.8 Ls - 52.1 52.1 Ls - 52.1 52.1 Days 30 - 30 4.800.000 1.000 30.0 30.0 Study 1 - 1 720.000.000 150.000 150.0 150.0 Thematic Studies lumpsum - 1 1 96.000.000 20.000 20.0 External Audits /f audit - 1 7 72.000.000 15.000 15.0 1 1 1 1 2 * Note on process: Single (S): one single tender for all quantities indicated Multiple (M): separate tenders and contracts for each year Single extendable upon performance(E): one single tender for all quantities indicated leading to a contractual framework agreement. Firm order (and implementation) for 2 years and extension of service upon quality and performance reviews. ** In the case of multiple tender, only indicated for the first round 20.0 15.0 15.1 15.2 15.3 30.7 106.3 Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender Quality and Costs Based Tender E 2.5 4 E 1 3 E 2 3 E 4 6 E -1 1 E 3.5 5 M 3 4 E -0.5 1 E 2.5 4 E 2.5 4 E 2.5 4 E 2.5 4 E 2.5 4 E -1 1 E 3.5 5 E 4.5 6 E 3.5 5 E -1 1 S 2.5 4 M 2.5 4 E -1 1 E -1 1 E -1 1 E -1 1 E -1 1 E -1 1 S 1.5 3 S 1.5 3 S 1.5 3 S 1.5 3 S 4.5 6 E 3.5 5 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 1.2. A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field - Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 9. Programme Cost and Financing MAIN ASSUMPTIONS 1. Inflation. For the entire duration of the programme, the local inflation has been assumed at 8 per cent per annum. International inflation has been assumed at 0 per cent until programme start and for the two initial project years, then 0.5 per cent per annum for the five following years. 2. Exchange rate. The competitiveness of Zambian agriculture for import substitution or export is quite dependent on the value of the Kwacha. The currency issue has strongly impacted on the profitability of cash crops production and determined their level of production. The value of the Kwacha evolves very much in parallel with the prices of copper on the international market. Over the last years, the evolution of the Kwacha has been rather erratic (Figure 1). 3. The initial exchange rate for the analysis has been set at Zambian Kwacha (K) 4,800 to US$ 1.00, the rate prevailing in April 2011. The conversions from current dollar values into K are calculated using the constant purchasing power (CPP) exchange rate (K/US$) as calculated by the Costab program. Both foreign and local inflation rates are compounded at mid-year. Figure 1: Exchange rate USD/K (estimate for 2010) Exchange rate USD/K 0.00045 0.0004 0.00035 0.0003 K / 0.00025 D S 0.0002 U 0.00015 0.0001 0.00005 0 9 9 9 1 0 0 0 2 1 0 0 2 2 0 0 2 3 0 0 2 4 0 0 2 5 0 0 2 6 0 0 2 7 0 0 2 8 0 0 2 9 0 0 2 0 1 0 2 Table 1: Assumptions regarding inflation and exchange rate Period Project preparation (April 2011) Foreign exchange Inflation (%) Local Currency Inflation (%) Exchange rate ZK/US$ b/ 4,800 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 - - - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 8.2 8.0 8.0 8.0 8.0 8.0 8.0 5,401 5,833 6,284 6,753 7,257 7,799 8,381 a/ between project costs estimates during pre-appraisal (January 2011) and likely project start date (January 2012). b/ using Constant purchasing parity rate option. 4. Taxes and duties have been estimated using the Zambia Revenue Authority data. All items imported for Programme purposes attract import duties, while domestically purchased items are subject to national and local taxes of different types. VAT has been applied on all expenditure accounts. Local staff are held responsible for the payment of their national tax liabilities on salaries and allowances paid from the loan. 5. Contingencies. Physical contingencies - accounting for changes in quantities and in unit prices that are not related to monetary fluctuation - have been set at zero percent considering that the quantities and unit costs in the budget are meant to calculate envelopes by activity, that will be clarified and detailed during project implementation, rather than targets to be achieved. The way the budget was established contains in itself sufficient flexibility to avoid using additional physical contingencies. Price contingencies, as calculated by Costab, are 1 per cent of base costs in US$ and to 43 per cent of base costs in ZK thanks to the CPP assumption (see para. 4). 119 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 2: Assumptions for the disbursement and expenditure accounts Disbursement category Expenditure category Civil works Equipment % of % foreign taxes exchange Investment costs Civil works 10% 18% Vehicles Vehicle 4x4 SW Vehicle 4x4 pick up Sedan cars Motorbikes 41% 29% 37% 23% 49% 59% 52% 64% Equipment Agricultural inputs Agricultural and processing machinery and tools Construction material Computer equipment Communication equipment Photocopier, printer Other imported office equipment Office furniture 14% 14% 23% 17% 23% 14% 16% 12% 72% 72% 64% 69% 64% 72% 64% 32% 5% 5% Consulting services National consultancies International consultancies 15% 0% 10% 90% Operating costs PMU/PCU salaries Allowances for field visits Vehicles O&M Office equipment O&M 15% 0% 16% 16% 0% 0% 38% 32% Capacity building and TA Training and workshops Project operating costs PROGRAMME COSTS 6. Total Programme Costs: The total investment and incremental recurrent Programme costs, including price contingencies, are estimated at US$ 39.9 million (ZK 271 billion). The foreign exchange component is estimated at US$ 6.9 million. Duties and taxes make up approximately US$ 6.3 million. Programme costs are summarised in Tables 3 and 4 (detailed costs are included in the Working Paper). 7. Costs by Component: In terms of expenditure by sub-component (SC), the major investment are for 1.2 - Extension, with 30 per cent of total funds, 1.3 – Research, with 21 per cent, and 2.1 - District Agricultural Investment funds, with 33 per cent of total costs: taken together, they represent 84 per cent of the total budget. The Programme management and M&E costs are estimated at 9 per cent of total costs. 8. Costs by disbursement account: In terms of cost by disbursement account (see Table 5), Services by service providers (technical assistance, MACO staff, etc.) represent 37 per cent of the budget. Civil works amounts to an estimated 25 per cent, Equipment and material to some 19 per cent, and training and studies to some 19 per cent of the total budget. Most of the civil works will be provided through the Local Agricultural Investments mechanisms (SC.2.1.). 120 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 3: Total project cost by component in US$ ('000 USD) Local (Excl. Taxes) Total Amount For. Exch. % Duties & Taxes A. S ustainable S mallholder Productivity Growth Strengthening member-based farmers organisations and their federations Pluralistic participatory extension services Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) Subtotal Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth 2,517 11,809 8,540 22,866 6 30 21 57 126 1,214 2,282 3,622 2,265 8,953 4,686 15,904 126 1,642 1,572 3,340 B. Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth Local Agricultural Investments Support to the Policy and Legal Framework Programme M anagement, M onitoring and Evaluation Subtotal Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth 13,082 521 3,388 16,990 33 1 9 43 2,779 112 311 3,202 7,912 330 2,561 10,803 2,391 79 516 2,985 Total PROJECT COS TS 39,856 100 6,824 26,706 6,326 Table 4: Project costs by component in ZK and US$ (ZMK Million) % % Total For. Base Local Foreign Total Exch. Costs (US D '000) Local Foreign Total A. S ustainable S mallholder Productivity Growth Strengthening member-based farmers organisations and their federations Pluralistic participatory extension services Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) Subtotal Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth 11,400 50,375 29,762 91,537 600 12,000 5,783 56,158 10,870 40,632 17,253 108,790 5 10 27 16 6 30 21 57 2,375 10,495 6,200 19,070 125 2,500 1,205 11,700 2,265 8,465 3,594 22,665 5 10 27 16 6 30 21 57 B. Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth Local Agricultural Investments Support to the Policy and Legal Framework Programme M anagement, M onitoring and Evaluation Subtotal Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth 49,067 1,956 14,641 65,664 13,236 532 1,484 15,253 62,303 2,488 16,125 80,917 21 21 9 19 33 1 8 43 10,222 408 3,050 13,680 2,758 12,980 111 518 309 3,359 3,178 16,858 21 21 9 19 33 1 8 43 % % Total For. Base Exch. Costs Total BAS ELINE COS TS Physical Contingencies Price Contingencies 157,201 68,152 32,506 189,707 13,244 81,396 17 16 100 43 32,750 281 6,772 39,522 52 333 17 16 100 1 Total PROJECT COS TS 225,353 45,750 271,103 17 143 33,032 6,824 39,856 17 101 Table 5: Project costs by disbursement category (USD '000) 1. Equipment and materials 2. Civil works 3. Services: TA and studies 4. Trainings and Workshops Total Total Amount % 7,747 9,658 14,826 7,625 39,856 19 24 37 19 100 For. Exch. 2,826 1,738 1,879 381 6,824 121 Local (Excl. Taxes) 3,634 6,471 9,739 6,862 26,706 Duties & Taxes 1,287 1,449 3,208 381 6,326 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 9. Disbursement by year: The annual disbursement by component and by year is presented in Table 6. The disbursements are quite equally split between the seven years of implementation, with slightly higher disbursement rates over years 2 to 6. Table 6: Disbursement by component and by year (USD '000) A. Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth Strengthening member-based farmers organisations and their federations Pluralistic participatory extension services Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) Subtotal Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth Y2 208 757 1,045 2,011 417 1,782 1,099 3,298 627 1,933 1,323 3,883 525 2,126 1,339 3,990 422 1,856 1,453 3,731 212 1,813 1,414 3,440 107 2,517 1,540 11,809 866 8,540 2,513 22,866 68 132 765 965 1,824 124 379 2,328 3,091 124 431 3,646 3,107 36 448 3,591 3,174 36 445 3,655 1,742 58 441 2,240 75 13,082 11 521 480 3,388 566 16,990 2,976 7% 7% 5,625 14% 22% 7,529 19% 40% 7,581 19% 59% 7,386 19% 78% 5,679 14% 92% 3,078 39,856 8% 100% 100% B. Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth Local Agricultural Investments Support to the Policy and Legal Framework Programme M anagement, M onitoring and Evaluation Subtotal Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth Total PROJECT COSTS % % cumulated Totals Including Contingencies Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y1 Y7 Total FINANCING 10. Tables 7 and 8 provide a summary of the proposed financing arrangement (see Working Paper for detailed financing arrangement for each budget items). 11. IFAD contribution: The proposed IFAD loan amounts to US$ 24.8 million, representing 63 per cent of the total estimated Programme costs. Finland will contribute through a grant of US$ 7.1 million, representing nearly 17 per cent of the total budget. These funds will be disbursed on a “pari passu” principle in a fixed ratio of approximately 78:22, and they are, therefore, presented in the tables under one and the same column. 12. The Programme beneficiaries will contribute an estimated US$ 1.5 million, 4 per cent of the total programme budget. Their participation is expected as counterpart contribution under the Local Agricultural Investments sub-component; it will be made both in-cash and in-kind; and it will range, depending on the type of investment, from 25 to 50 per cent of its total cost. 13. The districts will contribute under the Local Agricultural Investment component, by participating in the financing of the District-level agricultural investments. The participation of the districts in the cost of these will be at least 10 per cent of total cost of these investments, which corresponds to about US$ 0.4 million or about 1 per cent of the budget. It will be provided principally in-kind, in the form of the staff time spent in preparing the proposals and supervising construction. 14. The Government will finance all duties and taxes (except for those on salaries). Its share of the budget amounts to an equivalent of US$ 6.1 million, representing 15 per cent of the total programme budget. Table 7: Project Financing Plan by Disbursement Account (USD '000) 1. Equipment and materials 2. Civil works 3. Services: TA and studies 4. Trainings and Workshops Total PROJECT COSTS GRZ Amount % 1,287 1,449 2,961 381 6,078 17 15 20 5 15 Districts Amount % 415 415 4 - 122 1 IFAD / Finland Amount % 5,963 6,831 11,865 7,244 31,902 77 71 80 95 80 Beneficiaries Amount % 497 964 1,460 6 10 4 Total Amount % 7,747 19 9,658 24 14,826 37 7,625 19 39,856 100 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 8: Project Financing Plan by component and sub-component (USD '000) GRZ Amount % A. Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth Strengthening member-based farmers organisations and their federations Pluralistic participatory extension services Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) Subtotal Sustainable Smallholder Productivity Growth 126 5 1,642 14 1,572 18 3,340 15 B. Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth Local Agricultural Investments Support to the Policy and Legal Framework Programme M anagement, M onitoring and Evaluation Subtotal Enabling Environment for Productivity Growth 2,391 18 79 15 269 8 2,738 16 Total PROJECT COSTS 6,078 15 Districts Amount % - - IFAD / Finland Amount % Beneficiaries Amount % 2,391 10,167 6,968 19,525 95 86 82 85 - 415 3 - - 415 2 8,816 442 3,119 12,376 67 85 92 73 415 31,902 80 1 - 2,517 11,809 8,540 22,866 6 30 21 57 1,460 11 - - 1,460 9 13,082 521 3,388 16,990 33 1 9 43 1,460 39,856 100 4 PROCUREMENT 15. Table 9 presents the global procurement plan by expenditure account. Table 9: Procurement plan by expenditure account (USD '000) A. Civil works B. Vehicles C. Computer D. Imported furniture and equipment E. Local equipment and small expenses F. International Consultants G. PM U Team H. National Consultants I. Training Related Procurements J. Procurements Using M atching Grants K. Operating Costs Related procurements Total National Consulting Competitive Services: Bidding QCBS 9,658 886 83 1,593 12,219 123 980 3,077 7,715 2,517 14,289 Direct Purchase/ Negotiations/ Shopping Single Tender 1,895 2,162 2,554 1,812 8,423 1,765 177 429 2,554 4,925 Total Amount % Total 9,658 886 83 1,593 3,661 1,156 3,077 10,306 7,625 1,812 39,856 Detailed Cost Tables Table 1.1. Strengthening member-based farmers organisations and their federations Detailed Costs I. Investment Costs A. Service provider Total lumpsum Y1 Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Disb. Acct. 208 208 417 417 2 517 2 517 TRAININGSDA 627 627 525 525 422 422 212 212 107 107 124 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Unit Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Table 1.2. Pluralistic participatory extension services Detailed Costs Quantities Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Unit Cost (ZMK '000) (USD) Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 109 - 109 - 110 85 6 110 - - Total Disb. Acct. A. Strengthening MACO capacities in the field 1. Facilitators at PACO Provincial facilitator 4WD vehicles /a Computer Sets (Laptops) Electronic Office Equipments /b Personal offices' furniture 125 Vehicle Operation and Maintenance Miscellaneous office expenditure DSA Domestic air tickets Subtotal Facilitators at PACO 2. Regular planning, review and coordination meetings Quarterly provincial meetings /c Quarterly District meetings /d Subtotal Regular planning, review and coordination meetings 3. Capacity building in procurement and financial management /e Trainings /f Technical support /g Travel costs for Provincial accountants /h Subtotal Capacity building in procurement and financial management 4. Information / knowledge sharing /i 5. Upgrading of relevant camp facilities Housing rehabilitation Installation of solar panels Motorbikes Subtotal Upgrading of relevant camp facilities Subtotal Strengthening MACO capacities in the field pers.-month Vehicle Set 12 2 2 24 - 30 1 1 36 - 36 - 36 2 2 36 - lumpsum 2 set 2 ls/car/year ls/office/year DSA travel 210 5 5 14.400 3.000,00 200.000 41.666,67 13.000 2.708,33 36 83 5 - 72 90 42 3 - 1 - 2 - - 5 700 - 1. - - - - 3. 8.000 145,83 0 - 0 - 1.666,67 3 - 2 - 1 2 2.5 3 3 3 3 17.5 50.000 10.416,67 10 21 26 31 32 32 1 60 4 2 120 8 3 150 10 3 180 12 3 180 12 3 180 12 3 90 12 18 960 70 18.000 500 2.400 3.750,00 104,17 500,00 4 6 2 151 8 13 4 117 9 16 5 193 11 19 6 177 11 19 6 178 11 19 6 269 0 - 637 210 14 SERVICES EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT - 1 EQUIPMENT - 5 EQUIPMENT 32 184 EQUIPMENT 12 10 6 170 66 101 35 1 253 EQUIPMENT SERVICES SERVICES Meeting 4 8 10 12 12 12 12 70 12.000 2.500,00 10 20 25 30 30 31 31 177 TRAININGSDA Meeting 16 48 80 96 96 96 96 528 12.000 2.500,00 40 50 120 140 201 226 242 272 243 273 244 275 245 276 1 335 1 512 TRAININGSDA session pers.-day 1 50 1 50 1 25 - 3 150 50.000 10.416,67 3.000 625,00 10 31 10 31 10 16 - - - - 31 94 TRAININGSDA SERVICES - 2 2 15 56 15 41 22 38 22 22 22 22 118 243 EQUIPMENT 42 30 40 40 60 61 61 - 292 TRAININGSDA 120 120 121 122 - - 483 CIVIL_WORKS_DA 23 108 251 604 23 108 251 750 23 109 252 799 122 656 627 468 ls/yr 25 3 0 0 3 0 3 3 16 35.000 7.291,67 - lumpsum unit unit unit - 12 12 12 12 30 24 30 24 30 24 0 - 30 0 - - 48 - 120 72 0 - 48.000 10.000,00 - 3.600 21.600 - 750,00 4.500,00 23 23 295 16 22 22 90 325 898 4 198 EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Unit Unit Cost Quantities Unit Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Unit Cost Unit Cost (ZMK '000) (USD) Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Disb. Acct. B. Harmonization and up-scaled application of participatory extension approaches (PEA) 1. Extension specialist Extension specialist 4WD vehicles Pick-up Computer Sets (Laptops) Electronic Office Equipments /j Vehicle Operation and Maintenance 12 1 1 12 - 12 - 12 - - - - 48 1 1 lumpsum 1 - - - - - - 1 700 set 1 - - - - - - 1 8.000 lumpsum 50.000 10.416,67 1 1 1 1 - - - 4 Miscellaneous office expenditure Rent DSA Domestic air tickets Subtotal Extension specialist year month DSA travel 1 12 80 4 1 12 80 4 1 12 80 4 1 12 80 4 - - - 2. Master Training in the provinces /k training 1 1 1 3. Training of trainers at District level /l training 126 4. FFS-type activities at camp level 5. Refresher training sessions of field staff /m 6. Operating costs for CEOs and DACOs /n CEOs DACOs Subtotal Operating costs for CEOs and DACOs FFS 0 0 3. Stakeholder workshops Subtotal Establish partnerships and strengthen existing organizations providing advisory services - - - - - - 3 0 0 0 3 3 3 3 2 0 14 90 130 225 295 370 390 1500 44 42 3 - - - - - - 176 42 3 SERVICES EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT 145,83 0 - - - - - - 0 EQUIPMENT 1.666,67 2 - - - - - - 2 EQUIPMENT lumpsum lumpsum 44 lumpsum lumpsum lumpsum Total _________________________________ \a replacement of car upon justification \b printer, phone \c 20 pers., 2 days. \d 10 pers., 2 days \e Trainings and TA. Focused on accountants based in PACOs and DACOs. \f max. 4 days, 14 persons. \g by accounting company. framework contract. \h covers DSAs, petrol etc. for \i participation in knowledge events and exchange visits \j printer, phone \k each training concerns 20 trainees \l for 15 CEOs/ lead farmers \m technical & methodological. subjects acc. to priorities identified in the PACO and DACO quarterly meetings. \n includes fuel, repairs for vehicles/motorbikes, partial or full DSAs, other miscellaneous (phone costs) 44 10 10 10 10 - - - 42 EQUIPMENT 4 5 8 2 119 4 5 8 2 73 4 5 8 2 73 4 5 8 2 74 - - - 15 20 33 8 340 EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT SERVICES SERVICES 384.000 80.000,00 80 80 80 - - - - 240 TRAININGSDA - 195 195 196 197 132 - 917 TRAININGSDA - 54 78 136 179 226 239 913 TRAININGSDA TRAININGSDA 312.000 65.000,00 2.880 600,00 65 120 150 180 180 180 180 1 055 8 16 24 24 24 24 24 144 44 3.750,00 416,67 104,17 500,00 18.000 2.000 500 2.400 lumpsum Subtotal Harmonization and up-scaled application of participatory extension approaches (PEA) C. Establish partnerships and strengthen existing organizations 1. Piloting of partnerships for advisory services 2. Studies and reviews - 4 48 320 16 17.520 3.650,00 200.000 41.666,67 13.000 2.708,33 4.800 28.800 1.000,00 6.000,00 60 60 91 91 92 92 486 65 48 113 120 96 216 150 144 295 181 145 326 182 146 328 183 147 330 184 147 331 1 066 873 1 939 312 678 782 823 796 779 663 4 835 100 400 100 401 - 403 101 405 - 407 - 409 - 2 425 301 - - - - - - 150 50 500 401 504 405 407 409 2 776 50 757 1 782 1 933 2 126 1 856 1 813 1 540 11 809 SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES TRAININGSDA Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Personal offices' furniture pers.-month Vehicle Set Table 1.3. Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) Detailed Costs Unit Y2 Quantities Y4 Y5 Y3 pers.-month Vehicle Set lumpsum set lumpsum year month DSA travel 12 1 1 1 1 1 1 12 80 4 12 1 1 12 80 4 12 1 1 12 80 4 12 1 1 12 80 4 unit ls unit ls unit unit 1 1 3 3 3 1 1 3 - 1 3 - 1 3 - Y6 Y7 0 0 Unit Cost (ZMK '000) Total Unit Cost (USD) Y1 - 48 1 1 1 1 4 4 48 320 16 17.520 3.650,00 200.000 41.666,67 13.000 2.708,33 700 145,83 8.000 1.666,67 50.000 10.416,67 18.000 3.750,00 2.000 416,67 500 104,17 2.400 500,00 44 42 3 0 2 10 4 5 8 2 119 1 3 - 1 7 3 21 6 2 197.000 41.041,67 70.000 14.583,33 21.600 4.500,00 6.500 1.354,17 7.200 1.500,00 3.840 800,00 41 15 14 4 5 1 0 Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y2 44 - 44 - 10 4 5 8 2 73 44 - 10 4 5 8 2 73 10 4 5 8 2 74 - - Y7 Total - Disb. Acct. 176 42 3 0 2 42 15 20 33 8 340 SERVICES EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT SERVICES SERVICES 41 103 14 29 9 2 EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT B. Agricultural research for development 127 1. Adaptive research Mansa - Equipment: 4X4 CAR Mansa - Operational costs for car Mansa - Equipment: Motorbike Mansa - Operational costs for motorbikes Mansa - Equipment: laptops Mansa - Equipment: laser printer 1 3 1 1 3 3 - - 15 - 15 4 - 15 4 - 15 4 - 15 4 4 5 1 15 - - 4 - Mansa - Research costs: Field experimental support the ZARI BEANS programme ls 10 10 15 20 26 27 27 135 EQUIPMENT Mansa - Research costs: Field experimental support the ZARI CASSAVA programme ls 15 20 25 40 53 53 53 259 EQUIPMENT Mansa - Research costs: Field experimental support RICE AND GN Mansa - Research costs: On farm testing (varieties and cropping practices for beans and cassava) /b ls 12 20 30 42 42 42 43 231 EQUIPMENT on-farm trial - - - - - - - - Mansa - Training and technical support: Cassava : participation at intl. WS, prog. visits /c visit 1 1 1 1 1 1 - 6 Mansa - Training and technical support: Cassava : TS international institutes (IITA etc) /d Mansa - Operational costs for Cassava progr. communication / office Kasama - Equipment: 4X4 CAR Kasama - Operational costs for car Kasama - Equipment: Motorbike Kasama - Operational costs for motorbikes Kasama - Equipment: laptops Kasama - Equipment: laser printer pm ls unit ls unit ls unit unit 1 - 1 - 1 - 0.5 1 1 3 3 3 1 1 3 - 1 3 - 1 3 - 1 3 1 1 3 3 - 1 3 - 25.000 - 5.208,33 5 3.5 125.000 26.041,67 1 7 3 21 6 2 197.000 41.041,67 70.000 14.583,33 21.600 4.500,00 6.500 1.354,17 7.200 1.500,00 3.840 800,00 26 6 41 15 14 4 5 1 5 - 26 6 6 - 5 15 - 15 4 - 26 6 6 15 5 - 4 5 - 15 4 15 - 4 5 1 13 6 6 15 - - - 4 5 - 4 - EQUIPMENT 31 TRAININGSDA 92 44 41 103 14 29 9 2 SERVICES EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT Kasama - Research costs: Field experimental support the ZARI BEANS programme ls 10 10 15 20 26 27 27 135 EQUIPMENT Kasama - Research costs: Field experimental support the ZARI CASSAVA programme ls 15 20 25 40 53 53 53 259 EQUIPMENT Kasama - Research costs: Field experimental support RICE AND GN Kasama - Research costs: On farm testing (varieties and cropping practices for beans and cassava) /e ls 12 20 30 42 42 42 43 231 EQUIPMENT - EQUIPMENT Kasama - Training and technical support: Beans : participation at intl. WS, prog. visits /f Kasama - Training and technical support: Beans : TS international institutes (CIAT etc) /g Kasama - Operational costs for Beans progr. - comm. and office Subtotal Adaptive research on-farm trial - - - - - - - - visit 1 1 1 1 1 1 - 6 pm ls 1 - 1 - 1 - 0.5 3.5 25.000 - 5.208,33 5 125.000 26.041,67 26 4 303 - - 5 5 4 158 26 4 250 - - - 5 5 4 263 26 4 355 - 5 4 312 13 4 320 31 92 26 1 962 TRAININGSDA SERVICES EQUIPMENT Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report A. Research specialist Research specialist 4WD vehicles Pick-up Computer Sets (Laptops) Electronic Office Equipments /a Personal offices' furniture Vehicle Operation and Maintenance Miscellaneous office expenditure Rent DSA Domestic air tickets Subtotal Research specialist Y1 2. Development of CA practices adapted to high rainfall based farming systems Partnership CA Research contracts m anaged by nat. or regio. research partners /h Managem ent fees /i TA - International technical assistance in CA TA - Support from agroforestry institute ICRAF Y1 ls ls pm pm 0.5 1 1 1 1 1 1 6.5 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 13 13 - - - trial Y2 Quantities Y4 Y5 Unit Y3 Y6 Y7 Total Unit Cost (ZMK '000) Unit Cost (USD) 1.000.000 208.333,33 120.000 25.000,00 120.000 25.000,00 Y1 Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y2 Y7 Total 104 17 50 50 208 22 50 50 209 27 50 50 210 31 50 50 211 32 51 51 212 32 51 51 213 21 26 26 - - - - - - - Disb. Acct. 1 367 182 328 328 SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES On farm trial (collaboration GARI and other research centre) /j On-farm research activities (collaborat. ZARI - other research centre) - Vouchers for CA scaling up - - - - - - EQUIPMENT beneficiary 200 500 750 1 000 1 000 1 000 500 4 950 250 52,08 10 26 39 52 53 53 27 260 EQUIPMENT On-farm research activities (collaborat ZARI - other research centre) - Laboratory costs beneficiary 200 500 750 1 000 1 000 1 000 500 4 950 250 52,08 10 26 39 52 53 53 27 260 EQUIPMENT week 4 4 4 4 4 4 - 24 25.000 5.208,33 21 21 21 21 21 21 126 TRAININGSDA Biannual CA concertation m eeting /l session 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 14 37.500 7.812,50 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 110 TRAININGSDA unit lum psum 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 28 24.000 5.000,00 20 4 379 20 4 519 20 4 551 20 4 585 20 4 588 20 4 591 20 4 457 141 26 3 670 TRAININGSDA EQUIPMENT ls ls ls ls pm ls ls 1 1 1 1 1 5 0 1 0 1 1 10 0 1 1 1 1 1 5 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 0 1 0 1 1 0 7 2 7 2 7 20 0 144.000 240.000 12.500 48.000 120.000 36.000 30.000,00 50.000,00 2.604,17 10.000,00 25.000,00 7.500,00 30 50 3 10 25 38 30 31 25 75 30 50 3 10 25 38 155 133 155 SERVICES EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT SERVICES EQUIPMENT SERVICES 10 1 8 3 3 5 29 866 10 1 8 3 3 5 29 839 26 Scientific exchange visits and participation at regional CA conferences Office and com m unication /m Subtotal Developm ent of CA practices adapted to high rainfall based farm ing system s 128 3. Identification and scaling-up of adapted post-harvest technologies Post-harvest research program m e Mansa Tools / post-harvest equipm ent Mansa Office and com m unication (post harvest unit Mansa) Tools / post-harvest equipm ent Kasam a TA IITA Post-harvest equipm ent for Farm training institute/FTC/DACO (20) Technical support to on-farm trials (equipm ent provided under m atching grant) /n Subtotal Identification and scaling-up of adapted post-harvest technologies 4. Basic/foundation seed production Cassava base m aterial m ultiplication Beans breeder seed m ultiplication Beans basic seed m ultiplication Seed quality control SCCI Office and com m unication SCCI ZARI farm m anagem ent Subtotal Basic/foundation seed production Subtotal Agricultural research for developm ent ha ha ha ha ls ls 10 0 5 10 1. 1 Cassava - Bloc (with specialised FG) /o ha 50 Cassava - Cam p (with FG) /p ha - Beans (and others) - Bloc (with specialised FG) /q ha 20 Beans (and others) - Cam p (with FG) /r ha - 10 0 5 10 1. 1 10 0 5 10 1. 1 10 0 5 10 1. 1 10 0 5 10 1. 1 10 0 5 10 1. 1 10 0 5 10 1. 1 70 2 35 70 7. 7 5.000 10.000 7.500 1.250 12.500 25.000 1.041,67 2.083,33 1.562,50 260,42 2.604,17 5.208,33 70 85 100 100 100 150 200 300 500 500 - 505 2.500 520,83 - 1 650 1.500 312,50 30 40 40 40 40 - 210 3.750 781,25 50 100 150 25 50 50 95 540 890 50 890 200 200 - 700 2.500 520,83 50 890 50 890 - 275 4 195 2.500 250 520,83 52,08 58 58 59 59 212 100 18 20 177 150 677 10 1 8 3 3 5 29 987 10 1 8 3 3 5 29 935 11 1 8 3 3 5 30 1 031 11 1 8 3 3 5 30 991 11 1 8 3 3 5 30 866 74 4 55 18 18 37 206 6 515 EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT 36 44 52 53 53 - 265 EQUIPMENT 47 63 94 158 159 - 521 EQUIPMENT 23 31 31 32 32 - 165 EQUIPMENT 3 - 30 - 30 - 3 - 25 - 31 - 3 3 25 - 3 - 25 - 26 - C. Organisation of decentralized farmer/farmer group seed multiplication and quality control Orphan crops - Cam p /s Quality control / SCCI Subtotal Organisation of decentralized farm er/farm er group seed m ultiplication and quality control ha ha Total _________________________________ \a printer, phone \b in conjunction with the FFS \c 1 week visit in region \d 1 m onth consultancy \e part of the FFS \f 1 week visit in region \g 1 m onth consultancy \h GART, ITTA, CIRAD, ... \i 5% of "partnership research contract" and of "on-farm trials" \j linked to the FFS \k 1 week in the region \l 100 pers. for 2 days \m GART and CA associations \n linked with com ponent 2.1. - DAIF \o 2.5 ha per bloc \p 5 ha per cam p \q 1 ha per bloc \r 2 ha per cam p \s 0.5 ha per cam p 0 16 - 26 52 79 105 106 - 368 EQUIPMENT 13 5 60 26 28 187 26 46 263 26 47 330 26 47 421 27 47 423 - 144 220 1 685 EQUIPMENT SERVICES 1 045 1 099 1 323 1 339 1 453 1 414 866 8 540 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Scientific training: WS, visits, etc. /k Table 2.1. Local Agricultural Investments (LAI) Detailed Cos ts Quantities (ZMK '000) (USD) Y1 - Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 pers .-m onth Vehicle Set 12 1 12 - 12 - 12 - 12 1 - 12 1 12 - 84 1 2 17.520 200.000 13.000 3.650,00 41.666,67 2.708,33 Electronic Office Equipm ents /c lum ps um 1 - - - 1 - - 2 700 Pers onal offices ' furniture Vehicle Operation and Maintenance s et lum ps um 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 5 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 40 80 80 80 80 80 80 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 7 84 520 28 129 Mis cellaneous office expenditure Rent DSA Dom es tic air tickets Subtotal Dis trict Agricultural Inves tm ent Manager 2. Preparation and M&E by District staff 3. Engineering for preparation and supervision 4. Training and facilitation Subtotal Preparation, facilitation, training, M&E year m onth DSA travel lum ps um lum ps um lum ps um Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y2 44 Y3 44 Y4 44 44 3 - - - 145,83 0 - - - 8.000 50.000 1.666,67 10.416,67 2 5 - 18.000 2.000 500 2.400 3.750,00 416,67 104,17 500,00 4 5 4 2 68 4 5 8 2 68 31 104 246 449 5 68 Y5 4 5 8 2 68 62 209 246 585 44 42 45 3 0 5 4 5 8 2 69 62 210 248 588 Y7 - - 5 Y6 - - Total 45 - 309 42 5 SERVICES EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT - 0 EQUIPMENT 2 53 EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT - 11 11 4 5 8 2 117 62 211 253 643 4 5 8 2 77 32 106 127 342 Disb. Acct. 11 4 5 9 2 75 75 26 35 55 14 542 249 840 1 120 2 751 EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES B. Local Agricultural Investments (LAI) 1. District-level agricultural investments /d lum ps um 2. Community-level agricultural investments /e lum ps um 3. Group-based agricultural investments /f Subtotal Local Agricultural Inves tm ents (LAI) lum ps um Total _________________________________ \a Civil engineer with good fin. m gt. and procurem ent knowledge \b will s hare the car with the facilitators and the extens ion s pecialis t \c printer, phone \d 90% IFAD, 10% Dis trict \e 75% IFAD, 25% beneficiaries \f 50% IFAD, 50% beneficiaries - 521 1 190 1 196 1 202 530 0 625 1086 1091 1097 636 - 229 1 375 230 2 506 231 2 519 232 2 531 233 1 399 68 1 824 3 091 3 107 3 174 1 742 - - 4 640 CIVIL_WORKS_DA 0 - 4535 CIVIL_WORKS_DA - 1 155 10 331 75 13 082 EQUIPMENT Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Unit Cost Unit A. Preparation, facilitation, training, M&E 1. Local Agricultural Investments Manager /a Local Agricultural Inves tm ents Manager 4WD vehicles Pick-up /b Com puter Sets (Laptops ) Total Unit Cost Table 2.2. Support to the Policy and Legal Framework Detailed Costs Unit Miscellaneous office expenditure Subtotal Programme planning and monitoring specialist in PPD B. Policy framework support 1. International technical assistance 2. Studies 130 3. Workshops Subtotal Policy framework support Total _________________________________ \a printer, phone Y2 Y3 Quantities Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Unit Cost (ZMK '000) Unit Cost (USD) Y1 Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Disb. Acct. pers.-month set lumpsum set 12 1 1 1 12 - 12 - - - - - 36 1 1 1 17.520 7.000 700 8.000 3.650,00 1.458,33 145,83 1.666,67 44 1 0 2 44 - 44 - - - - - 132 1 0 2 SERVICES EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT year 1 1 1 - - - - 3 12.000 2.500,00 3 50 3 46 3 46 - - - - 8 142 EQUIPMENT person-day study 20 2 15 2 15 2 15 - 15 - 15 1 - 95 7 4.800 100.000 1.000,00 20.833,33 20 42 15 42 15 42 15 - 15 - 15 21 - 96 146 SERVICES SERVICES ws 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 13 50.000 10.416,67 21 83 21 78 21 78 21 36 21 36 21 58 11 11 136 378 TRAININGSDA 132 124 124 36 36 58 11 521 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report A. Programme planning and monitoring specialist in PPD PPMS in PPD Computer Sets (Desktop) Electronic Office Equipments /a Personal offices' furniture Y1 Table 2.3. Project Management, Monitoring and Evaluation Detailed Costs Quantities Unit Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Unit Cost Unit Cost (ZMK) (USD) Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total Disb. Acct. A. PMU operations 1. Vehicles and office equipment 4WD vehicles Pick-up 1 - - - 1 - - 2 200.000.000 41.667 42 - - - 42 - - 84 EQUIPMENT Vehicle 1 - - - - - - 1 155.000.000 32.292 32 - - - - - - 32 EQUIPMENT Set 4 - - - 4 - - 8 13.000.000 2.708 11 - - - 11 - - 22 EQUIPMENT Computer Sets (Desktops) Accounting and other MIS software Set lumpsum 1 1 - - - 1 - - - 2 1 7.000.000 50.000.000 1.458 10.417 1 10 - - - 1 - - - 3 10 EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT Electronic Office Equipments /a Computer Sets (Laptops) lumpsum 1 - - - 0.2 - - 1.2 144.000.000 30.000 30 - - - 6 - - 36 EQUIPMENT Personal offices' furniture and air condition set 5 - - - - 1 - 6 16.800.000 3.500 18 - - - - 4 - 21 EQUIPMENT Meeting room's furniture and air condition set 1 - - - - - - 1 33.600.000 7.000 7 - - - - - - 7 EQUIPMENT 151 - - - 61 4 - 215 Subtotal Vehicles and office equipment 131 2. Personnel /b Programme manager Finances and administration manager Procurement and contracts specialist M&E specialist Secretary Driver / messenger / office assistant Subtotal Personnel 3. Operation and maintenance Vehicle Operation and Maintenance Miscellaneous office expenditure Office Rent Lusaka DSA Domestic air tickets Pers.months Pers.months Pers.months Pers.months Pers.months Pers.months 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 84 84 84 84 84 84 26.160.000 20.160.000 17.520.000 17.520.000 7.200.000 4.800.000 5.450 4.200 3.650 3.650 1.500 1.000 65 50 44 44 18 12 233 65 50 44 44 18 12 233 66 51 44 44 18 12 234 66 51 44 44 18 12 235 66 51 44 44 18 12 236 67 51 45 45 18 12 238 67 52 45 45 18 12 239 462 356 309 309 127 85 1 648 lumpsum Month Month DSA travel 2 12 12 100 20 2 12 12 150 40 2 12 12 150 40 2 12 12 150 40 2 12 12 150 40 2 12 12 150 40 2 12 12 100 20 14 84 84 950 240 40.000.000 12.000.000 5.500.000 500.000 2.400.000 8.333 2.500 1.146 104 500 17 30 14 10 10 17 30 14 16 20 17 30 14 16 20 17 30 14 16 20 17 30 14 16 20 17 31 14 16 20 17 31 14 11 10 118 212 97 100 121 81 96 96 97 97 98 83 648 15 15 15 15 15 15 - 91 480 344 345 347 409 354 321 2 602 Subtotal Operation and maintenance 4. Training for PMU staff /c Subtotal PMU operations lumpsum SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT EQUIPMENT SERVICES SERVICES TRAININGSDA Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Vehicle City car Table 2.3. Project Management, Monitoring and Evaluation Detailed Costs Quantities Unit Ls Ls Days Study Study review lumpsum mission audit Total 132 _________________________________ \a integrated copier-printer-scanner, projector, server, phone system \b Includes all benefits \c targets principally the WS organised by IFAD \d Final impact evaluation completes the Completion mission \e last year two audits: one at start for previous year and one in the end for year 7 30 1 - Y2 Y3 1 1 Y4 1 1 1 15 1 1 1 Y5 Y6 1 1 Y7 1 1 1 0.5 1 2 Total 45 1.5 2 1 5 1 7 Unit Cost Unit Cost (ZMK) (USD) 4.800.000 720.000.000 240.000.000 240.000.000 96.000.000 240.000.000 72.000.000 1.000 150.000 50.000 50.000 20.000 50.000 15.000 Totals Including Contingencies (USD '000) Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Total 52 52 30 150 284 20 15 35 50 20 15 85 15 50 20 15 101 20 15 35 51 20 15 86 77 51 31 159 52 52 45 227 101 50 101 51 106 786 765 379 431 448 445 441 480 3 388 Disb. Acct. SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES SERVICES Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report B. Surveys, Studies and Reports 1. Project Preparation, Reporting, Monitoring and Evaluation Preparation of gender strategy Preparation of communication strategy International TA for PM&E development Baseline and Impact Evaluation /d Qualitative impact assessments Mid-Term Review Thematic Studies Completion mission External Audits /e Subtotal Project Preparation, Reporting, Monitoring and Evaluation Y1 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 10. Economic and Financial Analysis OVERALL ASSUMPTION FOR THE ANALYSIS Without-Programme Situation 1. Cultivated area: The programme will focus its interventions on three cropping systems: (i) the cassava-based system, (ii) the mixed beans and groundnut cultivation and (iii) lowland rice production. 2. In the without programme situation, the average cassava area cultivated per household is estimated 1.55 ha, of which half is harvested in a year. For mixed beans/ groundnuts, the cultivated area per household is estimated at 0.30 ha per household, and for rice at 0.25 ha per household (Table 1). 3. Considering the above figures and the assumption that the programme would directly support 45,000 farmers/ households for cassava production. Out of these 45,000, 37,000 would also further develop their mixed beans and/or groundnut production while some additional 8,000 farmers would develop their rice production. The total area targeted before increase would be 70,500 ha of which 42,000 ha are harvested on a yearly basis (due to the bi-annual harvest for cassava). Out of that latter, 69 per cent is cassava, 27 per cent mixed beans and/or groundnut and 5 per cent rice. Table 1: Areas cultivated and harvested per household (ha) (direct beneficiaries). Area per household (ha) (without programme) Total area Total area 3rd Weighted cultivated harvested Luapula Northern (ha) (ha) province average Cultivated area - cassava (only half of which is harvested every year) Cultivated area - beans & groundnut Cultivated area - rice Overall 2.00 0.10 0.20 1.10 0.50 0.30 1.55 0.30 0.25 1.55 0.30 0.25 57,350 11,100 2,000 70,450 28,675 11,100 2,000 41,775 4. Cropping patterns: In terms of cropping habits, it is assumed that: 100 per cent of the farmers cultivate cassava without mechanisation, fertiliser, herbicides nor improved varieties. 50 per cent are assumed to sell their produce in fresh while the other 50 per cent operate a transformation into chips. For mixed beans, 65 per cent of the farmers are assumed to mono-cropping with local varieties, no mechanisation nor commercial inputs; 5 per cent do the same but add some fertiliser; 25 per cent of the farmers do associated maize and mixed beans intercropping with local varieties, no mechanisation nor commercial inputs. Finally, 5 per cent operate mixed beans-maize intercropping, use improved mixed beans varieties, hybrid maize and some fertiliser. The results of the cropping budgets for mixed beans and groundnut was considered sufficiently similar so that the budget for mixed beans was used as an acceptable proxy for groundnut. Rice growers are assumed to cultivate local varieties without using external inputs. With-Programme Situation 5. Beneficiaries. The number of total direct beneficiaries of the programme amounts to 60,000 households. 45,000 households/ farmers will benefit from direct support through extension. It is assumed that these 45,000 farmers grow and will be supported in growing cassava. 37,000 of them will receive a further support to grow mixed beans or groundnuts, while 8,000 of them will rather go for rice. The 15,000 remaining direct beneficiaries of the programme will benefit from improved infrastructure (feeder roads, culverts, farmer training centres, water control systems, drying floors, storage rooms, etc.), from access to improved varieties and techniques developed by the 133 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report research with the help of the programme, from improved organisational capacities through the farmers’ organisations and from extension services that will have been trained by the programme. They do however not directly benefit from the extension support paid by the programme1. Cultivated area: It is expected that the programme will promote an increase in areas cultivated. The increase would range from 25 per cent for cassava to 35 per cent for mixed beans/groundnuts as well as for rice. In the withprogramme situation, the average cassava area cultivated per household is estimated 1.86 ha, of which half is harvested in a year. For mixed beans/groundnuts, the cultivated area per household is estimated at 0.41 ha per household, and for rice at 0.34 ha per household (Table 2). The total area directly developed through the programme would be 86,500 ha of which 52,000 ha are harvested on a yearly basis (due to the bi-annual harvest for cassava). Table 2: Areas cultivated and harvested per household (ha) (direct beneficiaries). Area per household (ha) (with programme) Cultivated area - cassava (only half of which is harvested every year) Cultivated area - beans & groundnut Cultivated area - rice Overall Luapula Northern 2.40 0.14 0.27 1.32 0.68 0.41 Total area Total area Increase with 3rd Weighted cultivated harvested (ha) (ha) programme province average 1.86 1.86 68,820 34,410 20% 0.41 0.41 14,985 14,985 35% 0.34 0.34 2,700 2,700 35% 86,505 52,095 23% 6. Cropping patterns. The Programme’s seven years’ interventions would result in changed cropping patterns, with higher inputs and outputs, and post-harvest transformation and value addition. There would be 30,000 farmers members of the FFStype groups organized with programme support and another 15,000 farmers assisted by partners / service providers (PPP) or other partners with programme support that would be adopting improved technologies. The economic and financial analysis is mainly based on these 45,000 direct beneficiary households. A further 15,000 households would only benefit indirectly from community-level infrastructure investments and indirect extension that may, more gradually, promote an uptake of the improved cropping patterns. 7. Adoption rates. The achievement of these cropping patterns is expected to gradually build up with the support of the programme and be reached by year 10 for cassava and 9 for mixed beans, groundnut and rice. For the 15,000 direct beneficiaries of the programme but that are indirect beneficiaries of the extension services provided through the programme, the adoption rate is assumed to be much slower and late. In that situation, full adoption is assumed in year 25 for cassava and 23 for mixed beans, groundnuts and rice. 8. Yields. Cassava yield are expected to increase gradually from the present average of 7 t/ha (fresh) to 13.7 t/ha mainly through the adoption of improved varieties and soil fertility improvement with minimal external inputs (Table 3). Bean yields are expected to increase from the present average of 355 kg/ha in mono-cropping to 856 kg/ha. Rice yields would increase from the present average of 750 kg/ha to an average of 1,775 kg/ha using improved seed, inputs and practices. Table 3: Average yields without and with programme (from yr 10 onwards) (kg/ha) (kg/ha) Cassava Beans Rice 1 Without 7,000 355 750 With 13,713 856 1,775 % Increase 96% 141% 137% In order to better distinguish the agricultural production impact of the programme on this second group, they are treated separately and therefore called “indirect beneficiaries” in the calculation tables. 134 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 9. Tables 4 to 6 present the without and with-programme cropping patterns for the three crops, as well as the associated yields. Table 4: Cassava - Cropping patterns and associated yields in the without and with programme situation Cropping intensity Cassava Variety Cassava Beans Mechanisation Fertilizer Transformation Herbicides Without project situation With project situation - expected Associated yields (kg/ha) (fresh) a. Local 50% 25% 7,000 b. c. d. e. f. g. Local Improved Improved Improved Improved Improved Improved yes yes yes yes yes yes yes yes 50% 5% 2.5% 30% 15% 12.5% 10% 7,000 14,000 14,000 15,000 18,500 25,000 Table 5: Mixed beans - Cropping patterns and associated yields in the without and with programme situation Cropping intensity Beans Variety BEANS MONOCROPPING Beans Maize Mechanisation Fertilizer Pesticides Herbicides Without project situation With project situation - expected Associated yields (kg/ha) a. Local 65% 20% 350 b. c. d. e. f. Local Improved Improved Improved Improved yes yes yes yes yes yes yes 5% 2.5% 10% 25% 10% 2.5% 550 750 1,250 1,400 1,500 MAIZE+ BEANS g. h. i. Local Improved Improved Local Hybrid Hybrid yes yes yes yes 25% 5% 5% 20% 5% 250 750 900 Table 6: Rice - Cropping patterns and associated yields in the without and with programme situation Rice Variety Mechanisation Fertilizer Pesticides Herbicides Without project situation With project situation - expected Associated yields (kg/ha) Cropping intensity a. b. c. d. Local Improved Improved Improved yes yes yes 100% 10% 40% 30% 20% 750 1,500 2,000 2,500 10. Production increase. Table 7 presents the estimated impact of the project in year 10 after project start. For cassava, the increase of 270,000 MT represents the equivalent of about 81,000 MT of dried products (chips). For mixed beans, the increase is substantial in relative terms (over 200 per cent increase) but quite limited in absolute terms (9,000 MT). This is also the case for rice. These levels of increase are reasonable but efforts should be made in close collaboration with SAPP and within the S3P approach to secure markets. 135 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 7: Impact of programme on the crop production tons Cassava (fresh) Beans Rice Without With 200,725 3,941 1,500 471,847 12,831 5,063 Increase 271,122 8,890 3,563 % Increase 135% 226% 238% FINANCIAL ANALYSIS Without-Programme situation 11. Table 8 presents a summary of the detailed calculations operated under the different assumptions. The detailed cropping budgets are presented in the Working Paper. The average net margins appear much higher for the mixed beans / groundnut cropping patterns than for cassava one, and even higher for rice. The return to labour (per person-day) is also rather well differentiated between the three. Cassava however provides more stable yields due to a lower sensitivity to climatic chocks and therefore plays a crucial role in terms of food security. Overall and on average amongst the beneficiary population, the net margin per household in the without programme situation is estimated at 145,000 ZK per year. Table 8: Summary of financial returns on production ('000 KW) Income per ha and per year Return to labour Area per hh (ha)* Income per hh Cassava Beans / Gdnut 22,781 358,158 3,217 5,625 1.55 0.30 35,311 107,448 Rice 612,450 12,878 0.25 153,113 * cassava: only half of which is harvested every year With-Programme Situation 12. Table 9 to 12 present the financial results of the various and combined cropping patterns in the with-programme situation. For cassava, the net margin per household, for an identical cultivated area as in the without-programme situation, would increase from 35,000 ZK without programme to 250,000 ZK with programme. For mixed beans, under the same conditions, the increase passes from 107,500 ZK to 355,000 ZK per household and year, while for rice, it goes from 153,000 up to 375.500 ZK. Overall, for an identical area, with mixed beans and maize combined, the net income of the households would evolve from 145,000 ZK to 608,000 ZK, which represents an increase of 300 per cent. Under these assumptions, the net margin would increase from an estimated USD 1.16 million to an estimated USD 5.7 million. Table 9: Summary of financial returns on production ('000 KW) Income per ha Return to labour (Kw/person-day) Area per household (ha)* Income per household (Kw) Cassava Beans / Gdnut 134,549 875,444 3,829 7,961 1.86 0.41 250,261 354,555 * cassava: only half of which is harvested every year 136 Rice 1,112,535 9,679 0.34 375,481 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 10: Cassava. Presentation of net margins and return to labour with programme Cassava % 25.0% 5.0% 2.5% 30.0% 15.0% 12.5% 10.0% Cassava - Not processed Cassava - Processed Cassava improved - not processed Cassava improved - processed Cassava improved - processed and herbicides Cassava improved - processed and fertiliser Cassava with beans - improved - processed and fertiliser Cassava - Weighted average net income per ha and per year Weighted average net income per household (ZK) per year Net income for the targeted households (ZK million) per year Net income for the targeted households (US$) Financial Net margin Return to per ha and labour year (ZK) (ZK/pd) 3,463 3,034 42,100 3,400 93,925 3,666 184,075 4,264 185,107 4,309 150,157 3,863 274,721 4,007 100.0% 134,549 250,261 11,262 2,346,199 3,829 Table 11: Mixed beans. Presentation of net margins and return to labour with programme Beans (and maize) (proxy for groundnuts) Beans mono - Basic variety Beans mono - Basic variety with limited fertiliser Beans mono - Improved variety, no fertiliser Beans mono - Improved variety, with fertiliser Beans mono - Improved variety, with fertiliser and pesticides Beans mono - Improved variety, with fertiliser, pesticides and herbicides Maize and beans - Basic variety Maize and beans - Basic variety with limited fertiliser Maize and beans - Basic variety with limited fertiliser, pesticides and herbicides Beans (and maize) weighted average net income per ha (ZK) Weighted average net income per household (ZK) Net income for the targeted households (ZK million) Net income for the targeted households (US$) % 20.0% 2.5% 10.0% 25.0% 10.0% 2.5% 5.0% 20.0% 5.0% Financial Net margin Return to per ha and labour year (ZK) (ZK/pd) 235,699 5,014 255,792 4,848 1,017,384 10,274 1,337,591 10,412 1,270,723 9,722 1,470,719 11,465 619,315 7,244 746,709 6,248 832,501 6,722 100.0% 875,444 354,555 13,119 2,733,026 7,961 Table 12: Rice. Presentation of net margins and return to labour with programme Financial Rice % 10.0% 30.0% 30.0% 30.0% Cropping intensity and practices as without project Improved cropping practices - low intensity Improved cropping practices - medium intensity Improved cropping practices - high intensity Rice weighted average net income per ha (ZK) Weighted average net income per household (ZK) Net income for the targeted households (ZK million) Net income for the targeted households (US$) Net margin per ha and year (ZK) 100.0% Return to labour (ZK/pd) 612,450 940,900 1,077,850 1,485,550 12,878 16,837 16,145 20,274 1,112,535 375,481 3,004 625,801 9,679 ECONOMIC ANALYSIS 13. Economic conversion factors: The economic crop models have been calculated by using individual economic conversion factors for all the inputs1. For the outputs (maize, mixed beans, rice), the economic prices have been estimated by calculating the import parity, either from Johannesburg (based on the Johannesburg Stock Exchange 1 Most of the Conversion Factors applicable to farm production inputs were taken from the very detailed calculations operated by J. Keyser (Case study for Zambia as background document) for the Study “Awakening Africa’s Sleeping Giant”, World Bank - FAO, 2009. 137 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report when available). For cassava, no regional representative prices could be found. The conversion factor (economic / local price) that was applied by default is 1.2. For rice, the conversion factors that has been applied is 0.9 considering that Zambia still has a competitiveness problem. For maize, considering the important stock surpluses of the year 2010 and the fact that Zambia will not be able to absorb all its production, the export parity was taken into account rather the import one. The conversion factor applied to the overall programme costs was 1 (after retrieval of taxes and duties). 14. Gross economic margin on area as presently cultivated: Based on these assumptions, the present economic gross margin on the total area cultivated by the direct and indirect beneficiaries is estimated around US$ 6.3 million per year. It would be at US$ 10 million per year with the programme in year 8 and slowly increase to US$ 11.3 million in year 25. 15. Baseline results: The discount rate adopted is 10 per cent per year. The cost of capital opportunity in Zambia is higher but in agriculture this is already considered reasonable, and even quite high when targeting the poor farmers. The period of time taken into account for the discounted fund flows is 25 years. Based on the assumptions as presented above, the Economic Internal Rate of Return (EIRR) of the programme is estimated at 14 per cent (see Working Paper). The associated Net Present Value at a 10 per cent discount rate is USD 5 million. Considering the all the benefits have not been captured in the simulation, the model for the calculation of the economic returns do only take partially into consideration some of the costs: 90 per cent of the support to agricultural research (SC.1.3.), 30 per cent of the costs of the District Agricultural Investment Fund (SC.2.1.) as am major part will be infrastructure and post-harvest equipment and 20 per cent of the “Support to the Policy and Legal Framework” subcomponent (SC.2.2.) as this support will target MACO at central level and have a much wider impact that cannot be directly linked to the results expected from the present programme. The simulation has been limited to the analysis of the consequences of improved production (mainly through increased yields and production areas) but has not taken into consideration the potential higher prices that may be gained though improved post-harvest practices (in terms of processing and marketing). The effective economic return is therefore expected to be notably greater than the 14 per cent. 16. Sensitivity analysis: The EIRR has a rather low sensitivity to variations in costs and to reductions or delays in income (Table 14). The highest risk incurred is a reduction in income due to lower output prices and / or to an increase in the costs of commercial inputs. With a 10 per cent reduction in the gross farmer income, the EIRR falls to 12 per cent. With a 20 per cent reduction in gross farmer income it goes down to 7 per cent. Table 13: Economic conversion factors for inputs Ca s u a l la b o r P e rma n e n t la b o r P e tro l Fu el Seed s F e rtilis e r (LCF , ECF ) F e rtilis e r (F A M ) Ch e mic a ls (e x in s e c tic id e s ) In s e c tic id e s T ra c to r Ve h ic le s F a rm Imp le me n ts O ffic e e q u ip me n t In s u ra n c e 138 75% 75% 55% 66% 99% 98% 98% 97% 87% 85% 76% 85% 82% 75% Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Table 14: Sensitivity analysis Standard sensitivity tests Ref. case NPV 10% EIRR (million USD) 14% 4 Costs + 10% 11% 2 Costs + 20% 10% -1 Costs + 30% 8% -3 Income + 10% 16% 7 Income + 20% 18% 10 Income + 30% 20% 12 Income - -10% 11% 1 Income - -20% 6% -3 Income -30% Income delayed by 1 year Income delayed by 2 years 1% -8 9% 5% -1 -5 139 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 11. Draft Programme Implementation Manual The purpose of the Programme Implementation Manual (PIM) is to facilitate programme management and implementation by defining the processes, procedures, responsibilities and schedules associated with, on one hand, all of the main programme activities, and on the other, the various management and fiduciary systems. The first complete version of the PIM will be drafted by a 2-person team of consultants, hired directly by IFAD, prior to programme start-up. This will provide guidance to the members of the PMU, as and when it is established, and the PMU members themselves will be responsible for reviewing the draft PIM and finalising it during the first 6 months of programme implementation. However, the PIM will need to be a living document, which will keep evolving during programme implementation, and the PMU team will need to update it regularly, as and when necessary. The draft annotated outline of the PIM, shown in Appendix 1, envisages 11 chapters, made up of: (i) an introduction; (ii) the institutional arrangements for programme management and implementation; (iii) the programme area; (iv) the programme activities, by sub-component; (v) the programme financial resources; (vi) the financial management and accounting arrangements; (vii) procurement; (viii) planning and budgeting; (ix) monitoring and evaluation; (x) general administrative matters; as well as (xi) the operational linkages / synergies with SAPP. Draft operating procedures for the Local Agricultural Investments sub-component, defined during the final design mission, are shown in Appendix 2; these are expected to be provide the basis for the procedures defined in more detail in the PIM. 140 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 11 - Appendix 1: Proposed Outline Of Programme Implementation Manual 1. Introduction Purpose of Programme Implementation Manual: Explanation of how the PIM is intended to be used, by whom, and for what purpose. S3P in Summary: Provide a summary description of the Programme including implementation arrangements indicating who is responsible for what. Programme Start-Up Activities: 2. Define the list of start-up activities, Draw up a draft approach to the start-up workshop Prepare a bar-chart showing the start-up work plan Define the process, responsibilities and timetable for the recruitment of the PMU staff Implementation and Institutional Arrangements Roles and responsibilities of the Programme Steering Committee, PMU and implementing and technical partners Programme Governance: Review the Programme Steering Committee’s composition and recommend members to be included – in the light of the current PSC for SAPP being expanded to take responsibility for S3P; review its terms of reference, particularly in the light of the agreed need for the PSC to play a more proactive role than hitherto, and recommend the additional tasks it should perform. Programme Organisation and Management: Define the programme organogram, showing clearly the lines of responsibility, reporting and coordination, within the PMU, and between the PMU and MACO. Programme Planning and Budgeting: Detail the procedures, responsibilities and deadlines for preparation and approval of annual workplans and budgets by implementing partners and the PMU. Implementation approach. Outline the key elements of the implementation approach, e.g. specifically targeted to respond to the constraints and opportunities of poor smallholder farmers – men and women – in northern Zambia; demand-driven and participatory; government-owned; supportive of ‘farming as a business’ and publicprivate partnerships to promote smallholder agricultural development; and closely linked to SAPP (and RFP). 3. Programme Area Criteria for selection: Define the criteria for selection of districts and camps in PY1 and PY2, and of third province districts and camps in PY1 and PY2. To include: actual and potential production of cassava and beans; market opportunities; linkages to SAPP and complementarities with other projects, in particular the Luapula Rural and Agricultural Development Project; target population Definition of process for selection: Define responsibilities for drawing up and approving proposed programme area. Indicate the roles, stakeholders and linkages to 141 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report SAPP. Prepare a template for matrix to prioritize and select (province), districts and camps. 4. Procedures for Programme Activities For all proposed programme activities: Clearly describe how all activities will be implemented Summarize institutional roles and responsibilities Review terms of reference (TOR) of S3P staff and update accordingly Sub-component 1.1: Strengthening farmer organizations and their federations The sub-component will strengthen existing farmer organizations, and assist farmers interested and willing to start their own organizations. Implementation will be outsourced to service providers working in this field in Zambia (one/province targeted by the programme). The contracts will include the following tasks: (a) detailed assessment of the existing farmer organizations, their level of development and capacity (as per the 5-stages of maturity defined in the PDR), the quality of the services they offer to their members, and their main capacity development requirements; (b) development of training material and provision of training on priority issues identified (could include group formation and group dynamics, leadership skills, governance and decision making processes, entrepreneurship skills and business planning, financial management, accounting and legal aspects); and (c) follow-up and on-the-job mentoring in terms of developing capacities for coordination and service provision, including linking up to rural finance services. Draw up (draft) tender documents for these services, including the preparation of TOR and a more detailed indication of the services required. Sub-component 1.2: Pluralistic participatory extension services The sub-component will broaden technology options for smallholders to increase productivity, by supporting different sources of advisory services to farmers: MACO, farmer organizations, private or commercial enterprises and NGOs. Strengthening MACO field capacities: at Provincial and District levels, to improve performance and efficiency in order to be able to deliver good quality services Review the TOR of the Provincial Facilitators and further define how they will operate at PACO’s office. Prepare draft TOR for Quarterly Provincial and District planning and review meetings (1-2 days), specifying outputs, participation, etc... Prepare draft TOR for recruitment of service provider to conduct provincial and district level capacity building in procurement and financial management. Prepare TOR for a study to explore the possible roles that ICT could play in extension delivery Prepare tender documents for procurement of goods and launching of works contract relative to providing mobility and housing to CEOs. Works will be conducted through local contractors whenever possible Harmonization and up-scaling of participatory extension approaches (PEA). Based on the Farmer Field School approach, and following a participatory assessment of current PEA methodologies (done by the PMU). Prepare TOR for a short-term consultant/trainer, who will be hired to work with the PMU both to develop a harmonized curriculum for Master training and training of trainers (ToT), and to train provincial Master Trainers, targeting DAOs, SAOs, staff from partner organizations 142 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Partnerships with organizations providing advisory services: Public-Private Partnerships (PPPs) may be envisaged where government and the private or non-government partner share similar objectives, but the latter needs some support or resources to up-scale activities in the target areas. Working with MACO’s committee looking at PPPs for extension, prepare TOR for any studies for which a need has already been defined; and draft a possible methodology for PPP, identifying which type of costs S3P will cover, and which are expected to be covered by the partner; and in other cases where contracting of service providers is envisaged, prepare TOR and request for proposals. Sub-component 1.3: Agricultural Research for Development (AR4D) The focus will be on strengthening of institutional AR4D collaboration and partnerships for enhanced agricultural research-extension-training linkages. Adaptive research for improved varieties. S3P will finance up-grading of research infrastructure of research stations and some equipment. Procurement of works will be done through local contractors to the extent possible. Adaptation of Conservation Agriculture, and other improved cropping practices. Key outputs of on-farm research/testing programmes will generate a range of technology options adapted to local farming system conditions. Prepare draft Memoranda of Understanding between ZARI, ICRAF and S3P; between ZARI, GART and S3P; and any others identifiable at this stage. Research on adapted tools/equipment, including for transport, and on-farm post-harvest technologies. S3P will support research on improved labour productivity for enhanced competitiveness of commodities produced in the target areas. S3P will finance research equipment for ZARI, and post-harvest equipment for Farmer training Institutes for demonstration purposes. Prepare equipment specification for tender process. Prepare draft Memorandum of Understanding between ZARI, IITA (e.g.), private sector and S3P (for cassava technology). Access to improved Seeds and Planting Material. Farmer-based high quality seed/planting material multiplication will be promoted and strengthened as follows: (a) maintenance of breeder seed stock by specialised commodity research programmes in ZARI stations of Mansa and Kasama; (b) production of foundation seed in both stations by ZARI for cassava and mixed beans over two seasons; and (c) first multiplication at district level and second multiplication at camp level through farmer groups and/or specialized seed producer groups/ individuals. Prepare (a) draft contract between ZARI and Farmer Groups or individual farmers, and (b) methodology (draft criteria) for selecting groups/ farmers. Adapted certification (Quality Declared Seeds) support to be provided by the Seed Control & Certification Institute (SCCI). Sub-component 2.1: Local Agricultural Investments The sub-component will help finance investments that improve access to markets, increase labour productivity, reduce post-harvest losses, improve land and water management, or facilitate access to knowledge. Conditional partial grants will be provided for eligible agricultural investments, and technical and facilitation assistance will be provided to prepare investment requests and help ensure correct implementation, operation and maintenance. Access to resources will be according to defined criteria that outline beneficiary eligibility and eligible type of investments. Three funding windows categories will be established, each with specific procedures and internal control mechanisms. The sub-component will be managed by a Local Agricultural Investments manager. 143 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Review and strengthen the TOR for the Local Agricultural Investments manager District-level agricultural investments of a strategic nature, such as improvement of feeder roads and rehabilitation of district Farmer Training Centres and Farm Institutes conditional on a sound business plan for sustainable operation and management being provided. S3P contribution to such investments will be up to 90 percent of total costs, with a ceiling equivalent to US$ 250,000 per sub-project. S3P will provide engineering and supervision support, both at preparation and implementation stage. Prepare a manual detailing how these investments will be identified and prioritised (criteria, business plan, etc); responsibilities for detailed design, preparation of bill of quantities, environmental and social impact assessment; the procurement process to local contractors and how to mobilize district contribution. Community-level agricultural investments of a public nature, including for instance: spot improvement of agricultural roads; small-scale storage sheds and drying floors; and small-scale water management or soil erosion control structures. S3P will provide facilitation services for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening and construction. Prepare TOR for this facilitation, and tender documents for works contracts Prepare a Manual detailing how these investments will be identified and prioritised (eligibility criteria of requesting groups or communities), how realistic operation and management plans will be prepared, how the procurement process of local contractors will work, and how to mobilize community contribution. Group-based agricultural investments with a high social value includes limited and conditional support to purchase labour saving equipment that might in more advanced situations be entirely financed through private means. S3P contribution will be up to 50 percent of equipment costs, with a ceiling of US$ 2,500 per sub-project and a maximum of one sub-project per group. S3P will provide facilitation services for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening and preparation of business plans. Prepare TOR for this facilitation, and tender documents for works contracts A Manual needs to be prepared detailing how these groups will be identified and prioritised (eligibility criteria of requesting groups), how realistic operation and management plans will be prepared, how the procurement process of local contractors will work and how to mobilize community contribution. For all three of the funding windows, there will be need to ensure: that the operational procedures include as a precondition for investment a credible and sound business plan for the sustainable operation and maintenance of the infrastructure or equipment financed. that the procedures include mechanisms that enable rural communities and groups are able to identify, prevent and/or whistle-blow on any cases of corruption encountered. Technical and facilitation assistance will be provided for: (i) training of DACO and DDCC staff, CACs and eligible farmer groups, as required; (ii) facilitation of participatory planning and implementation processes at community-level; (iii) technical assistance for the screening, assessment and design of proposed investments, (iv) preparation of business, operation and maintenance plans; and (v) engineering support for the design of infrastructure proposals and supervision of its construction. Prepare a manual detailing how the training and facilitation support for groups and local institutions will be accessed, how technical assistance will be mobilized. 144 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Sub-component 2.2 Support to the Policy and Planning Framework Focus: Support MACO’s Policy and Planning Department (PPD) to manage flows of information and communication, undertake policy reviews, and provide opportunities to learn from relevant experience. Management of information and communication: S3P will provide a Programme planning and monitoring specialist who will be based in PPD and who will report to the Director PPD, for a period of 3 years. Prepare draft TOR. Policy reviews and studies: S3P will provide support to undertake specific studies, draft policies and regulations, as well as the review, discussion (workshop, forums) and dialogue related to their preparation. 5. Define the processes for identifying the need for policy reviews and studies. To the extent that any relevant policy review and studies have already been identified by MACO, prepare draft TOR. Gender strategy Aim: to ensure that women make up at least 50% of the participants in programme activities, and 50% of the beneficiaries of the programme’s impacts. Define both the vehicles and the mechanisms that will be used to ensure that at least 50 per cent of the programme participants and beneficiaries are women. These may include: The use of quantitative gender targets to ensure women’s full participation in different programme activities The use of qualitative gender targets relative to women’s roles in community groups / organizations The inclusion of gender targets in TOR and contracts with service providers The use of gender-disaggregated programme impact 6. data for monitoring participation and Financial Management and Accounting Programme Financial Resources Summarise the programme cost estimates, by financiers, component and expenditure categories; and disbursement schedules Grant and Loan Administration Arrangements: Describe the process of accessing IFAD loan and Finland grant funds Review disbursement policies and procedures including withdrawal procedures and ensure that they are in conformity with IFAD and GRZ requirements Flow of Funds: Chart and narrative describing the various channels for disbursement of funds through the designated account, operating account, direct payment etc Financial Management and Accounting System: Draw up the general specifications, including control mechanisms, for the financial management and accounting systems and procedures to be used by the PMU and the implementing partners 145 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Review accounting procedures for receipts and payments and ensure that they conform to GRZ and IFAD requirements Review and recommend budget and budget control policies and procedures Financial Reporting and Auditing: List the reports required and their contents and frequencies, plus procedures for auditing, including internal control, and dispute reconciliation. Review and attach sample financial reporting formats as per GRZ and IFAD requirements Review internal control and dispute resolution mechanisms Review and attach internal and external sample audit principles, and prepare draft TOR for external audit Procurement 7. Review and recommend procurement procedures for goods and works Review and recommend procurement procedures for consultancies, including steps in consultancy selection Review and recommend appropriate procurement procedures for the Local Agricultural Investment funding windows, including procurement to be undertaken at sub-project level Review thresholds and ensure that they are in conformity with GRZ and IFAD requirements For all procedures, indicate circumstances under which a waiver can be granted. Ensure that issues of post procurement, audit and monitoring are included in all procedures Define responsibilities for the various procedures, and at the various stages, involving the PMU, MACO and ZPPA; and indicate requirements for prior review Draw up a draft 18-month procurement plan, linked to a tentative implementation schedule (see 8. below) 8. Planning and budgeting Define a participatory process for preparation and approval of annual work plan and budget, which makes clear how the programme beneficiaries will be involved and how the linkages to SAPP will be made; identify responsibilities and stakeholders; and draw up a proposed cycle for the exercise. Draw up a draft template for AWPB format. Develop a tentative implementation schedule showing what will be the main focus of the first, second and third years – subject to update/review once the PMU is on board. 9. Monitoring and Evaluation Explain the role of the logical framework for planning and monitoring and evaluation Explain how the monitoring system will be set-up and implemented 146 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 10. Prepare draft TOR for the baseline study General Administrative Matters Define procedures and responsibilities for: General office administration Motor vehicle and asset maintenance Human resource administration Contracts administration 11. Operational linkages / synergies with SAPP Define the range of specific mechanisms that will be used to develop operational synergies between S3P and SAPP. They will include, though not necessarily be limited to: The selection of provinces, districts and camps to be covered under S3P The role of Programme Managers’ Team Linkages through the Annual Work Planning and Budgeting process Jointly-conducted annual review of implementation performance Role of the Programme Steering Committee 147 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 11 - Appendix 2: Draft operating procedures for the Local Agricultural Investments sub-component 1. The Local Agricultural Investments sub-component will help finance investments that improve access to markets, increase labour productivity, reduce post-harvest losses, improve land and water management, or facilitate access to knowledge. Assistance to be provided under this sub-component will be flexible and multifarious. It will take the form of management assistance, technical training, social and economic appraisals, facilitation of community participation and/or financial assistance on a cofinancing basis according to the capacity of the community. S3P will provide conditional partial grants primarily for equipment or small-scale infrastructure with high public and social value, which are categorized as follows: (a) District-level agricultural investments of a strategic nature (b) Community-level agricultural investments of a public nature (c) Group-based agricultural investments with a high social value 2. The proposals have been developed taking into consideration lessons learnt from other programmes. These include the IFAD-funded Smallholder Enterprise and Marketing Programme (SHEMP); the SIDA-funded Agricultural Support Programme (ASP) which in turn built on the experiences of a number of other SIDA funded projects in the agricultural sector; the Rural Investment Fund Programme (RIF); the ZAMSIF Programme; the World Bank funded Agricultural Development Support Project for Smallholder Commercialisation (ADSP-SC), and the African Development Bank-funded Agricultural Sector Investment Support to Eastern Province. (a): District-level agricultural investments of a strategic nature 3. Investments could include, for example, improvement of feeder roads connecting productive smallholder areas to main roads, or rehabilitation of district level Farmer Training Centres or Farm Institutes (on condition that a sound business plan for sustainable operation and management is provided). Investments that would normally be undertaken by the private sector would not be eligible for support. These investments would be of a strategic nature and requests for support would be prepared by the DACO in close coordination with the District Development Coordination Committee (DDCC), and would also be included in the District Development Plan. 4. Intra-community agricultural investments’ facilitation process for the identification of the need for infrastructure will be done in harmony with the generic facilitation which will be employed by the Programme in Sub-component 1.1. A preliminary assessment of existing and condition of infrastructure in the area will be undertaken, with a view to identifying intra-community infrastructure priorities. S3P would provide facilitation services through the service provider for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening, construction, maintenance, and monitoring of projects. Requests will emanate from participatory this process. The request for the project by the community will first be submitted to the Area Development Committee (ADC)1 for review and recommendation before being submitted to the DACO. 5. First community meeting – Once the DACO is satisfied with the request from the ADC, the ADC and DACO will hold a focused community meeting which will be aimed at informing the Community about the ADC and DACO decision concerning the request for the project. The DACO will prepare a project proposal in collaboration with the community and the ADC for submission to the DDCC for approval. At the same meeting, the community will be informed of the next steps in the approval process, including the responsibility of the community to select a project committee. 1 An ADC is the next lower level in the structure after the District Development Coordinating Committee (DDCC) which is responsible for coordinating development work in a particular area. The CAC is represented on the ADC. 148 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 6. Selection of the Infrastructure project committee – During the first meeting, the ADC (including the CAC) and the DACO (in collaboration with the CEOs/BEOs in affected communities) will facilitate the community in the selection of the project committee which will be responsible for mobilizing the resources, providing oversight in the implementation of the project and constitute Panel B of the Project Account to which funds will be disbursed for project implementation. The project committee will need to be trained in its roles and responsibilities through the facilitation process in Sub-component 1.1 in collaboration with the Local Agricultural Investment manager. 7. The Proposal will need to include realistic operation and management plans. For simplicity, the Local Agricultural Investment manager will design an infrastructure project application form to be used by communities and groups. The application form should contain at the minimum the following information: date of application, contact person, name of applicant, legal status (options should include organized interest/farmer group), name of project, location, village(s), distance from district centre (km), economic activity in the community, description of the project, constraints created by current condition or lack of infrastructure, proposed works to be carried out, technology required (labour and machinery), environmental considerations (climate of area, topography of the project area, vegetation type, protected areas and how they will be protected, possibilities of project distancing some people, impact of materials to be used on the environment, etc.), number of beneficiaries and benefits, estimated total project cost, estimated project duration, proposed maintenance arrangement, management skills required and available to implement the project, community participation (when, how by whom the project was identified and whether project has been discussed by the community). The proposal should be signed by the DACO and at least two community representatives. 8. Technical Field and Appraisal visit –The DACO will submit the project proposal to the DDCC. A Technical Field and Appraisal visit will be undertaken by relevant representatives of the DDCC (DACO, SAO, Cooperative Development and Marketing Officer), Technical Service Branch (TSB) of MACO, ADC representative, Director of Works, related specialist Infrastructure from the District Council, Facilitation Team Leader (FTL) and the CEO. The purpose of the visit will be to assess the expressed interest and the intra-community’s need for the project in terms of how the project idea evolved; how much participation of the requesting community has been generated; the social, economic, environmental and engineering feasibility. Cost-benefit analysis criteria1 will be the basis for recommending a particular project. The physical nature of the project will provide the basis for the preparation of Bills of quantities (BOQs). 9. Approval of the infrastructure project proposal – The Technical Field and Appraisal visit report will be presented to the infrastructure and agriculture Subcommittees of the DDCC2 for approval. The DACO will only sign for the approval of the project once it has been reviewed and approved by those subcommittees of the DDCC. 10. Approval limits: The approval limit for the DACO is K10,000,000 or approximately US$2,200. Where the approval ceiling goes beyond that of the DACO, the DDCC reviewed and recommended project proposal will be referred to the PACO whose approval ceiling is K20,000,000 (approximately US$4,400). Where it still goes beyond 1 2 The IFAD funded Smallholder Enterprise and Marketing Programme (SHEMP) developed the cost-benefit analysis criteria to use under its Market Access Improvement sub-component which was providing road rehabilitation works. The Agricultural Support Programme (ASP) also had cost-benefit analysis criteria it was using. These can be adopted with minor adjustments where necessary so that there is no re-inventing of the will and to avoid unnecessary costs of developing new criteria. DDCC was established by Government through Circulars as a forum for coordinating the planning and implementation of development activities at the District level. It comprises various sector sub-committees whose representation is drawn from Ministerial departments performing specified Government functions and responsible for implementing programmes and report to their respective heads of department, NGOs, and the private sector. 149 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report the approval ceiling of the PACO, it will be referred through the PMU to the S3P Steering Committee for approval. 11. Second community meeting – Once a request has been approved/ rejected, the CEOs in collaboration with the ADC will arrange for a focused facilitation meeting with the communities involved at which the results of the request will be communicated. The meeting will be attended by the all Community members, project committee members, the DACO, the DC, the local Facilitator, the FTL, the Local Agricultural Investment manager, the Director of Works from the District council, and representatives from the ADC. The DACO or District Commissioner will announce the results and give reasons for rejected requests. For the approved projects, the DACO or the DC will hand over a letter of approval of the project by the Programme to the community. The meeting will also discuss the S3P intra-community-based agricultural investment sub-component and illustrate the importance of mainstreaming environment and gender aspects. Environmental activities at the different project cycle will be explained. Additionally the roles of all stakeholders in the project i.e. the local CEO/Facilitator, FTL, the Engineering Consultant, Director of Works, DC, DACO, the Local Agricultural Investment manager and other stakeholders will explained. The scope of work to be done and the contents of the BOQ, drawings and tendering process will be explained to the community. The Director of Works will also facilitate the design of a local detailed Work Plan indicating major project stages and Time Schedule for the local material and labour contribution by the community at each project stage. The meeting will further discuss the future need for maintenance and Community contribution towards maintenance, and the need for a project bank account. Maintenance will include mitigating activities to sustain the environment which will also be included in the workplan. 12. Invitations to tender - Invitations to tender for construction of approved projects will be advertised in the three prominent daily newsprints, namely Times of Zambia, Daily Mail and The Post. The advertisements shall run for three consecutive days at least 4 weeks before the date for opening and evaluation. Tender documents will be sold at respective Facilitation team (FT) offices in the district and at the S3P PMU in Lusaka. Tender guidelines will be developed by the Engineering Consultant in collaboration with MACO ensuring that they satisfy the Government Procurement procedures and the IFAD procurement guidelines. 13. Receiving of tender documents - Receiving of tender documents will be done at respective FT offices where arrangements to visit the project sites will be made by the respective FTs. The FTL will accompany the potential contractors to the project sites for them to assess the project requirements to enable them submit the tender documents. 14. Composition of the committee to select a contractor - All districts whose projects will be approved will constitute panels to select contractors to construct the projects. The panels will comprise benefiting community representatives, ADC representatives, DDCC representatives, DAC representatives, District council representatives, MACO technical branch and other organizations depending on the needs of the district. All tendering sessions will be chaired by the DC or will be delegated to the DACO in MACO. 15. Opening and evaluation of applications and awarding of contracts - This process will include opening of tenders, meeting the contractors, announcing the values of tenders, apportioning time a for interviews and checking the correctness of the submitted tender documents, and interviewing the contractors. Preceding the interviews, accepted and rejected documents will be announced and reasons for rejection given. Arithmetical corrections and new tender values to the tender documents will also be announced. All queries will be discussed at this stage. Awarding and signing of contracts with successful contractors will be a preserve of the DACO in collaboration with the S3P Facilitation Team Leader done upon agreeing on the terms. However, priority will be given to constructors in the district in which the approved project is, provided they meet 150 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report the requirements. The next to be considered are those in the province before consideration will be given to those at national level. 16. Announcement of tender results – A third focused facilitation meeting will be held with the community. It will comprise participants from the Project committee, the DACO, the FTL, the local CEO/Facilitator, the Contractor, and Director of Works, DDCC representatives, and ADC/CAC representatives. During this meeting, the activity and work schedule will be developed and agreed upon by all stakeholders: MACO, the Contractor and the community. Terms of payment will also be agreed based on the agreed activity and work schedule which will be phased according to major milestones/phases of the project. Mobilization of the Contractor to project site will be within 2 weeks of signing of the contract. 17. Community ownership – Project ownership will be promoted by two processes. The first one is through dialogue, community participation and decision making in planning, implementation and maintenance of the project which is aimed to provide the local community with an improved understanding of social and economic significance, technical quality, contractual obligations, good governance and ownership of the project. The second process will be through community contribution. S3P contribution to Intracommunity agricultural investments would be up to 90 percent of total costs, with a ceiling equivalent to US$ 250,000 per sub-project. Community contributions will be in form of local materials (such as sand and stones), labour, food, and tools for construction and maintenance of the project. 18. Capacity building: Capacity will be build for various stakeholders as follows: a) The community in their project identification, planning, project proposal writing, implementation and maintenance roles and responsibilities; b) Those to undertake the technical field and appraisal visit in their roles and responsibilities and criteria for recommending a project for partial funding; and c) The technical sub-committee of the DDCC, which will be approving project proposals, supervising and monitoring the project, in their roles and responsibilities and utilization of various forms which will be developed for project implementation. (b): Community-based agricultural investments of a public nature 19. Investments here will include: (i) spot improvement of local feeder roads including culverts and bridges; (ii) small-scale storage sheds and drying floors; and (iii) small-scale water control or soil erosion control structures such as weir dams and furrows/canals. Requests for would originate at the farmer group, cooperative or community level and would reach the DACO through the Camp Agricultural Committees and the CEOs. 20. Eligibility of groups: For requesting groups to be eligible, they will be required to have reached Development Stage 4 (Maturity stage – see Table 1, Annex 4) where they are able to run their own affairs. Community-based agricultural investments’ facilitation process for the identification of the need for infrastructure will be done in harmony with the generic facilitation which will be employed by the Programme in Subcomponent 1.1. A preliminary assessment of existing and condition of infrastructure in the area will be undertaken. The results of the preliminary assessment will be used to identify community-based infrastructure priorities and assess farmer groups and interest groups showing high possibility to suffer infrastructural-related constraints. S3P would provide facilitation services for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening and construction. Requests will emanate from participatory this process. 151 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 21. Contents of the project proposal – proposals will need to include realistic operation and management plans. For simplicity, the Engineering Consultant, in collaboration with the Local Agricultural Investment manager will design a infrastructure project application form to be used by communities and groups. The application form should contain at the minimum the following information: date of application, contact person, name of applicant, legal status (options should include organized interest/farmer group), name of project, location, village(s), distance from district centre (km), economic activity in the community, description of the project, constraints created by current condition or lack of infrastructure, proposed works to be carried out, technology required (labour and machinery), environmental considerations (climate of area, topography of the project area, vegetation type, protected areas and how they will be protected, possibilities of project distancing some people, impact of materials to be used on the environment, etc.), number of beneficiaries and benefits, estimated total project cost, estimated project duration, proposed maintenance arrangement, management skills required and available to implement the project, community participation (when, how by whom the project was identified and whether project has been discussed by the community). The proposal should be signed by the CEO and at least two community representatives. 22. Selection of the Infrastructure project committee – The project proposal will first be submitted to the CAC/CEO for review and recommendation before being submitted to the DACO. If the CAC is satisfied with the proposal, the CAC and the CEO will hold a focused community meeting which will be aimed at informing the Community about the CAC decision concerning the project. At the same meeting, the CAC and the CEO will facilitate the community in the selection of the Infrastructure project committee which will be responsible for mobilizing the resources, providing oversight in the implementation of the project and constitute Panel B of the Project Account to which funds will be disbursed for project implementation. The project account will be opened at District level. The project committee will need to be trained in its roles and responsibilities. 23. Technical Field and Appraisal visit – Once an application has been submitted to the DACO by the community, a Technical Field and Appraisal visit will be undertaken by relevant representatives of the DAC (DACO, SAO, Cooperative Development and Marketing Officer), Technical Service Branch (TSB) of MACO, CAC representative, Director of Works, related subject manager specialist Infrastructure from the District Council, Facilitation Team Leader (FTL) and the CEO. The purpose of the visit will be to assess the expressed interest and the community’s need for the project in terms of how the project idea evolved; how much participation of the requesting community has been generated; the social, economic, environmental and engineering feasibility of the project; and the physical nature of the project which will provide the basis for the preparation of Bills of quantities (BOQs). 24. Approval of the infrastructure project proposal – The Technical Field and Appraisal team’s report with its recommendations will be presented to the full DAC 1 for Community-based agricultural investments of a public nature for approval. Where the approval ceiling goes beyond that of the DACO (currently K10,000,000 /approximately US$2,200), the project proposal will be referred to the PACO for approval. Where it still goes beyond the approval ceiling of the PACO (currently K20,000,000 /approximately US$4,400) it will be referred to the S3P Steering Committee. 25. Focused facilitation meeting – Once a request has been approved/disapproved, the CEO will arrange for a focused facilitation meeting with the group or community at which the results of the request will be communicated. The DACO or District Commissioner will announce the results and give reasons for disapproved 1 DAC comprises the DACO, SAO, Cooperative Development and Marketing Officer, a representative from input agro dealers, a representative from a marketing agency (usually the Food Reserve Agency), a representative from NGOs, and a Planner from the Council. 152 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report requests. The meeting will be attended by the all Community and group members, Infrastructure committee members, the DACO, the DC, the local Facilitator, the FTL, the subject matter specialist responsible for Infrastructure, the Director of Works from the District council, and representatives from the CAC. For the approved projects, the DACO or the DC will hand over a letter of approval of the project by the Programme to the group. The meeting will discuss the S3P community-based agricultural investment subcomponent and illustrate the importance of mainstreaming environment and gender aspects. Environmental activities at the different project cycle will be explained. Additionally the roles of all stakeholders in the project including the local CEO/Facilitator, FTL, Director of Works, DC, DACO, subject matter specialist Infrastructure and other stakeholders will be explained. The scope of work to be done and the contents of the BOQ, drawings and tendering process will be explained to the community. The Director of Works will also facilitate the design of a local detailed Work Plan indicating major project stages and Time Schedule for the local material and labour contribution by the community at each project stage. The meeting will further discuss the future need for maintenance and Community contribution towards maintenance, and the need for a project bank account. Maintenance will include mitigating activities to sustain the environment which will also be included in the work-plan. 26. Invitations to tender - Invitations to bid for construction of approved projects will be advertised within the three prominent daily newsprints, namely Times of Zambia, Daily Mail and The Post. The advertisements shall run for three consecutive days at least 4 weeks before the date for opening and evaluation. Tender documents will be sold at respective Facilitation team (FT) offices in the district and at the S3P PMU in Lusaka. Tender guidelines will be developed by the Engineering Consultant ensuring that they satisfy the Government Procurement procedures and the IFAD procurement guidelines. 27. Receiving of tender documents - Receiving of tender documents will be done at respective FT offices where arrangements to visit the project sites will be made by the respective FTs. The FTL will accompany the potential contractors to the project sites for them to assess the project requirements to enable them submit the tender documents. All would-be contractors should be able to visit the project sights before submitting their bids and their bids should indicate source of their material and water to avoid delays in programme implementation. 28. Composition of the committee to select a contractor - All districts whose projects will be approved will constitute panels to select contractors to construct the projects. The panels will comprise benefiting community representatives, CAC representatives, DAC representatives, District council representatives, MACO technical branch and other organizations depending on the needs of the district. All tendering sessions will be chaired by the District Agricultural Coordinator in MACO. 29. Opening and evaluation of applications and awarding of contracts - This process will include opening of tenders, meeting the contractors, announcing the values of tenders, apportioning time a for interviews and checking the correctness of the submitted tender documents, and interviewing the contractors. Preceding the interviews, accepted and rejected documents will be announced and reasons for rejection given. Arithmetical corrections and new tender values to the tender documents will also be announced. All queries will be discussed at this stage. Awarding and signing of contracts with successful contractors will be a preserve of the DACO in collaboration with the S3P Facilitation Team Leader which will be done upon agreeing on the terms. However, priority will be given to constructors in the district in which the approved project is, provided they meet the requirements. The next to be considered are those in the province before consideration will be given to those at national level. 30. Announcement of tender results and contractor mobilisation – A Focused Facilitation meeting including participants from the Infrastructure Fund committee, the District coordinator, the FTL, the local CEO/Facilitator, the Contractor, and Director of Works and CAC representative will be held for the benefiting community at which the 153 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report tender results will be announced and terms of payment agreed. Terms of payment will be agreed based on the Activity and work schedule to be developed and agreed upon by MACO and the Contractor. Mobilization of the Contractor to project site will be within 2 weeks of signing of the contract. 31. Community ownership – Project ownership will be promoted by two processes. The first one is through dialogue, community participation and decision making in planning, implementation and maintenance of the project which is aimed to provide the local community with an improved understanding of social and economic significance, technical quality, contractual obligations, good governance and ownership of the project. The second process will be through community contribution. S3P will contribute up to 75% of construction costs, with a ceiling of US$ 25,000 per sub-project. Community contributions will be in form of local materials (such as sand and stones), labour, food, and tools. 32. Capacity building: To ensure sustainable utilisation of the projects, a strong sense of ownership by the requesting community coupled with appropriate management skills will be an essential prerequisite. Capacity will be built for the community (including the project committee), those participating in the technical field and appraisal visit, the DAC which will be approving project proposals, and the MACO Technical Branch Team plus the District Council who will be involved in the supervision and monitoring of the project. These will be trained in their respective roles and responsibilities for them to execute their duties diligently. Groups will also be facilitated in preparation of proposals/requests. 33. Management of infrastructure development - An Engineering Consultant (EC) will be contracted to give managerial advice on matters of construction and management of the DAIF to the Programme, target-communities, private contractors and public institutions in the target districts. The EC will not on full time basis, but will be called upon to provide services as and when need arises. 34. Funds flow for both categories of infrastructure (district and community) - the participating community or group will open an S3P account to which funds will be sent directly from the PMU. Every cheque issued on those accounts will require two signatures, one from Panel A and another from Panel B. Panel A will comprise the MACO District signatories (the DACO and the Assistant Accountant) while Panel B will comprise the executive members of the infrastructure project committee (chairperson, secretary and treasurer) who are community or group representatives . The community or group will be required to select representatives who are credible, have integrity and are transparent. For them to do that, the group facilitation in sub-component 1.1 will emphasis this aspect as well the roles and responsibilities of the project committee. 35. Project monitoring and inspection Monitoring of Contractor’s implementation or construction works will take place after every major activity in the Activity Schedule by Director of Works and FTL (DC). The CEO will submit monthly project monitoring reports to the FTL and S3P TL. To ensure quality, each project will be inspected at least 6 times during the construction phase. 36. Pre-commissioning workshops - The Pre-Commissioning Workshops will be organised by Infrastructure Fund committees after physical construction of project is completed. The workshops will discuss Maintenance Plans that will be costed in terms of labour, tools and material requirements which will be based on the maintenance guidelines and frequency which will be developed by the EC for each type on infrastructure. The plans will also include the necessary training in maintenance. The workshops will also discuss possible business developments resulting from the new infrastructure (e.g. out-grower schemes, input supply) and its capacity to support economic exploitation without compromising the environment; and future use of the tools provided by the Contractor. The tools could be used for other Community income generating projects as well as for individual productive purposes like opportunities for 154 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report hiring. The pre-commissioning workshop will decide the date for Commissioning and Hand-Over. 37. Commissioning and Handover - The Commissioning and Handover workshops will be ceremonies to publicise the completion and takeover of the infrastructure by the community. These ceremonies will be graced by high ranking government officials. 38. Project final completion workshop - Final project completion workshops will be held for each project after a one-year retention phase. The retention phase will be devised to expose the infrastructure to all the seasonal variations and identify any defects resulting from poor workmanship for the contractor to repair. The workshops will be epitomised by termination of contracts between S3P and the partner communities and the Partnership with the respective contractors. (c): Group-based agricultural investments with a high social value: 39. Investments here would include limited and conditional support to purchase labour saving equipment that might in more advanced situations be entirely financed through private means. The processing of the crops being targeted by S3P is usually done by women using methods which are extremely labour-intensive and time consuming. In addition, it is also important to note that women are more vulnerable to HIV/AIDS and also nurse HIV/AIDS patients in the communities such that they have to share their time between meeting those social needs and agricultural production. In such situations, labour-saving technologies can have a very significant positive impact on livelihoods of the poor and disadvantaged, in particular women, girls and the youth as a way of mitigating effects of cross cutting issues (gender and HIV/AIDS). 40. Assessment of groups: There are existing smallholder farmer groups with a common interest, willingness and capacity to develop into entrepreneurs but due to poverty levels and other factors which disadvantage them, they are unable to access credit for improved agricultural productivity. These groups include women groups, girls, youth groups, HIV/AIDS support groups, etc. These groups are at different levels of development in terms of group dynamics, cohesiveness, and self-sustainability. Each group will be assessed to ascertain the development stage (see Annex 4, Table 4). The results of this assessment will be used to determine the level, focus and emphasis of capacity building to be provided to each group to enable them reach a maturity stage (Stage 4) when they can be able to access the co-financing facility. 41. Groups will be capacity built with organizational/legal skills. Interest group members and their leaders will be trained in group dynamics, leadership skills, qualities and values of a leader, management skills, facilitation of assembly meetings, monitoring production, farmer groups’ rights and responsibilities, and legal aspects like development of group constitutions (bye laws). All members of interest groups will also be strongly encouraged to be members of savings and credit groups, though there should be no relationship between the interest group and the savings and credit group (except that of client and bank). These topics will be included in the facilitation which will be done for farmer groups in Sub-component 1.1. 42. Agricultural equipment: The groups will be supported with co-financing for the acquisition of the following agricultural equipment: (i) on-farm irrigation equipment such as treadle pumps, Ntambo pumps, water pumps (various capacities), windmills, irrigation pipes, water tank stands from 2,500 – 10,000 litres capacity tanks, poly tanks from 2,500 – 10,000 litres, etc. on-farm production equipment and assets such as ox carts, ploughs, diesel engine walking tractor with accessories, oxen or tractor driven harrow, etc. (ii) on-farm agricultural post-harvest treatment and value adding equipment and assets such as motor or diesel engine dehullers, motor or diesel engine gravity hammer-mills, motor or diesel engine cyclone hammer-mills, manual or diesel 155 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report maize shellers, motor or diesel engine cassava processors, hand operated oil presses (yenga), single phase electric motor or hand operated peanut butter mills (25 – 80 kgs per hour), manually operated or with electric motor groundnut shellers with winnower 50 – 150 kgs per hour), and motor or diesel engine dehuller/hammermill Combos (600 kgs per hour). (iii)Other on-farm equipment such as single choppers (manual, diesel or motor driven) for cutting fodder for livestock feed, motor or diesel engine feed mixer, feeding/milking cage with capacity of 1 – 6 animals, 15 – 20 litres milking buckets, generator sets, 20 – 40 kgs per hour fired/firewood roasting drum for all roasting requirements, etc. 43. Project Proposals: Requests for these investments would originate at the group level and S3P would provide facilitation services for participatory identification, planning, feasibility screening and preparation of business plans. The group will submit a formal request to MACO through the Camp Extension Officer (CEO) with quotations from three agro dealers contracted by MACO to supply agricultural equipment. The request should contain the following information at the least: date of application, contact person, the name of the group, camp, district, when the group was formed, why it was formed, legal status, the training the group has received, proof of having reached the maturity stage, the activities the group is involved in, the name of the agricultural equipment the group is applying for (with attached minutes of the resolution of the group to apply for that equipment), justification for the request (social and economic benefits), how much the group is proposing to contribute, how much the group has set aside as operating capital, financial position of the group, maintenance proposal, etc. 44. Eligibility criteria: There will be stringent eligibility criteria that requesting groups need to meet. Investment support would be restricted to groups that: (i) have reached a sufficiently mature developmental stage (Stage 4); but (ii) because of prevailing poverty are not able to raise sufficient funds to obtain the required equipment on credit; while (iii) the labour saving equipment would, at a modest fee, also be available to other community members (non-group members). Special consideration will be given to women, youth, and other vulnerable groups. 45. Project co-financing: S3P will remain flexible in terms of how much a group should contribute to the cost of the agricultural equipment it selects - since groups have different financial capacities and the types and prices of equipment also vary - up to a maximum of 50 percent of equipment costs, with a ceilings of US$ 2,500 per sub-project and one sub-project per group. The Camp Extension Officer (CEO), as a group facilitator, in collaboration with the service provider where possible, will make an assessment and recommendations for the financial capacity of a particular group. In making this assessment, consideration should be made that the group will also need to have operating capital. 46. It is critical that the equipment acquired by the groups is seen as belonging to the members and not the programme. To address the ownership issue the group’s contribution will be raised either through cash or individual loans obtained from the savings and credit groups. This way the members will take care of the equipment because it will be used to generate income for the group and themselves and it is this income that will be used to pay back the loan. The savings and credit group loans will also be a source of funds to maintain the equipment. 47. Feasibility assessment by a technical committee: The Camp Agricultural Committee (CAC) chaired by the CEO, the Block Extension Officer (Block) and the respective MACO specialist at district level will undertake a feasibility assessment of the request and make recommendations to the District Agricultural Committee (DAC) which is headed by the District Agricultural Coordination Officer (DACO) for approval. 48. Approval Limits: The DAC will review the appraisal and approve or reject the request. Where the project requested for is worth more than the approval limit of the DACO (ZK 10,000/US$2,200), the proposal will be referred for the PACO’s approval. 156 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 49. Focused facilitation meeting: Once a request has been approved/rejected, the CEO will arrange for a focused facilitation meeting with the group at which the results of the request will be communicated. The meeting will be attended by the DAC, BEO, CEO, CAC and all group members. The DACO will announce the results and give reasons for disapproved requests. For groups whose requests have been approved, the DACO will hand over a letter of approval of the equipment by the Programme to the group. The meeting will also discuss the contributions of the group to the acquisition of the agricultural equipment and agree when that payment can be made. The meeting will also discuss the future need for maintenance and group contribution towards maintenance and the economic opportunities which could be taken up using the income earned from the utilization of the equipment. Maintenance should include ways to sustain the environment. 50. Development of a procurement plan: MACO, in collaboration with the recipient group will come up with a procurement plan which will be enshrined in the contract to be signed between those two parties. MACO should consider identifying local agro dealers with whom it will sign contracts for the supply of various types of agricultural equipment. The group will pay its contribution directly to the approved agro dealer and submit proof of payment to DACO as the basis on which the Programme will release its contribution of funds. The Programme will make a cheque payment directly to the agro dealer1. Other issues 51. Monitoring of funded projects: The CEO and the infrastructure project committees should undertake regular monitoring of the groups which benefit from funding and produce monthly and quarterly reports as per the MACO reporting system. 52. Funding ceiling: Due to the demand-driven nature of the sub-component, all the three categories of support under it shall have no ceiling per district. However, to create a level playing field for all districts in each province participating in the Progamme, all information on the sub-component and its operations should be rolled out to all the districts at the same time. However, at Programme level, the sub-component will have a ceiling of US$16 million which will be buffer Fund. 1 Consideration was made for the use of a voucher system but it was dropped because it usually works well where the support is in standardized/pack form. However, if it is still of interest, after the first year, PLARD II can explore possibilities of using a voucher system instead of a cheque. This will entail assessing the most demanded agricultural equipment to come up with vouchers for those. Once a group brings proof of payment for its contribution to the DACO it will be provided with a voucher to take to the agro dealer. Then the agro dealer will redeem the voucher. The voucher system will quicken the process of equipment acquisition as the group will be able to get the equipment even before the agro dealer redeems the voucher. When a cheque is used the group has to wait for the cheque to be prepared by DACO, collected and deposited by the agro dealer, and cleared by the bank. 157 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 12. Adherence to IFAD Policies ENVIRONMENTAL SCREENING AND SCOPING NOTE 1. This Environmental Screening and Scoping Note (ESSN) has been prepared in line with IFAD’s Administrative Procedures for Environmental Assessment in the Project Cycle (President’s Bulletin 94/03) using information gathered during the visit of IFAD inception, formulation and appraisal missions to Zambia between October 2010 and April 2011. It has benefited extensively from the Environmental and Social Review Note (ESRN) prepared for the Smallholder Agribusiness Promotion Programme (SAPP) 1. The proposed environmental classification for the project is “B”. No further information is deemed necessary to complete the ESSN and no formal Environmental Assessment is considered necessary. I. PROGRAMME DESCRIPTION 2. S3P has a two components and six sub-components. For a detailed programme description, please refer to the description in the Main Text of the Project Design Report and to Annex 2 (Poverty, Targeting and Gender) and Annex 4 (Detailed Programme Description). S3P Goal: Income levels, food and nutrition security sustainably improved for poor agricultural households in target area S3P Development objective: Production, productivity and sales of smallholder farmers in target areas sustainably increased. Component 1: Sustainable smallholder Component 2: Enabling environment for productivity growth. productivity growth. Sub-component 1.1: Strengthening farmer organizations and their federations Sub-component 2.1: District Agricultural Investment Fund Sub-component 1.2: Pluralistic participatory extension services Sub-component 2.2: Support to the policy and planning framework Sub-component 2.3: Programme management, monitoring and evaluation Sub-component 1.3: Agricultural research for development II. MAJOR SITE CHARACTERISTICS 3. The proposed programme area will cover 24 districts, most of which are located in of the cassava-based farming system areas in Luapula and the Northern provinces of Zambia, which the Government has identified as the priority area for S3P. Some districts will be located in a third province, which will be identified and decided during the course of the programme. 4. These cassa-based farming system areas areas are characterised by a high incidence of poverty (>70 per cent), low human development indicators and overall deprivation. These areas are, generally, both food and nutrition insecure and outside of the agricultural sector, the access to other sources of employment and income is limited. Many areas within these districts are remote and isolated (mainly family settlements), which results in poor access to markets, sporadic government services and limited economic opportunities. (see also details in Annex 1). 5. Physical and Biological Characteristics. Zambia is endowed with a wealth of natural resources within 16 ecosystems with landscapes that include extensive forests, grassy plains, hills and steep escarpments; huge lakes and rivers, deep valleys and ecologically rich wetlands together with areas of anthropic origin such as cropland, plantation forests and urban settlements. The country straddles large parts of the 1 See SAPP-WP 6. Social screening is provided in Annex 1 . 158 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Zambezi and Congo drainage systems, and it is thus probably the best watered country in Africa, in terms of both surface and ground water resources. The country has six major perennial rivers - the Zambezi, Luangwa, Kafue, Kabompo, Luapula and Chambeshi; and four major lakes: Bangweulu, Kariba, Tanganyika and Mweru. The water bodies also include substantial wetland areas around the rivers and lakes. Including these wetlands, surface water covers 20 per cent of Zambia’s land area. The agricultural potential of the country is defined in terms of three Agro-Ecological Regions (Figure 1) and their main characteristics are described in Table 1. Table 1: Classification of Agro-Ecological Regions (AER) in Zambia. Element Rainfall LGP (70% probability) Nber of decades < 30 mm Altitude Temperature Growing season Cold season Sunshine Soils Vegetation Main crops AER 1 <800 mm 80-120 days Up to 5 Valleys: 300-900 m asl. South: 900-1200 m asl. 20-25 °C Mild/severe frost AER 2 /a 800-1000 mm 100-140 days 1-3 900-1300 m asl. Loamy clay soils Red coarse sandy soils Poor drained sandy soils IIa: Moderately leached clay soils Mopane woodland Acacia woodlands Deciduous thickets Drought resistant crops such as cotton, sorghum and millet (rice in shores of Zambezi plains). Livestock limited (Tsetse) 23-25 °C Some severe frost IIb: Coarse sandy loams and Sandy soils IIa: Miombo woodland Munga woodland IIb: Kalahari woodland IIa: Maïze, cotton, tobacco, helianthus, soybean, and irrigated wheat and vegetables IIb: maize, rice, cashew nut, cassava, millet, vegetables. AER 3 >1000 mm 120-150 days 1100-1700 m asl. Luapula valley:1000m 26°C Limited Highly weathered soils pH<4.5 (Al/Mn tox) Miombo woodland Cassava, maïze, mixed beans, millet/sorghum and groundnuts, sugar cane and fruits Livestock: mainly small ruminants, poultry Livestock: beef cattle production, dairy, and poultry. Provinces Southern and parts of IIa: Lusaka, Central + Eastern and Western Southern and Eastern IIb:Western /a: AER 2 is commonly sub-divided into sub-region IIa comprising the sandveld plateau of Central, Eastern? Lusaka and Southern Provinces and a sub-region IIb comprising the Kalahari sand plateau and the Zambezi flood plains in the western Province. Figure 1: Zambia agro-ecological regions I, IIa, IIb and III. 159 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 6. Overview of Agro-ecological conditions in the target area. The Luapula and the Northern Province of Zambia are located in the agro-ecological zone III (1000-1500 mm annual rainfall). This zone forms a plateau located at 1000-1500 m asl and benefits from a rather high rainfall in a mono-modal pattern. Average annual rainfall varies from 1100 mm in the South (Mpika) to 1400 in the northern part of the plateau. The length of growing period (LGP) extends from November to March-April with an average LGP of 128 to 172 days when moving from the south to the north (Nchelenge). The Luapula valley (east of the plateau along the RDC border) has a rather drier micro-climate with a larger degree of unpredictability (especially in Kawambwa). The soils are highly weathered, leached and acidic, with pH of less than 4.5 and very low reserves of primary minerals and very low organic matter levels do provide low water storage and buffer capacity, leading rapidly to dry soil conditions when rain intervals increase especially at the end of the rainy season. They are usually deficient in phosphorous, nitrogen and many other major plant nutrients and some micro-nutrients. Though these soils have serious chemical limitations to plant growth, the physical properties are mostly favourable. Soil organic matter content is very low and holds the key to productivity improvements. 7. Temperature and elevation. The elevation of the great central African plateau on which Zambia is located, typically between 1000 and 1300 m asl modifies temperatures, which are lower than for coastal areas at the same latitude, and pleasant for much of the year. On the plateau (covering about 80 per cent of the country) mean minimums for June in the cool dry season are in the range 6–12°C, mean maximums for October, the hot dry season are 28–35°C. Frost only occurs on a few days in winter on the highest exposed hills, or more widely in the lower humidity areas of the southern half of the country. Plants susceptible to frost do not grow in the southern half of the country. Otherwise temperature by itself is not a great determinant of plant and animal distribution. Temperatures are higher at lower elevations, such as the Luapula-Mweru and Mweru-Wantipa/Tanganyika valleys in the north, and highest in the lower Luangwa and Zambezi valleys in the south, typically experiencing 40°C in October. One way in which temperature affects the distribution of large mammals is through the distribution of the tsetse fly, which, within its range is found in hotter valleys rather than the higher, cooler plateau. Species susceptible to trypanosomiasis are not found in such valleys. 8. Soils and Land Classification Suitability. Soils1 of AER III consist of highly weathered and leached soils that are characterized by low pH < 4.5, low CEC and very low reserves of primary minerals. Soils are usually deficient in phosphorus, nitrogen and many other major plant nutrients and some micro-nutrients. Though the soils have serious chemical limitations for plant growth, their physical properties are generally favourable: these include micro-structural stability, deep and well drained soils (in absence of ‘clay pan’, and relatively high biological activity. 9. Soil acidity in the northern area has been studied over the past half-century. Main agronomic related elements are: (i) low pH (< 4.5 PH water): (ii) Ca and Mg deficiencies; (iii) Al and Mn toxicities and critical Al saturation of CEC; (iv) phosphate ‘fixation’ (formation of Al phosphates which precipitates and thus unavailable to plants). Lime rates needed to to neutralize the exchangeable Al would raise pH and supply adequate levels of Ca and Mg (dolomitic lime). However some soils (e.g. in Luapula) 1 Most common soils are: (i) strongly leached reddish to brownish clayey to loamy soils derived from acid rocks (Miombo) - Orthic/Xhantic Ferral soils – Ferric Acrisols; (ii) shallow and gravel soils occurring in rolling to hilly areas, shallow to deep moderately- strongly leached reddish and brownish clay-loamy soils (Lithosoils, Orthic Feralsoil and Lithosol, Ferric Acrisol, ferric Luvisol; (iii) Moderately leached red-brown clay-loam soils derived from acid rocks-Miombo (Ferric Acrisol/Luvisol); (iv) Associations of strongly leached brown-yellow mainly loamy well drained and poorly drained floodplain soils (Xanthic Ferral sol + Ferralitic Cambisol, Humic Ferral sol and Dystic Gleysol); and (v) Swamps and swampy soils (Grassland) (Distric Gleysoils /Humic G. and Distric Fluvisoils); (vi) Soils of the rift valley with variable textures, highly acid sandy soils up to dark alkaline cracking clays (Chromic/pellic vertisol, Orthic Luvisols); and (vi) alluvial soils along Luangwa river (Eutric Fluvisols + Eutric Cambisol). 160 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report show a combined Al and Mn toxicity and thus would require higher levels of lime1 to neutralize exchangeable Mn. III. KEY ENVIRONMENTAL AND NATURAL RESOURCE MANAGEMENT ISSUES A. Environmental Degradation and Poverty 10. There is a high correlation between poverty and environmental degradation as a result of poor people’s dependence on exploitation of the environment for survival. The poverty situation in the country, and in particular in the rural areas, results in unsustainable natural resource exploitation, and is associated with resource depletion and environmental degradation. These problems are compounded by high levels of rural population growth which contribute further to a vicious cycle of increasing poverty and increasing depletion of resources. This central issue is compounded by limited understanding of environmental problems, a weak administrative and legal framework, and breakdown of traditional values and practices which previously ensured a high degree of social responsibility and equitable sharing of resources within a natural equilibrium. B. Deforestation and Land Degradation 11. The greatest environmental challenge facing the country is deforestation. Although some 60 per cent of the total land area is covered by forest, much of it is degraded through encroachment and bush fires; the two principal causes being uncontrolled agricultural expansion and charcoal burning. Between 1990 and 2000, Zambia lost an average of close to 450,000 hectares of forest per year, equivalent to an average deforestation rate of 0.9 per cent; while between 2000 and 2005, the rate of forest change further increased to 1.0 per cent per annum. In total, between 1990 and 2005, Zambia lost almost 14 per cent of its forest cover, or around 6.7 million hectares. 12. Deforestation has in turn affected the hydrological cycle and modified weather conditions. For example, in Kaoma district of Western Province - one of Zambia's largest charcoal-producing regions, several perennial streams have become seasonal and some have even dried up, while the water level in the Luena River, which flows through the town of Kaoma, has dropped. In Zambia's Southern Province, which suffered one of the highest and fastest deforestation rates in the 1990s, floods and droughts have become more frequent events. Other, linked environmental issues include soil erosion and land degradation - verging on desertification in some areas - most of which results from deforestation, land clearance and agricultural techniques that are ill-adapted to Zambian conditions. Wildlife depletion is also an issue, especially in the protected areas; as are inadequate sanitation and air and water pollution. 13. In the programme target area, where soils are frequently heavily leached and acid, the ‘large circle Chitemene’ shifting ax and hoe hand cultivation is the most common farming/cropping system practiced by the local Bemba populations. The cultivation starts with the selection of a field site on the basis of the quantity of available wood material and its botanical composition – fertility indicator. Clearing of the selected area2 starts in May-June (after rains): men cut shrubs/small trees and chop off the branches of bigger trees leaving trunks standing, while others cut trees at shoulder height (labour saving and less dangerous). Once cut women collect and pile up branches to prepare field for burning in late October after first rains, leaving a deep layer of ash. Finger millet is always grown in the first year, usually mixed with other crops such as pumpkins and cassava (some maize, sorghum and bulrush millet may also be planted). In the 2nd season, millet stalks are burnt and groundnuts and/or finger millet is planted. In the 3th year, mixed beans are most commonly grown, or groundnuts if finger millet 1 2 Several local sources for agricultural lime where identified among others in Ndola, Mkushi, Matanda and Nkombwa hills. See also: Economic aspects of Agricultural liming in Zambia. SPRP Studies n°9 (NORAGRIC, 1987). When fields are far away from the village a small temporary hut will be built where the family will live during clearing, land preparation and harvesting periods. 161 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report was grown in the 2nd year. Mixed beans (February-June) are planted on ridges, made early in the rainy season and contain incorporated grass. Harvest of cassava, planted in the first year, starts in December before the planting of the mixed beans. The fourth year could also be used for mixed beans and then the field is left to fallow. 14. The size of the cultivated field depends upon the (natural) wood quantity and density: a variation between 3-12 times (on average 6.5-10 times) 1 the actual cultivated area is being cleared and the wood accumulated on the area to be cultivated. On the basis of 0.6-1 ha per HH cleared annually (the average for Luapula/Northern Provinces smallholders), the total land (landholding) requirement per HH has been calculated at about 25-40 ha2, given a fallow requirement of 15years and the fact that about 60 per cent of the total area is suitable for cropping. 15. Conservation Farming. Traditional agricultural techniques that leave the topsoil bare during key periods of the year make a significant contribution to soil erosion and environmental degradation. The Conservation Farming Unit (CFU), an initiative of the Zambia National Farmers Union (ZNFU), has been trying to change this. Since 1996, and backed by a consortium of international donor agencies, it has been promoting the use of conservation farming (CF) techniques for smallholders in Zambia as a means to increase productivity, while using the land and water resources in a more efficient and sustainable manner. The CF system they advocate involves: dry-season land preparation using minimum tillage methods; no burning but rather retention of crop residue from the prior harvest; planting and input application in fixed planting stations; and nitrogen-fixing crop rotations. The CF system: (i) enables farmers to plant with the first rains; (ii) improves water infiltration, water retention and plant root development; (iii) prevents soil erosion; and (iv) enables farmers to locate fertiliser and organic material in close proximity to the plants, where they will provide greatest benefits. 16. Immediate gains result from increased yields, lower draft power and labour requirements, and from a reduced risk of crop failure in years of low rainfall: thus making it an invaluable approach for enhancing farmers’ ability to adapt to the effects of climate change. Many of the benefits are longer term however: they include improved soil organic matter levels, gains from nitrogen-fixing crop rotations, and reduced labour requirements for field preparation that enable many adopters to expand the area of land under cultivation. By ensuring permanent ground cover, CF also provides a carbon sink and so contributes to climate change mitigation. To date, approximately 140,000160,000 smallholder farmers in Zambia (about one in seven) have adopted CF techniques to some degree. 17. Traditional slash and burn agriculture (Chitemene) is still widely practiced. Shifting towards more intensive farming systems requires a drastic change in soil management towards increased soil organic matter content and pH, to promote more sustainable semi-permanent farming systems, resilient to climatic variability (flooding and drought). Within this perspective, conservation farming and agro-forestry technologies appear to be the most promising options. However, the CF and agroforestry technologies promoted in Zambia have mainly been developed for the dryer, maize-based farming systems of agro-ecological regions I and II, they have not been adapted to AER III. C. Climate Change 18. Despite low greenhouse gas emissions, the threat of climate change looms in Zambia. There remains uncertainty about how its impact will play out, with different forecasting models providing a range of different scenarios. According to the model used in the National Adaptation Programme of Action (NAPA)3, mean temperatures are 1 2 3 Trapnel 1953. The current level appears to be much higher Or an average carrying capacity of about 2-3 HH per km². “The National Adaptation Programme of Action” Ministry of Tourism, Environment and Natural Resources, 2007 162 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report expected to increase (average 2°C between 2010 and 2070), while rainfall will increase in AER III and decrease in AER I – particularly the valley areas and the southern parts of Western and Southern provinces. In all areas however, climatic conditions will become ever more uncertain, and floods and droughts are expected to become ever-more frequent. The implications for smallholder farmers are important: one key conclusion is that, under a variety of climate change scenarios, most varieties of maize, the staple crop (grown by 80 per cent of smallholder farmers nationwide) would not mature due to shortening of the growing season, especially in Zones I and II. 19. According to the NAPA, the country is already suffering from growing climatic variability. Both droughts and floods are increasing in frequency and intensity: between 2000 and 2007 there were two drought years, two flood years and only two normal condition years. The impacts of these floods and droughts have included widespread crop failure/loss, outbreaks of human and animal diseases, dislocation of human populations and destruction of property and infrastructure. In Zambia's Southern Province, which suffered one of the highest and fastest deforestation rates in the 1990s, floods and droughts have become perennial, causing failed harvests and chronic hunger, while other parts of the country have been experiencing shorter rainy seasons with colder winters and warmer summers. 20. In 2007 IUCN and partners conducted a participatory climate change vulnerability assessment (using the CRiSTAL decision support tool) with selected in communities in all three agro-ecological Zones1. Their findings were largely consistent with those of the NAPA. The communities cited drought, floods, extreme heat and shorter rainy season as the four main climate hazards faced, and were of the view that these changes started 3 to 9 years ago. The communities also identified the impacts that they associated with the hazards, as indicated in Table 2 below: Table 2: Impact associated with climatic hazards as identified by communities. Drought Crop-damage/loss, leading to food scarcity and hunger Water shortages Reduced fish stocks Income loss Reduced charcoal business Increase in diseases (human and animals) Decreased water quality Increased soil erosion Decreased soil fertility Increased honey production (if drought not too severe) Floods Crop damage/loss, leading to food scarcity and hunger Loss of crop land and grazing grounds Decline in fish catches Increase in diseases (malaria, dysentery, cholera) Destruction of infrastructures (roads, houses) Loss of life (human, livestock) Extreme heat Increase in diseases affecting animals, crops, humans (especially malaria) Decreased human capacity to work Loss of life (human, livestock) Crop damage/loss Reduced fish stocks Decreased livestock feed Reduced water quality Shorter rainy season Decreased crop yields Crop damage/loss Decreased income from sale of crops Crop seeds which do not reach maturity (with negative effects on next generation of crops) Reduced charcoal production and business 21. Climatic data over the past decades indicate an increasing level of total annual rainfall variability (linked to ‘La Nina’) and farmers claim that rainfall intensity is increasing in ‘wetter’ years, while rainfall intervals increase in ‘drier’ years. Furthermore, the increasing variability of LGP, induces reduced growing periods in relatively less rainy years and increased unpredictability of rain onset (planting time). Except for specific areas in the Luapula valley, the overall rainfall pattern does not yet appear problematic for local cassava-based cropping systems. However, soil erosion and temporary field flooding increase in wetter years, while higher risks for seeding failure for grain crops and cassava yield decreases occur in drier years. Cassava being planted after grain crops, the initial growth of cassava plants is not strong enough to pass the dry season 1 Climate Change and Development Project, Pilot Phase: “Climate change vulnerability assessment in Zambia”, IUCN 2007 163 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report (from 160 days in the North to 210 days in South on average) without too much damage. 22. A number of cropping practices, including adapted varieties, could be integrated within local cropping systems to reduce farmers risk levels linked to increasing rainfall variability. However, in the medium term, a gradual shift from traditional land use (chitemene slash and burn) toward more intensive farming system requires a drastic change of soil management towards increased soil organic matter and pH. Within this perspective, conservation farming and agro-forestry appear among the most promising options. These options would not only allow intensifying local farming systems, increasing their productivity, reducing farmers risk and labouring input, but also allow for carbon sequestration in soils by raising significantly their organic matter level. This shift would adapt local farming systems to changing environment and contribute to climate mitigation. IV. POLICY, LEGAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE FRAMEWORK 23. Zambia’s body of laws relating to the management of the environment and natural resources sector is spread over more than 20 international treaties and over 30 Acts of Parliament; and responsibility dispersed amongst at least ten ministries. Natural resource and environmental priorities have been spelled out in the National Environmental Action Plan, the Forest Policy, the Zambia National Biodiversity and Action Plan (NBSAP), the Zambia Forestry Action Plan (ZFAP), the National Action Plan (NAP) for the implementation of the United Nations Convention to Combat Desertification (UNCCD), and the Zambia Wetland Strategy and Action Plan. They have also been reflected in the FNDP (2006-2010), where environment is treated as a cross-cutting issue with its own specific objectives and strategies. 24. More recently, the National Policy on the Environment (NPE, 2007 1) serves to rationalise the various priorities and define a comprehensive policy for managing environmental and natural resources in harmony with the national development policy. The NPE is envisaged as an all-encompassing approach to environmental management. Its overall vision is to provide a framework for the sustainable management of Zambia’s environment and natural resources, and to this end it incorporates a set of objectives, guiding principles and strategies aimed at ensuring that all organisations and individuals exercise due care to avoid depletion of natural assets and environmental degradation. Its goals are expected to be achieved through the FNDP programmes on natural resources management and the environment. Specific to the agriculture sector, the NPE’s objective is to promote environmentally-sound agricultural development by ensuring sustainable crop and livestock production through ecologically appropriate production and management techniques, and appropriate legal and institutional framework for sustainable environmental management. 25. The key institutions are, above all, the Ministry of Tourism, Environment and Natural Resources (MTENR) - the lead institution for environmental and natural resource management in Zambia, and the Environmental Council of Zambia (ECZ), which is mandated to protect the environment and control pollution and is empowered to identify projects, plans and policies for which Environmental Impact Assessments are necessary. V. POTENTIAL ENVIRONMENTAL RISKS A. Overview 26. The attainment of the Programme’s overall goal – Income levels, food and nutrition security sustainably improved for poor agricultural households in the project area - is expected to have a positive socio-economic impact on the target population as 1 The process of developing the NPE was initiated by the Ministry of Tourism, Environment and Natural Resources in 2004. It was finalized in 2005, approved by cabinet in December 2007, and it is expected to be formally launched by mid-2009. 164 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report well as strengthening the capacity of the target population to adapt to the effects of climate change. 27. In its support for agricultural productivity increase of cassava and mixed beans based farming systems, S3P will promote crop diversification (particularly away from maize), so reducing the vulnerability of participant smallholder farmers to climate related shocks and risks of crop failure. Selected value chains are key to the livelihood of poor smallholder producers in the target area and offer also a good opportunity for increased commercialization and income, ensuring food security as well as for market opportunities. All of these aspects are expected to have important and positive social impacts. 28. S3P will promote the adoption of improved cassava and mixed beans cultivars that are better adapted to local farming systems and the emerging climatic conditions than are those currently used. It will promote their adoption and enhance their productivity, within the context of a conservation farming approach developed for the local agro-ecological conditions. These measures will not only reduce the vulnerability of the rural population to climatic shocks; they will also have a positive impact on the environment, through improved soil and water conservation, and increased carbon sequestration. B. Benefits and Risks 29. Overall the environmental impact of the proposed programme is expected to be positive. Production increase will be generated by productivity enhancement and improved return to cultivated land and labour. Although benefits from conservation farming practices are mainly expected in the medium to longer term, S3P will provide the building blocks for improved sustainability of local farming systems within a perspective of optimizing the use of available natural resources but also for climate change adaptation and mitigation. 30. A priori, one can point to the possibility of environmental and social risks associated with: (i) increased use of fertilizer and other agro-chemicals (particularly herbicide, which is promoted as part of the conservation farming package) by participating smallholder farmers; (ii) increased forest land clearing for new cultivation of selected commodities; (iii) increased gender inequality either through focus on crops controlled by men, or through men appropriating the benefits of “women’s” commodities; (iv) increased HIV transmission along crop marketing corridors; (v) Pollution, treatment of waste and/or waste water in agro-processing (e.g. cassava transformation); and (vi) erosion risks associated to infrastructure development (rural roads). C. Mitigation measures for environmental issues 31. To ensure that all intervention plans adequately take into account all potential environmental costs and benefits, agreement has been reached within SAPP that experts from the Environmental Council of Zambia (ECZ) will participate in the value chain analysis and the design of IPs. Within this framework, general guidelines for environmental risk management will be developed and check lists used when reviewing the annual work programme. 32. Although expected to be overall positive, potential environmental risks could be associated with community-based agricultural investment supports targeting productive rural infrastructure (market infrastructure, feeder roads, etc.) but also projects that have a positive impact on the environment and sustainability of intensified farming systems (soil erosion control, reforestation, etc.). Environmental issues will be identified by rapid environmental assessments and involved communities sensitized. Mitigation measures will be proposed and integrated into the respective investment action plan, as appropriate. 165 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report 33. Furthermore, the preparation of farmer group investments in window 1 ‘Farming as a Business’, will explicitly include a simplified participative review of potential environmental issues at planning stage and, wherever appropriate, will make recommendations for mitigating any environmental risk and/or expanding the environmental benefits. It is not possible at this stage to predict the range of issues to be considered, given the diversity of demand-driven activities to be proposed. Nevertheless, particular areas of focus are likely to include among others: a) Ensuring that farmers are trained in safe storage and handling of fertiliser and other agro-chemicals (particularly herbicides and insecticides); b) Ensuring that the promotion of any commodity-specific market opportunities does not result: (i) in increased clearing of forest land for new cultivation; or (ii) in the over-exploitation of cultivated soils, woodlands or grazing land; c) Promoting conservation farming practices (in partnership with GART/ZARI and other Conservation Farming partners) as a basis for on-farm productivity increases; d) Ensuring that the benefits accrue primarily to the programme target group and improve their food and nutrition security; e) Ensuring not only that within the target group women benefit proportionately, but also that men do not appropriate the benefits of “women’s” commodities; f) Avoiding the risk of increased HIV transmission by providing HIV training at all stages of the value chain; g) Training small and medium scale value chain operators in the safe treatment of waste and/or waste water in agro-processing (e.g. cassava) D. Monitoring 34. While it will be the responsibility of the value chain players supported by the Programme to promote positive environmental impacts and mitigate negative impacts, the monitoring both of those measures and of the environmental social impacts, both positive and negative, of the intervention plans will be the responsibility of the service providers who are engaged to support implementation of the intervention plans. Participative monitoring will be undertaken in relation to environmental and social indicators at Programme level, but also embodied in each of the investment plans. Programme monitoring will include appropriate environmental indicators at output level. E. Environmental Category 35. The Programme is proposed for classification as Category B – with minor environmental and social impacts, that can be managed and remedied. 36. Further information required to complete screening and scoping: No further studies required at this stage. 166 Zambia: Smallholder Productivity Promotion Programme (S3P) Programme Design Report: Volume 1 – Main Report Annex 13. Contents of the Programme Life File PROCESS DOCUMENTS: Identification Mission Aide Mémoire, September 2010 S3P Concept Note November, 2010 OSC Minutes 11 November 2010 Detailed Design Mission Aide Memoire, 17 January – 4 February 2011 QE Panel Report, 21 March 2011 PLARD/S3P proposed synergies 8 April 2011 Final Design Mission Aide Memoire, 28 March – 15 April 2011 WORKING PAPERS RELATED TO JANUARY/FEBRUARY 2011 MISSION: Food Security (V. Glaesener) Agriculture (H. Pfeiffer) Land Tenure Security and Land Use Planning (H. Liversage) WORKING PAPERS AND NOTES RELATED TO APRIL 2011 MISSION Analysis of Market Outlook (V. Glaesener) S3P Costs and Financing (V. Glaesener) S3P Financial and Economic Analysis (V. Glaesener) Support to Agricultural Production and Diversification (A. Mascaretti / E. Chuma). 167